blob: 58019479e0e4e744a75072742335a600086fa1b0 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaueaded982022-12-01 15:25:34 +01005 version 2.8
Christopher Fauletaaba8d02023-12-07 15:20:36 +01006 2023/12/07
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007
8
9This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
18 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
19 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020020 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
22 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
23 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020024 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025
26
27Summary
28-------
29
301. Quick reminder about HTTP
311.1. The HTTP transaction model
321.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100331.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341.2.2. The request headers
351.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371.3.2. The response headers
38
392. Configuring HAProxy
402.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200422.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100432.4. Conditional blocks
442.5. Time format
Daniel Eppersonffdf6a32023-05-15 12:45:27 -0700452.6. Size format
462.7. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02001028.2.4. HTTPS log format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
1048.2.6. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001058.3. Advanced logging options
1068.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1078.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1088.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1098.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1108.4. Timing events
1118.5. Session state at disconnection
1128.6. Non-printable characters
1138.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1148.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1158.9. Examples of logs
116
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001179. Supported filters
1189.1. Trace
1199.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001209.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001219.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001229.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001239.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02001249.7. Bandwidth limitation
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200125
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012610. FastCGI applications
12710.1. Setup
12810.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12910.1.2. Proxy section
13010.1.3. Example
13110.2. Default parameters
13210.3. Limitations
133
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013411. Address formats
13511.1. Address family prefixes
13611.2. Socket type prefixes
13711.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138
1391. Quick reminder about HTTP
140----------------------------
141
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100142When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200143fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
144on almost anything found in the contents.
145
146However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
147formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
148correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
149
150
1511.1. The HTTP transaction model
152-------------------------------
153
154The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100155to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100156from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
157connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158will involve a new connection :
159
160 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
161
162In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
163establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
164by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
165length.
166
167Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
168to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
169however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
170response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
171header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
172
173 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
174
175Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
176power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
177but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200178a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100180Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
182second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
183page :
184
185 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
186
187This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
188latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
189correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
190the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100191server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200193The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2 and HTTP/3.
194This time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all
195streams are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100196parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
197carry the stream identifier.
198
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200199
200HTTP/3 is implemented over QUIC, itself implemented over UDP. QUIC solves the
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +0200201head of line blocking at transport level by means of independently treated
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200202streams. Indeed, when experiencing loss, an impacted stream does not affect the
203other streams.
204
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100205By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
206connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
207leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100208start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
209processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
210waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200211
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200212HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100213 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
214 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100215 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100216 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200217 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100218
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100219
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220
2211.2. HTTP request
222-----------------
223
224First, let's consider this HTTP request :
225
226 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100227 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
229 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
230 3 User-agent: my small browser
231 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
232 5 Accept: image/png
233
234
2351.2.1. The Request line
236-----------------------
237
238Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
239
240 - a METHOD : GET
241 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
242 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
243
244All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
245which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
246followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
247is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
248desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
249the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
250
251The URI itself can have several forms :
252
253 - A "relative URI" :
254
255 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
256
257 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
258 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
259
260 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
261
262 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
263
264 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
265 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
266 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
267 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
268 must accept this form too.
269
270 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
271 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
272 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100273
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200274 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
275 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
276 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
277 other protocols too.
278
279In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
280mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
281on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
282It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
283specific to the language, framework or application in use.
284
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100285HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100286assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100287
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200288
2891.2.2. The request headers
290--------------------------
291
292The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
293beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
294an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
295Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
296values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
297encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
298the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
299define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
300
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100301Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200302their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100303"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200304as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
305normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
306representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
307HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200308
309The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
310that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
311is one valid form of empty line.
312
313Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
314headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
315about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
316application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
317
318Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000319 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200320 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
321 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
322 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
323
324
3251.3. HTTP response
326------------------
327
328An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
329messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
330
331 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100332 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200333 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
334 2 Content-length: 350
335 3 Content-Type: text/html
336
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200337As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
338codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
339response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100340continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
341the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
342following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
343sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
344(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
345correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
346such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
347state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400348over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100349if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
350information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200351
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200352
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003531.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200354------------------------
355
356Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
357
358 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
359 - a status code : 200
360 - a reason : OK
361
362The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100363 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
364 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
365 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
366 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
367 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200368
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000369Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100370"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
372messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
373or "Authentication Required".
374
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100375HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376
377 Code When / reason
378 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
379 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
380 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
381 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100382 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
383 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200384 400 for an invalid or too large request
385 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
386 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200387 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100388 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200389 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100390 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
391 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400392 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200393 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400394 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100395 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200396 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200397 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200398 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
399 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
400 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
401
402The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
4034.2).
404
405
4061.3.2. The response headers
407---------------------------
408
409Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
410the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
411details.
412
413
4142. Configuring HAProxy
415----------------------
416
4172.1. Configuration file format
418------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200419
420HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
421
422 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100423 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700424 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100425 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200426
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100427The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
428a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100429
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100430 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
431
432 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
433
434 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
435 tab characters
436
437 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
438 keyword sequences listed in this document
439
440 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
441 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
442 parts of the configuration, or expressions
443
444 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
445 are supported
446
447 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
448 section
449
450This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
451generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
452figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
453
454First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
455the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
456a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
457word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
458follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
459the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
460the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
461the parts that need to be addressed.
462
463A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
464requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
465extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
466the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
467section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
468section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
469not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
470
471A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
472each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
473a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
474start a new one.
475
476Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
477that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
478applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
479"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
480processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
481ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
482which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
483In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
484of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
485identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
486such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4872, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
488
489 listen foo
490 bind :80
491
492 listen bar
493 bind :81
494
495Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
496spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
497of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
498following configurations are strictly equivalent:
499
500 global#this is the global section
501 daemon#daemonize
502 frontend foo
503 mode http # or tcp
504
505and:
506
507 global
508 daemon
509
510 # this is the public web frontend
511 frontend foo
512 mode http
513
514The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
515new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
516other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
517section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
518section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
519at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
520
521Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
522are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
523editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
524support automatic indent.
525
526In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
527positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
528modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
529anymore, and is not recommended.
530
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200531
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005322.2. Quoting and escaping
533-------------------------
534
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100535In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
536that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
537possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
538in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
539('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200540
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100541This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
542very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
543the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
544also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
545delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
546word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
547remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200548
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100549If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
550(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
551
552Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
553backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200554
555 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
556 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
557 \\ to use a backslash
558 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
559 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
560
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100561In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
562C-language representation:
563
564 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
565 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
566 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
567 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
568
569Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
570or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
571of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200572
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100573 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200574 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
575 # hash as a comment start
576
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100577Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
578evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
579dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
580backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200581
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100582Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
583character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
584is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200585
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100586As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
587entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
588name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
589represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300590hence its absence there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200591
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100592 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
593 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
594 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300595 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
596 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" |
597 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
598 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" |
599 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100600 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300601 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100602 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300603 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300605 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100606 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300607 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
608 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" |
609 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100610 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300611 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200612
613 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100614 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200615 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
616 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
617 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
618 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
619 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
620
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100621There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
622necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
623by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
624they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
625escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
626characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
627case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
628if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
629own quotes.
630
631The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600632quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500633not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100634quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
635
636Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
637arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
638
639 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
640 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
641
642Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
643"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
644cannot write:
645
646 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
647
648because we would like the string to cut like this:
649
650 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
651 |---------|----|-|
652 arg1 _/ / /
653 arg2 __________/ /
654 arg3 ______________/
655
656but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
657parenthesis then garbage:
658
659 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
660 |--------|--------|
661 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
662 trailing garbage _________/
663
664The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
665quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
666processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
667this word:
668
669 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
670 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
671 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
672
673So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
674still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
675the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
676the second level:
677
678 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
679 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
680 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
681 |---------||----|-|
682 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
683 arg2=blah ___________/ /
684 arg3=g _______________/
685
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500686Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100687double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
688
689 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
690 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
691 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
692 |---------||----|-|
693 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
694 arg2 ___________/ /
695 arg3 _______________/
696
697When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
698appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
699string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
700thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
701
702 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
703 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
704 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
705 |-------------| |-----||-|
706 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
707 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
708 arg3 ______________________/
709
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400710Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600711that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100712quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
713single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
714level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
715
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600716Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
717if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
718or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
719
720 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
721 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
722 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
723
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100724When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
725double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600726and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100727a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
728a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
729the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
730regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
731around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
732more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200733
734
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007352.3. Environment variables
736--------------------------
737
738HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
739interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
740configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
741optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
742shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200743underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
744list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
745arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100746before the closing brace. It is also possible to specify a default value to
747use when the variable is not set, by appending that value after a dash '-'
748next to the variable name. Note that the default value only replaces non
749existing variables, not empty ones.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200750
751 Example:
752
753 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
754
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100755 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG-127.0.0.1}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200756
757 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
758
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200759Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
760file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200761
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200762* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
763 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
764
765* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
766 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
767 directory.
768
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +0100769* HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT: contains the value of the default HTTP log format as
770 defined in section 8.2.3 "HTTP log format". It can be used to override the
771 default log format without having to copy the whole original definition.
772
773 Example:
774 # Add the rule that gave the final verdict to the log
775 log-format "${HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT} lr=last_rule_file:last_rule_line"
776
777* HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT: similar to HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT but for HTTPS log
778 format as defined in section 8.2.4 "HTTPS log format".
779
780* HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT: similar to HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT but for TCP log format
781 as defined in section 8.2.2 "TCP log format".
782
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200783* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
784
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500785* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200786 processes, separated by semicolons.
787
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500788* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200789 CLI, separated by semicolons.
790
William Lallemandd4c0be62023-02-21 14:07:05 +0100791* HAPROXY_STARTUP_VERSION: contains the version used to start, in master-worker
792 mode this is the version which was used to start the master, even after
793 updating the binary and reloading.
794
Sébaastien Gross2a1bcf12023-02-23 12:54:25 -0500795* HAPROXY_BRANCH: contains the HAProxy branch version (such as "2.8"). It does
796 not contain the full version number. It can be useful in case of migration
797 if resources (such as maps or certificates) are in a path containing the
798 branch number.
799
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200800In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
801regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
802only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
803
804* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
805
806* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
807 starting at one.
808
809* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
810 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
811 first section.
812
813These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
814if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
815section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
816"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
817proxies.
818
819This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
820logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
821to name some config objects like servers for example.
822
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200823See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200824
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100825
8262.4. Conditional blocks
827-----------------------
828
829It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
830some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
831ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
832configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
833versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
834preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
835text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
836lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
837switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
838are defined to form conditional blocks:
839
840 - .if <condition>
841 - .elif <condition>
842 - .else
843 - .endif
844
845The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
846as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
847matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
848there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
849only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
850".elif" of a block.
851
852Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
853ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
854as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
855
Maximilian Maderfc0cceb2021-06-06 00:50:22 +0200856Conditions can also be evaluated on startup with the -cc parameter.
857See "3. Starting HAProxy" in the management doc.
858
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200859The conditions are either an empty string (which then returns false), or an
860expression made of any combination of:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100861
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100862 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
863 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200864 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200865 - a condition placed between a pair of parenthesis '(' and ')'
Kunal Gangakhedkard0bacde2021-08-17 11:55:45 +0530866 - an exclamation mark ('!') preceding any of the non-empty elements above,
867 and which will negate its status.
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200868 - expressions combined with a logical AND ('&&'), which will be evaluated
869 from left to right until one returns false
870 - expressions combined with a logical OR ('||'), which will be evaluated
871 from right to left until one returns true
872
873Note that like in other languages, the AND operator has precedence over the OR
874operator, so that "A && B || C && D" evalues as "(A && B) || (C && D)".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200875
876The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
877
878 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
879 exists, regardless of its contents
880
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200881 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
882 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
883 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
884
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200885 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
886 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
Christopher Fauleta1fdad72023-02-20 17:55:58 +0100887 - strstr(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the second string is found in the first one
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200888
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200889 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
890 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
891 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
892 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
893
894 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
895 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
896 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
897 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
898
Christopher Fauletc13f3022023-02-21 11:16:08 +0100899 - enabled(<opt>) : returns true if the option <opt> is enabled at
900 run-time. Only a subset of options are supported:
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +0100901 POLL, EPOLL, KQUEUE, EVPORTS, SPLICE,
902 GETADDRINFO, REUSEPORT, FAST-FORWARD,
903 SERVER-SSL-VERIFY-NONE
Christopher Fauletc13f3022023-02-21 11:16:08 +0100904
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200905Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100906
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200907 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
908 listen mwcli_px
909 bind :1111
910 ...
911 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100912
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200913 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
914 bind :80
915 .endif
916
917 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200918 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200919 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200920 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200921 .endif
922
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200923 .if feature(OPENSSL) && (streq("$WITH_SSL",yes) || streq("$SSL_ONLY",yes))
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200924 bind :443 ssl crt ...
925 .endif
926
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200927 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
928 profiling.memory on
929 .endif
930
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200931 .if !feature(OPENSSL)
932 .alert "SSL support is mandatory"
933 .endif
934
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200935Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100936
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200937 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100938 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
939 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
940 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
941
942Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
943"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
944fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
945provide advice to the user.
946
947Example:
948
949 .if "${A}"
950 .if "${B}"
951 .notice "A=1, B=1"
952 .elif "${C}"
953 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
954 .elif "${D}"
955 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
956 .else
957 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
958 .endif
959 .else
960 .notice "A=0"
961 .endif
962
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200963 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
964 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
965
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100966
9672.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200968----------------
969
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100970Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100971values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
972otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
973numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
974for every keyword. Supported units are :
975
976 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
977 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
978 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
979 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
980 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
981 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
982
983
Daniel Eppersonffdf6a32023-05-15 12:45:27 -07009842.6. Size format
985----------------
986
987Some parameters involve values representing size, such as bandwidth limits.
988These values are generally expressed in bytes (unless explicitly stated
989otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
990numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
991for every keyword. Supported units are case insensitive :
992
993 - k : kilobytes. 1 kilobyte = 1024 bytes
994 - m : megabytes. 1 megabyte = 1048576 bytes
995 - g : gigabytes. 1 gigabyte = 1073741824 bytes
996
997Both time and size formats require integers, decimal notation is not allowed.
998
999
10002.7. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02001001-------------
1002
1003 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
1004 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
1005 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
1006 global
1007 daemon
1008 maxconn 256
1009
1010 defaults
1011 mode http
1012 timeout connect 5000ms
1013 timeout client 50000ms
1014 timeout server 50000ms
1015
1016 frontend http-in
1017 bind *:80
1018 default_backend servers
1019
1020 backend servers
1021 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
1022
1023
1024 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
1025 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
1026 global
1027 daemon
1028 maxconn 256
1029
1030 defaults
1031 mode http
1032 timeout connect 5000ms
1033 timeout client 50000ms
1034 timeout server 50000ms
1035
1036 listen http-in
1037 bind *:80
1038 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
1039
1040
1041Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
1042
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +01001043 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02001044
1045
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010463. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001047--------------------
1048
1049Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
1050are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
1051of them have command-line equivalents.
1052
1053The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
1054
1055 * Process management and security
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001056 - 51degrees-allow-unmatched
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001057 - 51degrees-cache-size
1058 - 51degrees-data-file
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001059 - 51degrees-difference
1060 - 51degrees-drift
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001061 - 51degrees-property-name-list
1062 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001063 - 51degrees-use-performance-graph
1064 - 51degrees-use-predictive-graph
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001065 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001066 - chroot
Frédéric Lécaille372508c2022-05-06 08:53:16 +02001067 - cluster-secret
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001068 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001069 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001070 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001071 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001072 - description
1073 - deviceatlas-json-file
1074 - deviceatlas-log-level
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001075 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001076 - deviceatlas-separator
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001077 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001078 - external-check
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001079 - fd-hard-limit
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001080 - gid
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001081 - grace
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001082 - group
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001083 - h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
1084 - h1-case-adjust
1085 - h1-case-adjust-file
1086 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001087 - hard-stop-after
William Lallemande279f592023-05-11 21:08:38 +02001088 - httpclient.resolvers.disabled
William Lallemandcfabb352022-05-12 10:51:15 +02001089 - httpclient.resolvers.id
1090 - httpclient.resolvers.prefer
William Lallemand4ad693e2023-09-05 15:55:04 +02001091 - httpclient.retries
William Lallemandcfabb352022-05-12 10:51:15 +02001092 - httpclient.ssl.ca-file
1093 - httpclient.ssl.verify
William Lallemandb9ed1572023-09-05 16:42:27 +02001094 - httpclient.timeout.connect
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001095 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001096 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001097 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001098 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001099 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001100 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001101 - log-tag
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001102 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001103 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001104 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001105 - mworker-max-reloads
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001106 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001107 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001108 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001109 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001110 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001111 - presetenv
Patrick Hemmer425d7ad2023-05-23 13:02:08 -04001112 - prealloc-fd
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001113 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001114 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001115 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001116 - setenv
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001117 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001118 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
William Lallemandb6ae2aa2023-05-05 00:05:46 +02001119 - ssl-default-bind-client-sigalgs
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001120 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001121 - ssl-default-bind-options
William Lallemand1d3c8222023-05-04 15:33:55 +02001122 - ssl-default-bind-sigalgs
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001123 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001124 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001125 - ssl-default-server-options
1126 - ssl-dh-param-file
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone8097652022-05-16 16:24:32 +02001127 - ssl-propquery
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02001128 - ssl-provider
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonccc03552022-05-17 15:18:37 +02001129 - ssl-provider-path
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001130 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001131 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001132 - stats
1133 - strict-limits
1134 - uid
1135 - ulimit-n
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001136 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001137 - unsetenv
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001138 - user
1139 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001140 - wurfl-data-file
1141 - wurfl-information-list
1142 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001143
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001144 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001145 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001146 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001147 - maxcompcpuusage
1148 - maxcomprate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001149 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001150 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001151 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001152 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001153 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001154 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001155 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001156 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001157 - noepoll
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001158 - noevports
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001159 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001160 - nokqueue
1161 - nopoll
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001162 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001163 - nosplice
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001164 - profiling.tasks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001165 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001166 - server-state-file
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001167 - spread-checks
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001168 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001169 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001170 - tune.buffers.limit
1171 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001172 - tune.bufsize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001173 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Christopher Faulet2f7c82b2023-02-20 14:06:52 +01001174 - tune.disable-fast-forward
Christopher Faulet760a3842023-02-20 14:33:46 +01001175 - tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001176 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Tim Duesterhus3ca274b2023-06-13 15:07:34 +02001177 - tune.h2.be.initial-window-size
1178 - tune.h2.be.max-concurrent-streams
1179 - tune.h2.fe.initial-window-size
1180 - tune.h2.fe.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau4869ed52023-10-13 18:11:59 +02001181 - tune.h2.fe.max-total-streams
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001182 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001183 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001184 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Tim Duesterhusbf7493e2023-06-13 15:08:47 +02001185 - tune.h2.max-frame-size
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001186 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001187 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001188 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001189 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001190 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001191 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001192 - tune.lua.maxmem
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001193 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001194 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1195 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Tristan2632d042023-10-23 13:07:39 +01001196 - tune.lua.log.loggers
1197 - tune.lua.log.stderr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001198 - tune.maxaccept
1199 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001200 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreau284cfc62022-12-19 08:15:57 +01001201 - tune.memory.hot-size
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001202 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreau8bd146d2022-07-19 20:17:38 +02001203 - tune.peers.max-updates-at-once
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001204 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001205 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1206 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02001207 - tune.quic.frontend.conn-tx-buffers.limit
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02001208 - tune.quic.frontend.max-idle-timeout
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02001209 - tune.quic.frontend.max-streams-bidi
Amaury Denoyelle24d5b722023-01-31 11:44:50 +01001210 - tune.quic.max-frame-loss
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02001211 - tune.quic.retry-threshold
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01001212 - tune.quic.socket-owner
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001213 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1214 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001215 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001216 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001217 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001218 - tune.sndbuf.client
1219 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01001220 - tune.stick-counters
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001221 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001222 - tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size
1223 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size (deprecated)
1224 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02001225 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1226 - tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001227 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001228 - tune.ssl.lifetime
1229 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001230 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Remi Tricot-Le Breton58432372023-02-28 17:46:29 +01001231 - tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay
1232 - tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001233 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001234 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001235 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1236 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1237 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001238 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1239 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001240
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001241 * Debugging
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02001242 - anonkey
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001243 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001244 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001245
1246
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012473.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001248------------------------------------
1249
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100125051degrees-data-file <file path>
1251 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1252 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1253
1254 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001255 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001256
125751degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
1258 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1259 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1260 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1261
1262 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001263 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001264
126551degrees-property-separator <char>
1266 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1267 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1268
1269 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001270 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001271
127251degrees-cache-size <number>
1273 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1274 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1275 By default, this cache is disabled.
1276
1277 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001278 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001279
128051degrees-use-performance-graph { on | off }
1281 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of the performance graph in
1282 the detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1283
1284 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001285 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001286
128751degrees-use-predictive-graph { on | off }
1288 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of the predictive graph in
1289 the detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1290
1291 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001292 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001293
129451degrees-drift <number>
1295 Sets the drift value that a detection can allow.
1296
1297 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001298 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001299
130051degrees-difference <number>
1301 Sets the difference value that a detection can allow.
1302
1303 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001304 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001305
130651degrees-allow-unmatched { on | off }
1307 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of unmatched nodes in the
1308 detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1309
1310 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001311 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001312
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001313ca-base <dir>
1314 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001315 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1316 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1317 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001318
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001319chroot <jail dir>
1320 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1321 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1322 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1323 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1324 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001325 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001326
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001327close-spread-time <time>
1328 Define a time window during which idle connections and active connections
1329 closing is spread in case of soft-stop. After a SIGUSR1 is received and the
1330 grace period is over (if any), the idle connections will all be closed at
1331 once if this option is not set, and active HTTP or HTTP2 connections will be
1332 ended after the next request is received, either by appending a "Connection:
1333 close" line to the HTTP response, or by sending a GOAWAY frame in case of
1334 HTTP2. When this option is set, connection closing will be spread over this
1335 set <time>.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001336 If the close-spread-time is set to "infinite", active connection closing
1337 during a soft-stop will be disabled. The "Connection: close" header will not
1338 be added to HTTP responses (or GOAWAY for HTTP2) anymore and idle connections
1339 will only be closed once their timeout is reached (based on the various
1340 timeouts set in the configuration).
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001341
1342 Arguments :
1343 <time> is a time window (by default in milliseconds) during which
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001344 connection closing will be spread during a soft-stop operation, or
1345 "infinite" if active connection closing should be disabled.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001346
1347 It is recommended to set this setting to a value lower than the one used in
1348 the "hard-stop-after" option if this one is used, so that all connections
1349 have a chance to gracefully close before the process stops.
1350
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001351 See also: grace, hard-stop-after, idle-close-on-response
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001352
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001353cluster-secret <secret>
1354 Define an ASCII string secret shared between several nodes belonging to the
1355 same cluster. It could be used for different usages. It is at least used to
1356 derive stateless reset tokens for all the QUIC connections instantiated by
1357 this process. This is also the case to derive secrets used to encrypt Retry
Amaury Denoyelle28ea31c2022-11-14 16:18:46 +01001358 tokens.
1359
1360 If this parameter is not set, a random value will be selected on process
1361 startup. This allows to use features which rely on it, albeit with some
1362 limitations.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001363
Willy Tarreau615c3012023-05-05 16:10:05 +02001364cpu-map [auto:]<thread-group>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>[,...] [...]
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001365 On some operating systems, it is possible to bind a thread group or a thread
1366 to a specific CPU set. This means that the designated threads will never run
1367 on other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for individual
1368 threads or thread groups. The first argument is a thread group range,
1369 optionally followed by a thread set. These ranges have the following format:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001370
1371 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1372
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001373 <number> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001374 word size. Any group IDs above 'thread-groups' and any thread IDs above the
1375 machine's word size are ignored. All thread numbers are relative to the group
1376 they belong to. It is possible to specify a range with two such number
1377 delimited by a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all threads at once
1378 using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just
1379 like with the "thread" bind directive. The second and forthcoming arguments
1380 are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the
Willy Tarreau615c3012023-05-05 16:10:05 +02001381 first CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). These
1382 CPU numbers and ranges may be repeated by delimiting them with commas or by
1383 passing more ranges as new arguments on the same line. Outside of Linux and
1384 BSD operating systems, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to
1385 either 31 or 63. Multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified, but each
1386 "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001387
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001388 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1389 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1390 on the machine's word size.
1391
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001392 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the thread set to let HAProxy
1393 automatically bind a set of threads to a CPU by incrementing threads and
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001394 CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same size. No matter the
1395 declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from the lowest to the
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001396 highest bound. Having both a group and a thread range with the "auto:"
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001397 prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one must be
1398 a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001399
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001400 Note that group ranges are supported for historical reasons. Nowadays, a lone
1401 number designates a thread group and must be 1 if thread-groups are not used,
1402 and specifying a thread range or number requires to prepend "1/" in front of
1403 it if thread groups are not used. Finally, "1" is strictly equivalent to
1404 "1/all" and designates all threads in the group.
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001405
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001406 Examples:
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001407 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first group on the
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001408 # first 4 CPUs
1409
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001410 cpu-map 1/1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1/1-64 0-63"
1411 # or "cpu-map 1/1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001412 # word size.
1413
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001414 # all these lines bind thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001415 # and so on.
1416 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1417 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1418 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
Willy Tarreau615c3012023-05-05 16:10:05 +02001419 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3,2,1,0
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001420
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001421 # bind each thread to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
1422 cpu-map auto:1/all 0-63
1423 cpu-map auto:1/even 0-31
1424 cpu-map auto:1/odd 32-63
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001425
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001426 # invalid cpu-map because thread and CPU sets have different sizes.
1427 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0 # invalid
1428 cpu-map auto:1/1 0-3 # invalid
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001429
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001430 # map 40 threads of those 4 groups to individual CPUs
1431 cpu-map auto:1/1-10 0-9
1432 cpu-map auto:2/1-10 10-19
1433 cpu-map auto:3/1-10 20-29
1434 cpu-map auto:4/1-10 30-39
1435
1436 # Map 80 threads to one physical socket and 80 others to another socket
1437 # without forcing assignment. These are split into 4 groups since no
1438 # group may have more than 64 threads.
Willy Tarreau615c3012023-05-05 16:10:05 +02001439 cpu-map 1/1-40 0-39,80-119 # node0, siblings 0 & 1
1440 cpu-map 2/1-40 0-39,80-119
1441 cpu-map 3/1-40 40-79,120-159 # node1, siblings 0 & 1
1442 cpu-map 4/1-40 40-79,120-159
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001443
1444
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001445crt-base <dir>
1446 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001447 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1448 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001449
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001450daemon
1451 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1452 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001453 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1454 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001455
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001456default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001457 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001458 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1459 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1460 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1461 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1462 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1463 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1464 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1465 not start with a slash ('/'):
1466 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1467 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1468
1469 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1470 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1471 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1472 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1473 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1474 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1475 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1476 each of them.
1477
1478 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1479 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1480 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1481 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1482 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1483 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1484 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1485 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1486
1487 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1488 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001489 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001490 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1491 made easily relocatable.
1492
1493 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1494 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1495 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1496 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1497 consistent across all configuration files.
1498
1499 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1500 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1501 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1502 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1503 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1504 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1505 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1506 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1507
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001508description <text>
1509 Add a text that describes the instance.
1510
1511 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1512 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1513 "<" and ">" characters.
1514
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001515deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1516 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001517 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001518
1519deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001520 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001521 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1522
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001523deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001524 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1525 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1526 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001527
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001528deviceatlas-separator <char>
1529 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1530 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1531
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001532expose-experimental-directives
1533 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1534 the config file will be rejected.
1535
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001536external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001537 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1538 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001539 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1540 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1541 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1542 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1543 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001544
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001545fd-hard-limit <number>
1546 Sets an upper bound to the maximum number of file descriptors that the
1547 process will use, regardless of system limits. While "ulimit-n" and "maxconn"
1548 may be used to enforce a value, when they are not set, the process will be
1549 limited to the hard limit of the RLIMIT_NOFILE setting as reported by
1550 "ulimit -n -H". But some modern operating systems are now allowing extremely
1551 large values here (in the order of 1 billion), which will consume way too
1552 much RAM for regular usage. The fd-hard-limit setting is provided to enforce
1553 a possibly lower bound to this limit. This means that it will always respect
1554 the system-imposed limits when they are below <number> but the specified
1555 value will be used if system-imposed limits are higher. In the example below,
1556 no other setting is specified and the maxconn value will automatically adapt
1557 to the lower of "fd-hard-limit" and the system-imposed limit:
1558
1559 global
1560 # use as many FDs as possible but no more than 50000
1561 fd-hard-limit 50000
1562
1563 See also: ulimit-n, maxconn
1564
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001565gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001566 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001567 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1568 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001569 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001570 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001571 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001572
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001573grace <time>
1574 Defines a delay between SIGUSR1 and real soft-stop.
1575
1576 Arguments :
1577 <time> is an extra delay (by default in milliseconds) after receipt of the
1578 SIGUSR1 signal that will be waited for before proceeding with the
1579 soft-stop operation.
1580
1581 This is used for compatibility with legacy environments where the haproxy
1582 process needs to be stopped but some external components need to detect the
1583 status before listeners are unbound. The principle is that the internal
1584 "stopping" variable (which is reported by the "stopping" sample fetch
1585 function) will be turned to true, but listeners will continue to accept
1586 connections undisturbed, until the delay expires, after what the regular
1587 soft-stop will proceed. This must not be used with processes that are
1588 reloaded, or this will prevent the old process from unbinding, and may
1589 prevent the new one from starting, or simply cause trouble.
1590
1591 Example:
1592
1593 global
1594 grace 10s
1595
1596 # Returns 200 OK until stopping is set via SIGUSR1
1597 frontend ext-check
1598 bind :9999
1599 monitor-uri /ext-check
1600 monitor fail if { stopping }
1601
1602 Please note that a more flexible and durable approach would instead consist
1603 for an orchestration system in setting a global variable from the CLI, use
1604 that variable to respond to external checks, then after a delay send the
1605 SIGUSR1 signal.
1606
1607 Example:
1608
1609 # Returns 200 OK until proc.stopping is set to non-zero. May be done
1610 # from HTTP using set-var(proc.stopping) or from the CLI using:
1611 # > set var proc.stopping int(1)
1612 frontend ext-check
1613 bind :9999
1614 monitor-uri /ext-check
1615 monitor fail if { var(proc.stopping) -m int gt 0 }
1616
1617 See also: hard-stop-after, monitor
1618
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001619group <group name>
1620 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1621 See also "gid" and "user".
1622
Christopher Faulet0f9c0f52022-05-13 09:20:13 +02001623h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
1624 Does not reject HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1625
1626 While It is explicitly allowed in HTTP/1.1, HTTP/1.0 is not clear on this
1627 point and some old servers don't expect any payload and never look for body
1628 length (via Content-Length or Transfer-Encoding headers). It means that some
1629 intermediaries may properly handle the payload for HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE
1630 requests, while some others may totally ignore it. That may lead to security
1631 issues because a request smuggling attack is possible. Thus, by default,
1632 HAProxy rejects HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1633
1634 However, it may be an issue with some old clients. In this case, this global
1635 option may be set.
1636
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001637h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1638 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1639 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1640 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1641 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001642 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001643 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1644 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1645 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1646 specified in a proxy.
1647
1648 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1649 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1650 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1651 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1652 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1653 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1654 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1655
1656 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1657 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1658 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1659 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1660 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1661
1662 Example:
1663 global
1664 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1665
1666 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1667 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1668
1669h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1670 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1671 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1672 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1673 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1674 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1675 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1676 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1677 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1678
1679 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1680 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1681 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1682
1683 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1684 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1685
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001686h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1687 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1688 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1689 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1690 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1691 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1692 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1693 the keyword with "no'.
1694
1695hard-stop-after <time>
1696 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1697
1698 Arguments :
1699 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1700 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1701 SIGUSR1 signal.
1702
1703 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1704 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1705 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1706
1707 Example:
1708 global
1709 hard-stop-after 30s
1710
1711 See also: grace
1712
William Lallemande279f592023-05-11 21:08:38 +02001713httpclient.resolvers.disabled <on|off>
1714 Disable the DNS resolution of the httpclient. Prevent the creation of the
1715 "default" resolvers section.
1716
1717 Default value is off.
1718
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001719httpclient.resolvers.id <resolvers id>
1720 This option defines the resolvers section with which the httpclient will try
1721 to resolve.
1722
1723 Default option is the "default" resolvers ID. By default, if this option is
1724 not used, it will simply disable the resolving if the section is not found.
1725
1726 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1727 configuration error if it fails to load.
1728
1729httpclient.resolvers.prefer <ipv4|ipv6>
1730 This option allows to chose which family of IP you want when resolving,
1731 which is convenient when IPv6 is not available on your network. Default
1732 option is "ipv6".
1733
William Lallemand4ad693e2023-09-05 15:55:04 +02001734httpclient.retries <number>
1735 This option allows to configure the number of retries attempt of the
1736 httpclient when a request failed. This does the same as the "retries" keyword
1737 in a backend.
1738
1739 Default value is 3.
1740
William Lallemandde1803f2022-05-04 18:14:25 +02001741httpclient.ssl.ca-file <cafile>
1742 This option defines the ca-file which should be used to verify the server
1743 certificate. It takes the same parameters as the "ca-file" option on the
1744 server line.
1745
1746 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
1747 "@system-ca" which tries to load the CA of the system. If it fails the SSL
1748 will be disabled for the httpclient.
1749
1750 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1751 configuration error if it fails.
1752
1753httpclient.ssl.verify [none|required]
1754 Works the same way as the verify option on server lines. If specified to 'none',
1755 servers certificates are not verified. Default option is "required".
1756
1757 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
1758 "required". If it fails the SSL will be disabled for the httpclient.
1759
1760 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1761 configuration error if it fails.
1762
William Lallemandb9ed1572023-09-05 16:42:27 +02001763httpclient.timeout.connect <timeout>
1764 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt by default for the
1765 httpclient.
1766
1767 Arguments :
1768 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
1769 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1770 as explained at the top of this document.
1771
1772 The default value is 5000ms.
1773
1774
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001775insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001776 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001777 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1778 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1779 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1780 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1781 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1782 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1783 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001784 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001785 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1786 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1787 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1788 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1789 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1790 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1791 disable it.
1792
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001793insecure-setuid-wanted
1794 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1795 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1796 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1797 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001798 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001799 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001800 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001801 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1802 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001803 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001804 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1805 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1806 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1807 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1808
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001809issuers-chain-path <dir>
1810 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1811 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1812 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001813 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001814 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1815 "issuers-chain-path".
1816 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1817 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1818 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1819 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1820 will share the chain in memory.
1821
Frédéric Lécailleffb67d52023-07-21 18:32:32 +02001822limited-quic
1823 This setting must be used to explicitly enable the QUIC listener bindings when
1824 haproxy is compiled against a TLS/SSL stack without QUIC support, typically
1825 OpenSSL. It has no effect when haproxy is compiled against a TLS/SSL stack
1826 with QUIC support, quictls for instance. Note that QUIC 0-RTT is not supported
1827 when this setting is set.
1828
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001829localpeer <name>
1830 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1831 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1832 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1833 the configuration parsing.
1834
1835 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1836 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1837
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001838log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001839 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001840 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001841 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001842 configured with "log global".
1843
1844 <address> can be one of:
1845
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001846 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001847 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1848 port).
1849
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001850 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1851 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1852 port).
1853
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001854 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001855 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1856 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001857 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001858
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001859 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1860 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1861 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1862 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1863 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1864 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1865 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1866 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1867 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1868 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001869 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001870 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1871 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1872 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001873 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1874 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001875
1876 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1877 "fd@2", see above.
1878
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001879 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1880 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1881 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1882 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1883 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1884
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001885 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1886 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001887
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001888 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1889 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1890 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1891 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1892 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1893 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1894 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1895 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1896 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1897 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001898 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1899 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001900
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001901 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1902 one of the following :
1903
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001904 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1905 field is stripped. This is the default.
1906 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1907 rfc3164.
1908
1909 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001910 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1911
1912 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1913 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1914
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001915 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1916 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1917 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1918 designed to be used with a local log server.
1919
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001920 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1921 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1922 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1923 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1924 logger consumes.
1925
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001926 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1927 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1928 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1929 used with a local log server.
1930
1931 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1932 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1933 designed to be used with a local log server.
1934
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001935 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1936 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1937 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1938 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1939
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001940 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1941 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1942 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1943 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1944 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1945
1946 <sample_size>
1947 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1948 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1949 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1950 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1951 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1952
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001953 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001954
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001955 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1956 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1957 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1958
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001959 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1960 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1961 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1962 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001963
1964 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001965 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1966 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1967 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1968 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1969 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1970 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001971
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001972 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001973
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001974log-send-hostname [<string>]
1975 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1976 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1977 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1978 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1979 the logs.
1980
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001981log-tag <string>
1982 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1983 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1984 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001985 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001986
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001987lua-load <file> [ <arg1> [ <arg2> [ ... ] ] ]
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001988 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1989 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1990 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1991 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1992 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1993 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001994 used multiple times.
1995
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +05001996 args are available in the lua file using the code below in the body of the
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001997 file. Do not forget that Lua arrays start at index 1. A "local" variable
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +05001998 declared in a file is available in the entire file and not available on
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001999 other files.
2000
2001 local args = table.pack(...)
2002
2003lua-load-per-thread <file> [ <arg1> [ <arg2> [ ... ] ] ]
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01002004 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
2005 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
2006 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
2007 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
2008 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
2009 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
2010 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
2011 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
2012 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
2013 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
2014 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
2015 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
2016 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
2017 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
2018 times.
2019
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02002020 See lua-load for usage of args.
2021
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01002022lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
2023 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
2024 variable.
2025 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
2026 to "path".
2027
2028 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
2029 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
2030 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
2031 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
2032 will be checked earlier.
2033
2034 As an example by specifying the following path:
2035
2036 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
2037 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
2038
2039 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
2040 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
2041 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
2042 paths if that does not exist either.
2043
2044 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
2045 documentation.
2046
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01002047master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02002048 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
2049 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
2050 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002051 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02002052 or daemon mode.
2053
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01002054 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
2055 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
2056 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
2057 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
2058 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02002059
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01002060 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02002061
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02002062mworker-max-reloads <number>
2063 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002064 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02002065 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
2066 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
2067 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
2068
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02002069nbthread <number>
2070 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002071 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. "nbthread" also works when HAProxy is
2072 started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity, the default
2073 "nbthread" value is automatically set to the number of CPUs the process is
2074 bound to upon startup. This means that the thread count can easily be
2075 adjusted from the calling process using commands like "taskset" or "cpuset".
2076 Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default value is reported in the
2077 output of "haproxy -vv".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02002078
Frédéric Lécaille12a03172023-01-12 15:23:54 +01002079no-quic
Frédéric Lécaille12a03172023-01-12 15:23:54 +01002080 Disable QUIC transport protocol. All the QUIC listeners will still be created.
2081 But they will not bind their addresses. Hence, no QUIC traffic will be
2082 processed by haproxy. See also "quic_enabled" sample fetch.
2083
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01002084numa-cpu-mapping
Amaury Denoyelleb09f4472021-12-15 09:48:39 +01002085 If running on a NUMA-aware platform, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU
2086 topology of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity
2087 is automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done
2088 in order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the
2089 inter-socket bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a
2090 particular architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no
2091 numa-cpu-mapping'. This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread
2092 statement is present in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is
2093 already specified, for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset
2094 utility.
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01002095
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002096pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09002097 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
2098 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
2099 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
2100 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002101
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02002102pp2-never-send-local
2103 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
2104 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
2105 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
2106 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
2107 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
2108 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
2109 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
2110 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
2111 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
2112 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
2113 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
2114
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002115presetenv <name> <value>
2116 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
2117 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
2118 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
2119 and "unsetenv".
2120
Patrick Hemmer425d7ad2023-05-23 13:02:08 -04002121prealloc-fd
2122 Performs a one-time open of the maximum file descriptor which results in a
2123 pre-allocation of the kernel's data structures. This prevents short pauses
2124 when nbthread>1 and HAProxy opens a file descriptor which requires the kernel
2125 to expand its data structures.
2126
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002127resetenv [<name> ...]
2128 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
2129 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
2130 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
2131 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
2132 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
2133 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
2134 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
2135 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
2136
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02002137server-state-base <directory>
2138 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002139 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
2140 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02002141
2142server-state-file <file>
2143 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
2144 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
2145 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
2146 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
2147 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
2148 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
2149 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
2150 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002151 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
2152 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02002153
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002154set-dumpable
2155 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
2156 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
2157 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
2158 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
2159 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
2160 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
2161 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
2162 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
2163 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
2164 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
2165 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
2166 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
2167 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
2168 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
2169 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
2170 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
2171 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
2172 leaves a core where expected when dying.
2173
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01002174set-var <var-name> <expr>
2175 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
2176 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
2177 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
2178 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
2179 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
2180 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02002181 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It is
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01002182 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
2183 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
2184
2185 Example:
2186 global
2187 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
2188 set-var proc.prio int(100)
2189 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
2190
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02002191set-var-fmt <var-name> <fmt>
2192 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the string resulting from the
2193 evaluation of the log-format <fmt>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
2194 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
2195 'set-var-fmt' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is
2196 evaluated at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly
2197 set. The sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression
2198 are only those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'.
2199 It is possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These
2200 variables will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
2201 Please see section 8.2.4 for details on the log-format syntax.
2202
2203 Example:
2204 global
2205 set-var-fmt proc.current_state "primary"
2206 set-var-fmt proc.bootid "%pid|%t"
2207
Willy Tarreaua547a212023-08-29 10:24:26 +02002208setcap <name>[,<name>...]
2209 Sets a list of capabilities that must be preserved when starting with uid 0
2210 and switching to a non-zero uid. By default all permissions are lost by the
2211 uid switch, but some are often needed when trying connecting to a server from
2212 a foreign address during transparent proxying, or when binding to a port
2213 below 1024, e.g. when using "tune.quic.socket-owner connection", resulting in
2214 setups running entirely under uid 0. Setting capabilities generally is a
2215 safer alternative, as only the required capabilities will be preserved. The
2216 feature is OS-specific and only enabled on Linux when USE_LINUX_CAP=1 is set
2217 at build time. The list of supported capabilities also depends on the OS and
2218 is enumerated by the error message displayed when an invalid capability name
2219 or an empty one is passed. Multiple capabilities may be passed, delimited by
2220 commas. Among those commonly used, "cap_net_raw" allows to transparently bind
2221 to a foreign address, and "cap_net_bind_service" allows to bind to a
2222 privileged port and may be used by QUIC.
2223
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002224setenv <name> <value>
2225 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
2226 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
2227 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
2228 and "unsetenv".
2229
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002230ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
2231 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2232 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00002233 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002234 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002235 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
2236 information and recommendations see e.g.
2237 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
2238 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
2239 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
2240 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002241
2242ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
2243 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
2244 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
2245 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
2246 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
2247 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002248 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
2249 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2250 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002251 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002252
William Lallemandb6ae2aa2023-05-05 00:05:46 +02002253ssl-default-bind-client-sigalgs <sigalgs>
2254 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2255 the default string describing the list of signature algorithms related to
2256 client authentication for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
2257 theirs. The format of the string is a colon-delimited list of signature
2258 algorithms. Each signature algorithm can use one of two forms: TLS1.3 signature
2259 scheme names ("rsa_pss_rsae_sha256") or the public key algorithm + digest form
2260 ("ECDSA+SHA256"). A list can contain both forms. For more information on the
2261 format, see SSL_CTX_set1_client_sigalgs(3). A list of signature algorithms is
2262 also available in RFC8446 section 4.2.3 and in OpenSSL in the ssl/t1_lib.c
2263 file. This setting is not applicable to TLSv1.1 and earlier versions of the
2264 protocol as the signature algorithms aren't separately negotiated in these
2265 versions. It is not recommended to change this setting unless compatibility
2266 with a middlebox is required.
2267
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02002268ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
2269 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2270 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
2271 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
2272 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
2273 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
2274
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002275ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
2276 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2277 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
2278 keyword to see available options.
2279
2280 Example:
2281 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02002282 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002283
William Lallemand1d3c8222023-05-04 15:33:55 +02002284ssl-default-bind-sigalgs <sigalgs>
2285 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
2286 sets the default string describing the list of signature algorithms that
2287 are negotiated during the TLSv1.2 and TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines
2288 which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is a
2289 colon-delimited list of signature algorithms. Each signature algorithm can
2290 use one of two forms: TLS1.3 signature scheme names ("rsa_pss_rsae_sha256")
2291 or the public key algorithm + digest form ("ECDSA+SHA256"). A list
2292 can contain both forms. For more information on the format,
2293 see SSL_CTX_set1_sigalgs(3). A list of signature algorithms is also
2294 available in RFC8446 section 4.2.3 and in OpenSSL in the ssl/t1_lib.c file.
2295 This setting is not applicable to TLSv1.1 and earlier versions of the
2296 protocol as the signature algorithms aren't separately negotiated in these
2297 versions. It is not recommended to change this setting unless compatibility
2298 with a middlebox is required.
2299
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002300ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
2301 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
2302 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00002303 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002304 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002305 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
2306 information and recommendations see e.g.
2307 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
2308 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
2309 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
2310 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
2311 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002312
2313ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
2314 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
2315 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
2316 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
2317 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
2318 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002319 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
2320 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2321 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
2322 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002323
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002324ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
2325 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2326 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
2327 keyword to see available options.
2328
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002329ssl-dh-param-file <file>
2330 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2331 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
2332 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002333 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002334 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02002335 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1d6338e2022-04-12 11:31:55 +02002336 directly in the certificate file, DHE ciphers will not be used, unless
2337 tune.ssl.default-dh-param is set. In this latter case, pre-defined DH
2338 parameters of the specified size will be used. Custom parameters are known to
2339 be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002340 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
2341 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
2342 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
2343
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone8097652022-05-16 16:24:32 +02002344ssl-propquery <query>
2345 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2346 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to define a default property
2347 string used when fetching algorithms in providers. It behave the same way as
2348 the openssl propquery option and it follows the same syntax (described in
2349 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man3.0/man7/property.html). For instance, if you
2350 have two providers loaded, the foo one and the default one, the propquery
2351 "?provider=foo" allows to pick the algorithm implementations provided by the
2352 foo provider by default, and to fallback on the default provider's one if it
2353 was not found.
2354
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002355ssl-provider <name>
2356 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2357 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to load a provider during init.
2358 If loading is successful, any capabilities provided by the loaded provider
2359 might be used by HAProxy. Multiple 'ssl-provider' options can be specified in
2360 a configuration file. The providers will be loaded in their order of
2361 appearance.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002362
2363 Please note that loading a provider explicitly prevents OpenSSL from loading
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002364 the 'default' provider automatically. OpenSSL also allows to define the
2365 providers that should be loaded directly in its configuration file
2366 (openssl.cnf for instance) so it is not necessary to use this 'ssl-provider'
2367 option to load providers. The "show ssl providers" CLI command can be used to
2368 show all the providers that were successfully loaded.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002369
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002370 The default search path of OpenSSL provider can be found in the output of the
2371 "openssl version -a" command. If the provider is in another directory, you
2372 can set the OPENSSL_MODULES environment variable, which takes the directory
2373 where your provider can be found.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002374
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonccc03552022-05-17 15:18:37 +02002375 See also "ssl-propquery" and "ssl-provider-path".
2376
2377ssl-provider-path <path>
2378 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2379 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to specify the search path that
2380 is to be used by OpenSSL for looking for providers. It behaves the same way
2381 as the OPENSSL_MODULES environment variable. It will be used for any
2382 following 'ssl-provider' option or until a new 'ssl-provider-path' is
2383 defined.
2384 See also "ssl-provider".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002385
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002386ssl-load-extra-del-ext
2387 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
2388 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002389 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002390 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002391 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
2392
2393 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002394
2395 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
2396 and won't try to remove them.
2397
2398 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
2399
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002400ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002401 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002402 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
2403 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
2404 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002405
2406 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
2407 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
2408 optimize the startup time.
2409
2410 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
2411 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
2412 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
2413
2414 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002415 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002416
2417 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002418 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
2419 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002420
2421 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
2422 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
2423 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
2424 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
2425 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002426 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002427
2428 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002429 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002430 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
2431 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
2432 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
2433 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
2434 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002435 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002436
2437 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
2438
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002439 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002440 a cert bundle.
2441
2442 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
2443 separately in several "crt".
2444
2445 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
2446 since files are loading separately.
2447
2448 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
2449 required to commit them.
2450
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02002451 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002452 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002453
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002454 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2455 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2456 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002457
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002458 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2459 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2460 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002461
2462 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002463 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2464 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002465
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002466 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2467 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2468
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002469 The default behavior is "all".
2470
2471 Example:
2472 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2473 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2474 ssl-load-extra-files none
2475
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002476 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2477 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002478
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002479ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2480 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2481 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2482 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2483
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002484ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002485 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002486 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2487 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2488 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2489 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2490 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2491 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002492 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002493
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002494stats maxconn <connections>
2495 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2496 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2497
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002498stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2499 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2500 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2501 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002502 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002503 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002504
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002505 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2506 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2507 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002508
2509stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2510 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2511 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002512 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002513
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002514strict-limits
2515 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
2516 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2517 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2518 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2519 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002520
Willy Tarreaud04bc3a2021-09-27 13:55:10 +02002521thread-group <group> [<thread-range>...]
2522 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2523 enumerates the list of threads that will compose thread group <group>.
2524 Thread numbers and group numbers start at 1. Thread ranges are defined either
2525 using a single thread number at once, or by specifying the lower and upper
2526 bounds delimited by a dash '-' (e.g. "1-16"). Unassigned threads will be
2527 automatically assigned to unassigned thread groups, and thread groups
2528 defined with this directive will never receive more threads than those
2529 defined. Defining the same group multiple times overrides previous
2530 definitions with the new one. See also "nbthread" and "thread-groups".
2531
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002532thread-groups <number>
2533 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2534 makes HAProxy split its threads into <number> independent groups. At the
Willy Tarreau856d56d2022-07-15 21:46:55 +02002535 moment, the default value is 1. Thread groups make it possible to reduce
2536 sharing between threads to limit contention, at the expense of some extra
2537 configuration efforts. It is also the only way to use more than 64 threads
2538 since up to 64 threads per group may be configured. The maximum number of
2539 groups is configured at compile time and defaults to 16. See also "nbthread".
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002540
Willy Tarreau9fd05422022-11-16 17:29:12 +01002541trace <args...>
2542 This command configures one "trace" subsystem statement. Each of them can be
2543 found in the management manual, and follow the exact same syntax. Only one
2544 statement per line is permitted (i.e. if some long trace configurations using
2545 semi-colons are to be imported, they must be placed one per line). Any output
2546 that the "trace" command would produce will be emitted during the parsing
2547 step of the section. Most of the time these will be errors and warnings, but
2548 certain incomplete commands might list permissible choices. This command is
2549 not meant for regular use, it will generally only be suggested by developers
2550 along complex debugging sessions. For this reason it is internally marked as
2551 experimental, meaning that "expose-experimental-directives" must appear on a
2552 line before any "trace" statement. Note that these directives are parsed on
2553 the fly, so referencing a ring buffer that is only declared further will not
2554 work. For such use cases it is suggested to place another "global" section
2555 with only the "trace" statements after the declaration of that ring. It is
2556 important to keep in mind that depending on the trace level and details,
2557 enabling traces can severely degrade the global performance. Please refer to
2558 the management manual for the statements syntax.
2559
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002560uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002561 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002562 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2563 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2564 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2565
2566ulimit-n <number>
2567 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2568 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002569 option. If the intent is only to limit the number of file descriptors, better
2570 use "fd-hard-limit" instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002571
Amaury Denoyelle414a6122021-08-06 10:25:32 +02002572 Note that the dynamic servers are not taken into account in this automatic
2573 resource calculation. If using a large number of them, it may be needed to
2574 manually specify this value.
2575
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002576 See also: fd-hard-limit, maxconn
2577
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002578unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2579 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2580
2581 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2582 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2583 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2584 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2585 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002586 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002587 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2588 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2589 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2590 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2591
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002592unsetenv [<name> ...]
2593 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2594 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2595 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2596 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2597 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2598 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2599 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2600
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002601user <user name>
2602 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2603 See also "uid" and "group".
2604
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002605node <name>
2606 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2607
2608 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2609 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2610 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2611 traffic.
2612
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002613wurfl-cache-size <size>
2614 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2615 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
2616 - "0" : no cache is used.
2617 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002618
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002619 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
2620 with USE_WURFL=1.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002621
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002622wurfl-data-file <file path>
2623 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2624 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2625
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002626 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002627 with USE_WURFL=1.
2628
2629wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2630 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2631 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2632 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2633
2634 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2635
2636 Valid WURFL properties are:
2637 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2638
2639 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2640 device.
2641
2642 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2643 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2644
2645 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2646 particular web request.
2647
2648 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2649 used Libwurfl API version.
2650
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002651 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2652 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2653
2654 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2655 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2656
2657 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2658
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002659 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002660 with USE_WURFL=1.
2661
2662wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2663 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2664 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2665
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002666 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002667 with USE_WURFL=1.
2668
2669wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2670 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2671 thus before the chroot.
2672
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002673 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002674 with USE_WURFL=1.
2675
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026763.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002677-----------------------
2678
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002679busy-polling
2680 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2681 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2682 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2683 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2684 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2685 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2686 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2687 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2688 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2689 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2690 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2691 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2692 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2693 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2694 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2695 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2696 "poll" pollers.
2697
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002698 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2699 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2700 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2701
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002702max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002703 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002704 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2705 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2706 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2707 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2708 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2709 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2710 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2711
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002712maxcompcpuusage <number>
2713 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2714 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2715 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2716 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2717 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2718 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2719 and from introducing high latencies.
2720
2721maxcomprate <number>
2722 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
2723 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
2724 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2725 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2726 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
2727 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
2728 default value.
2729
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002730maxconn <number>
2731 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2732 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2733 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002734 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2735 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2736 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2737 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002738 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2739 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2740 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2741 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2742 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002743 also be automatic). In any case, the fd-hard-limit applies if set.
2744
2745 See also: fd-hard-limit, ulimit-n
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002746
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002747maxconnrate <number>
2748 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2749 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2750 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2751 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2752 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2753 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2754 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2755 fairness.
2756
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002757maxpipes <number>
2758 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2759 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2760 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2761 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2762 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2763 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2764
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002765maxsessrate <number>
2766 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2767 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2768 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2769 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2770 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2771 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2772 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2773 fairness.
2774
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002775maxsslconn <number>
2776 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2777 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2778 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2779 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2780 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2781 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2782 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002783 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2784 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2785 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2786 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002787 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002788 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2789 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002790
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002791maxsslrate <number>
2792 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2793 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2794 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2795 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2796 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2797 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2798 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2799 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2800 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2801 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2802
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002803maxzlibmem <number>
2804 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2805 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2806 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002807 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2808 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2809 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2810
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002811no-memory-trimming
2812 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2813 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2814 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2815 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2816 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2817 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2818 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2819 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2820 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2821 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2822 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2823 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2824 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2825 not suffer from such a problem.
2826
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002827noepoll
2828 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2829 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002830 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002831
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002832noevports
2833 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2834 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2835 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2836 also "nopoll".
2837
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002838nogetaddrinfo
2839 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2840 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2841
2842nokqueue
2843 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2844 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2845 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2846
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002847nopoll
2848 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2849 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002850 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002851 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2852 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002853
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002854noreuseport
2855 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2856 command line argument "-dR".
2857
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002858nosplice
2859 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002860 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002861 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002862 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002863 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2864 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2865 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2866 "option splice-response".
2867
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002868profiling.memory { on | off }
2869 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2870 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2871 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2872 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2873 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2874 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2875 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2876 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2877 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2878
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002879profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2880 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2881 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2882 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2883 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002884 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002885 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2886 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2887 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2888 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2889
2890 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2891 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2892 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2893 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2894 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002895 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2896 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2897 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2898 CLI.
2899
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002900spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002901 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2902 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2903 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2904 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2905 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2906 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002907
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002908ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002909 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002910 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002911 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002912 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002913 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2914 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2915 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002916 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2917 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002918 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2919 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2920 openssl configuration file uses:
2921 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2922
Aleksandar Lazic89fb2102022-07-27 15:24:54 +02002923 HAProxy Version 2.6 disabled the support for engines in the default build.
2924 This option is only available when HAProxy has been built with support for
2925 it. In case the ssl-engine is required HAProxy can be rebuild with the
2926 USE_ENGINE=1 flag.
2927
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002928ssl-mode-async
2929 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002930 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002931 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2932 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002933 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002934 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002935 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002936
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002937tune.buffers.limit <number>
2938 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2939 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2940 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2941 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2942 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002943 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002944 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2945 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2946 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2947 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2948 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2949 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2950 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2951 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002952 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002953
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002954tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2955 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2956 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2957 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002958 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002959
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002960tune.bufsize <number>
2961 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2962 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2963 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2964 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2965 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2966 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2967 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002968 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2969 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002970 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002971 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002972 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002973 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2974 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002975
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002976tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2977 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2978 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2979 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2980 this value. The default value is 1.
2981
Christopher Faulet2f7c82b2023-02-20 14:06:52 +01002982tune.disable-fast-forward [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2983 Disables the data fast-forwarding. It is a mechanism to optimize the data
2984 forwarding by passing data directly from a side to the other one without
2985 waking the stream up. Thanks to this directive, it is possible to disable
2986 this optimization. Note it also disable any kernel tcp splicing. This command
2987 is not meant for regular use, it will generally only be suggested by
2988 developers along complex debugging sessions. For this reason it is internally
2989 marked as experimental, meaning that "expose-experimental-directives" must
2990 appear on a line before this directive.
2991
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002992tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreauf4b79c42022-02-23 15:20:53 +01002993 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC or started with "-dMfail", gives the
2994 percentage of chances an allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no
2995 failure) and 100 (no success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory
Willy Tarreau0c4348c2023-03-21 09:24:53 +01002996 failures are handled gracefully. When not set, the ratio is 0. However the
2997 command-line "-dMfail" option automatically sets it to 1% failure rate so that
2998 it is not necessary to change the configuration for testing.
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002999
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02003000tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
3001 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
3002 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
3003 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
3004 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
3005 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
3006
Willy Tarreau9d7abda2023-04-17 15:04:34 +02003007tune.h2.be.initial-window-size <number>
3008 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size for outgoing connections, which is the
3009 number of bytes the server can respond before waiting for an acknowledgment
3010 from HAProxy. This setting only affects payload contents, not headers. When
3011 not set, the common default value set by tune.h2.initial-window-size applies.
3012 It can make sense to slightly increase this value to allow faster downloads
3013 or to reduce CPU usage on the servers, at the expense of creating unfairness
3014 between clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
Tim Duesterhuse3ebe0e2023-06-13 15:15:47 +02003015
Willy Tarreau9d7abda2023-04-17 15:04:34 +02003016 See also: tune.h2.initial-window-size.
3017
Willy Tarreauca1027c2023-04-18 15:57:03 +02003018tune.h2.be.max-concurrent-streams <number>
3019 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per outgoing connection
3020 (i.e. the number of outstanding requests on a single connection to a server).
3021 When not set, the default set by tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams applies. A
3022 smaller value than the default 100 may improve a site's responsiveness at the
3023 expense of maintaining more established connections to the servers. When the
3024 "http-reuse" setting is set to "always", it is recommended to reduce this
3025 value so as not to mix too many different clients over the same connection,
3026 because if a client is slower than others, a mechanism known as "head of
3027 line blocking" tends to cause cascade effect on download speed for all
3028 clients sharing a connection (keep tune.h2.be.initial-window-size low in this
3029 case). It is highly recommended not to increase this value; some might find
3030 it optimal to run at low values (1..5 typically).
3031
Willy Tarreau9d7abda2023-04-17 15:04:34 +02003032tune.h2.fe.initial-window-size <number>
3033 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size for incoming connections, which is the
3034 number of bytes the client can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment
3035 from HAProxy. This setting only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of
3036 POST requests), not headers. When not set, the common default value set by
3037 tune.h2.initial-window-size applies. It can make sense to increase this value
3038 to allow faster uploads. The default value of 65536 allows up to 5 Mbps of
3039 bandwidth per client over a 100 ms ping time, and 500 Mbps for 1 ms ping
3040 time. It doesn't affect resource usage. Using too large values may cause
3041 clients to experience a lack of responsiveness if pages are accessed in
Tim Duesterhuse3ebe0e2023-06-13 15:15:47 +02003042 parallel to large uploads.
3043
3044 See also: tune.h2.initial-window-size.
Willy Tarreau9d7abda2023-04-17 15:04:34 +02003045
Willy Tarreauca1027c2023-04-18 15:57:03 +02003046tune.h2.fe.max-concurrent-streams <number>
3047 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per incoming connection
3048 (i.e. the number of outstanding requests on a single connection from a
3049 client). When not set, the default set by tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
3050 applies. A larger value than the default 100 may sometimes slightly improve
3051 the page load time for complex sites with lots of small objects over high
3052 latency networks but can also result in using more memory by allowing a
3053 client to allocate more resources at once. The default value of 100 is
3054 generally good and it is recommended not to change this value.
3055
Willy Tarreau4869ed52023-10-13 18:11:59 +02003056tune.h2.fe.max-total-streams <number>
3057 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of total streams processed per incoming
3058 connection. Once this limit is reached, HAProxy will send a graceful GOAWAY
3059 frame informing the client that it will close the connection after all
3060 pending streams have been closed. In practice, clients tend to close as fast
3061 as possible when receiving this, and to establish a new connection for next
3062 requests. Doing this is sometimes useful and desired in situations where
3063 clients stay connected for a very long time and cause some imbalance inside a
3064 farm. For example, in some highly dynamic environments, it is possible that
3065 new load balancers are instantiated on the fly to adapt to a load increase,
3066 and that once the load goes down they should be stopped without breaking
3067 established connections. By setting a limit here, the connections will have
3068 a limited lifetime and will be frequently renewed, with some possibly being
3069 established to other nodes, so that existing resources are quickly released.
3070
3071 It's important to understand that there is an implicit relation between this
3072 limit and "tune.h2.fe.max-concurrent-streams" above. Indeed, HAProxy will
3073 always accept to process any possibly pending streams that might be in flight
3074 between the client and the frontend, so the advertised limit will always
3075 automatically be raised by the value configured in max-concurrent-streams,
3076 and this value will serve as a hard limit above which a violation by a non-
3077 compliant client will result in the connection being closed. Thus when
3078 counting the number of requests per connection from the logs, any number
3079 between max-total-streams and (max-total-streams + max-concurrent-streams)
3080 may be observed depending on how fast streams are created by the client.
3081
3082 The default value is zero, which enforces no limit beyond those implied by
3083 the protocol (2^30 ~= 1.07 billion). Values around 1000 may already cause
3084 frequent connection renewal without causing any perceptible latency to most
3085 clients. Setting it too low may result in an increase of CPU usage due to
3086 frequent TLS reconnections, in addition to increased page load time. Please
3087 note that some load testing tools do not support reconnections and may report
3088 errors with this setting; as such it may be needed to disable it when running
3089 performance benchmarks. See also "tune.h2.fe.max-concurrent-streams".
3090
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02003091tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
3092 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
3093 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
3094 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
3095 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
3096 change it.
3097
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02003098tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
Willy Tarreau9d7abda2023-04-17 15:04:34 +02003099 Sets the default value for the HTTP/2 initial window size, on both incoming
3100 and outgoing connections. This value is used for incoming connections when
3101 tune.h2.fe.initial-window-size is not set, and by outgoing connections when
3102 tune.h2.be.initial-window-size is not set. The default value is 65536, which
3103 for uploads roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of bandwidth per client over a
3104 network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps over a 1-ms local network.
3105 Given that changing the default value will both increase upload speeds and
3106 cause more unfairness between clients on downloads, it is recommended to
3107 instead use the side-specific settings tune.h2.fe.initial-window-size and
3108 tune.h2.be.initial-window-size.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02003109
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02003110tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
Willy Tarreauca1027c2023-04-18 15:57:03 +02003111 Sets the default HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection
Willy Tarreau2fefab62023-05-07 07:10:55 +02003112 (i.e. the number of outstanding requests on a single connection). This value
Willy Tarreauca1027c2023-04-18 15:57:03 +02003113 is used for incoming connections when tune.h2.fe.max-concurrent-streams is
3114 not set, and for outgoing connections when tune.h2.be.max-concurrent-streams
3115 is not set. The default value is 100. The impact varies depending on the side
3116 so please see the two settings above for more details. It is recommended not
3117 to use this setting and to switch to the per-side ones instead. A value of
3118 zero disables the limit so a single client may create as many streams as
3119 allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02003120
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01003121tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003122 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01003123 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003124 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01003125 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
3126 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
3127 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
3128 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
3129
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003130tune.http.cookielen <number>
3131 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
3132 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
3133 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
3134 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
3135 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
3136 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
3137 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
3138 to change this value.
3139
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02003140tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003141 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
3142 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02003143 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003144 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02003145 configuration directives too.
3146 The default value is 1024.
3147
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02003148tune.http.maxhdr <number>
3149 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
3150 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
3151 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
3152 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
3153 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
3154 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02003155 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
3156 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
3157 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02003158
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02003159tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
3160 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
3161 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
3162 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
3163 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
3164 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
3165 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01003166 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
3167 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
3168 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
3169 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
3170 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02003171
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01003172tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003173 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01003174 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
3175 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
3176 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
3177 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003178 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003179 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003180 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01003181 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
3182
Willy Tarreau73101642023-04-22 22:06:23 +02003183tune.listener.default-shards { by-process | by-thread | by-group }
3184 Normally, all "bind" lines will create a single shard, that is, a single
3185 socket that all threads of the process will listen to. With many threads,
3186 this is not very efficient, and may even induce some important overhead in
3187 the kernel for updating the polling state or even distributing events to the
3188 various threads. Modern operating systems support balancing of incoming
3189 connections, a mechanism that will consist in permitting multiple sockets to
3190 be bound to the same address and port, and to evenly distribute all incoming
3191 connections to these sockets so that each thread only sees the connections
3192 that are waiting in the socket it is bound to. This significantly reduces
3193 kernel-side overhead and increases performance in the incoming connection
3194 path. This is usually enabled in HAProxy using the "shards" setting on "bind"
3195 lines, which defaults to 1, meaning that each listener will be unique in the
3196 process. On systems with many processors, it may be more convenient to change
3197 the default setting to "by-thread" in order to always create one listening
3198 socket per thread, or "by-group" in order to always create one listening
3199 socket per thread group. Be careful about the file descriptor usage with
3200 "by-thread" as each listener will need as many sockets as there are threads.
3201 Also some operating systems (e.g. FreeBSD) are limited to no more than 256
3202 sockets on a same address. Note that "by-group" will remain equivalent to
3203 "by-process" for default configurations involving a single thread group, and
3204 will fall back to sharing the same socket on systems that do not support this
Willy Tarreau0e875cf2023-04-23 00:51:59 +02003205 mechanism. The default is "by-group" with a fallback to "by-process" for
3206 systems or socket families that do not support multiple bindings.
Willy Tarreau73101642023-04-22 22:06:23 +02003207
Willy Tarreau84fe1f42023-04-20 15:40:38 +02003208tune.listener.multi-queue { on | fair | off }
3209 Enables ('on' / 'fair') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept
3210 which spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to
3211 run on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01003212 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
3213 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
Willy Tarreau84fe1f42023-04-20 15:40:38 +02003214 with one thread for example). The default mode, "on", optimizes the choice of
3215 a thread by picking in a sample the one with the less connections. It is
3216 often the best choice when connections are long-lived as it manages to keep
3217 all threads busy. A second mode, "fair", instead cycles through all threads
3218 regardless of their instant load level. It can be better suited for short-
3219 lived connections, or on machines with very large numbers of threads where
3220 the probability to find the least loaded thread with the first mode is low.
3221 Finally it is possible to forcefully disable the redistribution mechanism
3222 using "off" for troubleshooting, or for situations where connections are
Willy Tarreau2fefab62023-05-07 07:10:55 +02003223 short-lived and it is estimated that the operating system already provides a
Willy Tarreau84fe1f42023-04-20 15:40:38 +02003224 good enough distribution. The default is "on".
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01003225
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003226tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
3227 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003228 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003229 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
3230 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003231 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003232 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
3233 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
3234
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01003235tune.lua.maxmem
3236 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
3237 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
3238 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
3239 memory.
3240
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003241tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
3242 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02003243 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
3244 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003245 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003246
Aurelien DARRAGON58e36e52023-04-06 22:51:56 +02003247tune.lua.burst-timeout <timeout>
3248 The "burst" execution timeout applies to any Lua handler. If the handler
3249 fails to finish or yield before timeout is reached, it will be aborted to
3250 prevent thread contention, to prevent traffic from not being served for too
3251 long, and ultimately to prevent the process from crashing because of the
3252 watchdog kicking in. Unlike other lua timeouts which are yield-cumulative,
3253 burst-timeout will ensure that the time spent in a single lua execution
3254 window does not exceed the configured timeout.
3255
3256 Yielding here means that the lua execution is effectively interrupted
3257 either through an explicit call to lua-yielding function such as
3258 core.(m)sleep() or core.yield(), or following an automatic forced-yield
3259 (see tune.lua.forced-yield) and that it will be resumed later when the
3260 related task is set for rescheduling. Not all lua handlers may yield: we have
3261 to make a distinction between yieldable handlers and unyieldable handlers.
3262
3263 For yieldable handlers (tasks, actions..), reaching the timeout means
3264 "tune.lua.forced-yield" might be too high for the system, reducing it
3265 could improve the situation, but it could also be a good idea to check if
3266 adding manual yields at some key points within the lua function helps or not.
3267 It may also indicate that the handler is spending too much time in a specific
3268 lua library function that cannot be interrupted.
3269
3270 For unyieldable handlers (lua converters, sample fetches), it could simply
3271 indicate that the handler is doing too much computation, which could result
3272 from an improper design given that such handlers, which often block the
3273 request execution flow, are expected to terminate quickly to allow the
3274 request processing to go through. A common resolution approach here would be
3275 to try to better optimize the lua function for speed since decreasing
3276 "tune.lua.forced-yield" won't help.
3277
3278 This timeout only counts the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a core.sleep,
3279 the sleeping time is not taken in account. The default timeout is 1000ms.
3280
3281 Note: if a lua GC cycle is initiated from the handler (either explicitly
3282 requested or automatically triggered by lua after some time), the GC cycle
3283 time will also be accounted for.
3284
3285 Indeed, there is no way to deduce the GC cycle time, so this could lead to
3286 some false positives on saturated systems (where GC is having hard time to
3287 catch up and consumes most of the available execution runtime). If it were
3288 to be the case, here are some resolution leads:
3289
3290 - checking if the script could be optimized to reduce lua memory footprint
3291 - fine-tuning lua GC parameters and / or requesting manual GC cycles
3292 (see: https://www.lua.org/manual/5.4/manual.html#pdf-collectgarbage)
3293 - increasing tune.lua.burst-timeout
3294
3295 Setting value to 0 completely disables this protection.
3296
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02003297tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
3298 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
3299 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
3300 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003301 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02003302
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01003303tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
3304 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
3305 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
3306 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
3307 check servers.
3308
Tristan2632d042023-10-23 13:07:39 +01003309tune.lua.log.loggers { on | off }
3310 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') logging the output of LUA scripts via the
3311 loggers applicable to the current proxy, if any.
3312
3313 Defaults to 'on'.
3314
3315tune.lua.log.stderr { on | auto | off }
3316 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') logging the output of LUA scripts via
3317 stderr.
3318 When set to 'auto', logging via stderr is conditionally 'on' if any of:
3319
3320 - tune.lua.log.loggers is set to 'off'
3321 - the script is executed in a non-proxy context with no global logger
3322 - the script is executed in a proxy context with no logger attached
3323
3324 Please note that, when enabled, this logging is in addition to the logging
3325 configured via tune.lua.log.loggers.
3326
3327 Defaults to 'on'.
3328
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01003329tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01003330 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
3331 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01003332 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
3333 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
3334 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
3335 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
3336 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
3337 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
3338 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
3339 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
3340 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01003341
3342tune.maxpollevents <number>
3343 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
3344 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
3345 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
3346 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
3347 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
3348
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02003349tune.maxrewrite <number>
3350 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
3351 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
3352 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
3353 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
3354 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
3355 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
3356 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
3357 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
3358 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
3359 bufsize.
3360
Willy Tarreau284cfc62022-12-19 08:15:57 +01003361tune.memory.hot-size <number>
3362 Sets the per-thread amount of memory that will be kept hot in the local cache
3363 and will never be recoverable by other threads. Access to this memory is very
3364 fast (lockless), and having enough is critical to maintain a good performance
3365 level under extreme thread contention. The value is expressed in bytes, and
3366 the default value is configured at build time via CONFIG_HAP_POOL_CACHE_SIZE
3367 which defaults to 524288 (512 kB). A larger value may increase performance in
3368 some usage scenarios, especially when performance profiles show that memory
3369 allocation is stressed a lot. Experience shows that a good value sits between
3370 once to twice the per CPU core L2 cache size. Too large values will have a
3371 negative impact on performance by making inefficient use of the L3 caches in
3372 the CPUs, and will consume larger amounts of memory. It is recommended not to
3373 change this value, or to proceed in small increments. In order to completely
3374 disable the per-thread CPU caches, using a very small value could work, but
3375 it is better to use "-dMno-cache" on the command-line.
3376
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02003377tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
3378 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
3379 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
3380 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
3381 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
3382 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
3383 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
3384 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
3385 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
3386 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02003387 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
3388 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02003389 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
3390 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
3391 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
3392 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
3393 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
3394 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
3395 setting this parameter to 0.
3396
Willy Tarreau8bd146d2022-07-19 20:17:38 +02003397tune.peers.max-updates-at-once <number>
3398 Sets the maximum number of stick-table updates that haproxy will try to
3399 process at once when sending messages. Retrieving the data for these updates
3400 requires some locking operations which can be CPU intensive on highly
3401 threaded machines if unbound, and may also increase the traffic latency
3402 during the initial batched transfer between an older and a newer process.
3403 Conversely low values may also incur higher CPU overhead, and take longer
3404 to complete. The default value is 200 and it is suggested not to change it.
3405
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02003406tune.pipesize <number>
3407 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
3408 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
3409 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
3410 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
3411 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
3412 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
3413
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003414tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
3415 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003416 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003417 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
3418 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
3419 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
3420 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003421 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003422
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02003423tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
3424 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003425 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02003426 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
3427 default is 20.
3428
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02003429tune.quic.frontend.conn-tx-buffers.limit <number>
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02003430 This settings defines the maximum number of buffers allocated for a QUIC
3431 connection on data emission. By default, it is set to 30. QUIC buffers are
3432 drained on ACK reception. This setting has a direct impact on the throughput
3433 and memory consumption and can be adjusted according to an estimated round
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02003434 time-trip. Each buffer is tune.bufsize.
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02003435
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02003436tune.quic.frontend.max-idle-timeout <timeout>
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02003437 Sets the QUIC max_idle_timeout transport parameters in milliseconds for
3438 frontends which determines the period of time after which a connection silently
3439 closes if it has remained inactive during an effective period of time deduced
3440 from the two max_idle_timeout values announced by the two endpoints:
3441 - the minimum of the two values if both are not null,
3442 - the maximum if only one of them is not null,
3443 - if both values are null, this feature is disabled.
3444
3445 The default value is 30000.
3446
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02003447tune.quic.frontend.max-streams-bidi <number>
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02003448 Sets the QUIC initial_max_streams_bidi transport parameter for frontends.
3449 This is the initial maximum number of bidirectional streams the remote peer
3450 will be authorized to open. This determines the number of concurrent client
3451 requests.
3452
3453 The default value is 100.
3454
Amaury Denoyelle24d5b722023-01-31 11:44:50 +01003455tune.quic.max-frame-loss <number>
Amaury Denoyelle24d5b722023-01-31 11:44:50 +01003456 Sets the limit for which a single QUIC frame can be marked as lost. If
3457 exceeded, the connection is considered as failing and is closed immediately.
3458
3459 The default value is 10.
3460
Frederic Lecaillef1724f42024-02-13 19:38:46 +01003461tune.quic.reorder-ratio <0..100, in percent>
3462 The ratio applied to the packet reordering threshold calculated. It may
3463 trigger a high packet loss detection when too small.
3464
3465 The default value is 50.
3466
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003467tune.quic.retry-threshold <number>
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003468 Dynamically enables the Retry feature for all the configured QUIC listeners
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02003469 as soon as this number of half open connections is reached. A half open
3470 connection is a connection whose handshake has not already successfully
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003471 completed or failed. To be functional this setting needs a cluster secret to
3472 be set, if not it will be silently ignored (see "cluster-secret" setting).
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02003473 This setting will be also silently ignored if the use of QUIC Retry was
3474 forced (see "quic-force-retry").
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003475
3476 The default value is 100.
3477
3478 See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9000.html#section-8.1.2 for more
3479 information about QUIC retry.
3480
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003481tune.quic.socket-owner { listener | connection }
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003482 Specifies how QUIC connections will use socket for receive/send operations.
3483 Connections can share listener socket or each connection can allocate its
3484 own socket.
3485
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003486 When default "connection" value is set, a dedicated socket will be allocated
3487 by every QUIC connections. This option is the preferred one to achieve the
Amaury Denoyellefb375572023-02-01 09:28:32 +01003488 best performance with a large QUIC traffic. This is also the only way to
Amaury Denoyellee1a0ee32023-02-28 15:11:09 +01003489 ensure soft-stop is conducted properly without data loss for QUIC connections
3490 and cases of transient errors during sendto() operation are handled
3491 efficiently. However, this relies on some advanced features from the UDP
Amaury Denoyellefb375572023-02-01 09:28:32 +01003492 network stack. If your platform is deemed not compatible, haproxy will
Willy Tarreau2a3d9282023-08-29 10:22:46 +02003493 automatically switch to "listener" mode on startup. Please note that QUIC
3494 listeners running on privileged ports may require to run as uid 0, or some
Willy Tarreaua547a212023-08-29 10:24:26 +02003495 OS-specific tuning to permit the target uid to bind such ports, such as
3496 system capabilities. See also the "setcap" global directive.
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003497
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003498 The "listener" value indicates that QUIC transfers will occur on the shared
3499 listener socket. This option can be a good compromise for small traffic as it
3500 allows to reduce FD consumption. However, performance won't be optimal due to
Ilya Shipitsin5fa29b82022-12-07 09:46:19 +05003501 a higher CPU usage if listeners are shared across a lot of threads or a
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003502 large number of QUIC connections can be used simultaneously.
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003503
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003504tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
3505tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
3506 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
3507 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
3508 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003509 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003510 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003511 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
3512 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
3513
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01003514tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003515 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01003516 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
3517 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
3518 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
3519 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
3520
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02003521tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003522 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01003523 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
3524 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
3525 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
3526 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
3527 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
3528 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
3529 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02003530
3531tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
3532 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003533 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02003534 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
3535 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
3536 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
3537 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
3538 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
3539 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
3540 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02003541
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003542tune.sndbuf.client <number>
3543tune.sndbuf.server <number>
3544 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
3545 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
3546 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003547 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003548 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003549 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
3550 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
3551 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
3552 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003553 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003554
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01003555tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01003556 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01003557 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
3558 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
3559 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
3560 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
3561 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
3562 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
3563 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
3564 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
3565 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02003566 pre-allocated upon startup. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session
3567 cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01003568
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01003569tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size <number>
3570tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number> (deprecated)
3571 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
3572 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
3573 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
3574 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
3575
3576tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
3577 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
3578 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
3579 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
3580 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
3581 this maximum value. Only 1024 or higher values are allowed. Higher values
3582 will increase the CPU load, and values greater than 1024 bits are not
3583 supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not used if static
3584 Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly in the certificate
3585 file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
3586 If there is neither a default-dh-param nor a ssl-dh-param-file defined, and
3587 if the server's PEM file of a given frontend does not specify its own DH
3588 parameters, then DHE ciphers will be unavailable for this frontend.
3589
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02003590tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02003591 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02003592 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
3593 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
3594 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
3595 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
3596 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
3597
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02003598tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord <number>
3599 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at any time. Default
3600 value 0 means there is no limit. In contrast to tune.ssl.maxrecord this
3601 settings will not be adjusted dynamically. Smaller records may decrease
3602 throughput, but may be required when dealing with low-footprint clients.
3603
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02003604tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
3605 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
3606 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
3607 performances. This is disabled by default.
3608
3609 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
3610 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
3611
3612 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
3613
3614 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
3615
3616 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
3617
3618 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
3619 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
3620 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
3621
3622 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
3623 converted.
3624
3625 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
3626 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
3627 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
3628 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
3629 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
3630 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
3631 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02003632 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
3633 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02003634
3635 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
3636
3637 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
3638 only need this line:
3639
3640 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
3641
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003642tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
3643 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003644 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003645 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
3646 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
3647 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
3648 being used for too long.
3649
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003650tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02003651 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at the beginning of
3652 the data transfer. Default value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS,
3653 the client can decipher the data only once it has received a full record.
3654 With large records, it means that clients might have to download up to 16kB
3655 of data before starting to process them. Limiting the value can improve page
3656 load times on browsers located over high latency or low bandwidth networks.
3657 It is suggested to find optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments
3658 (generally 1448 bytes over Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when
3659 timestamps are disabled), keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead.
3660 Typical values of 1419 and 2859 gave good results during tests. Use
3661 "strace -e trace=write" to find the best value. HAProxy will automatically
3662 switch to this setting after an idle stream has been detected (see
3663 tune.idletimer above). See also tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord.
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003664
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02003665tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
3666 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
3667 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
3668 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
3669 1000 entries.
3670
Remi Tricot-Le Breton58432372023-02-28 17:46:29 +01003671tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay <number>
3672 Sets the maximum interval between two automatic updates of the same OCSP
3673 response. This time is expressed in seconds and defaults to 3600 (1 hour). It
3674 must be set to a higher value than "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay". See
3675 option "ocsp-update" for more information about the auto update mechanism.
3676
3677tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay <number>
3678 Sets the minimum interval between two automatic updates of the same OCSP
3679 response. This time is expressed in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 minutes).
3680 It is particularly useful for OCSP response that do not have explicit
3681 expiration times. It must be set to a lower value than
3682 "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay". See option "ocsp-update" for more
3683 information about the auto update mechanism.
3684
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01003685tune.stick-counters <number>
3686 Sets the number of stick-counters that may be tracked at the same time by a
3687 connection or a request via "track-sc*" actions in "tcp-request" or
Ilya Shipitsin07be66d2023-04-01 12:26:42 +02003688 "http-request" rules. The default value is set at build time by the macro
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01003689 MAX_SESS_STK_CTR, and defaults to 3. With this setting it is possible to
3690 change the value and ignore the one passed at build time. Increasing this
3691 value may be needed when porting complex configurations to haproxy, but users
3692 are warned against the costs: each entry takes 16 bytes per connection and
3693 16 bytes per request, all of which need to be allocated and zeroed for all
3694 requests even when not used. As such a value of 10 will inflate the memory
3695 consumption per request by 320 bytes and will cause this memory to be erased
3696 for each request, which does have measurable CPU impacts. Conversely, when
3697 no "track-sc" rules are used, the value may be lowered (0 being valid to
3698 entirely disable stick-counters).
3699
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003700tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003701tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003702tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
3703tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
3704tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003705 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
3706 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
3707 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
3708 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
3709 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
3710 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
3711 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
3712 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003713
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003714 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
3715 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
3716 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
3717 all available space is consumed.
3718 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
3719 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
3720 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003721
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003722tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
3723 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003724 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003725 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003726 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003727 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
3728
3729tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
3730 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
3731 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003732 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
3733 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003734
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037353.3. Debugging
3736--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003737
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02003738anonkey <key>
3739 This sets the global anonymizing key to <key>, which must be a 32-bit number
3740 between 0 and 4294967295. This is the key that will be used by default by CLI
3741 commands when anonymized mode is enabled. This key may also be set at runtime
Amaury Denoyelledd3a33f2023-03-03 17:11:10 +01003742 from the CLI command "set anon global-key". See also command line argument
3743 "-dC" in the management manual.
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02003744
Willy Tarreaue98d3852022-11-15 09:34:07 +01003745quick-exit
3746 This speeds up the old process exit upon reload by skipping the releasing of
3747 memory objects and listeners, since all of these are reclaimed by the
3748 operating system at the process' death. The gains are only marginal (in the
3749 order of a few hundred milliseconds for huge configurations at most). The
3750 main target usage in fact is when a bug is spotted in the deinit() code, as
3751 this allows to bypass it. It is better not to use this unless instructed to
3752 do so by developers.
3753
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003754quiet
3755 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
3756 line argument "-q".
3757
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003758zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003759 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003760 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
3761 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
3762 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
3763 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
3764 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
3765
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003766
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010037673.4. Userlists
3768--------------
3769It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
3770http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
3771it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
3772
3773userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003774 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003775 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
3776
3777group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003778 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003779 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
3780 proceeded by "users" keyword.
3781
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003782user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
3783 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003784 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
3785 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003786 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
3787 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
3788 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
3789 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003790
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003791 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
3792 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
3793 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
3794 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
3795 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
3796 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
3797 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003798 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003799 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003800
3801 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003802 userlist L1
3803 group G1 users tiger,scott
3804 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003805
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003806 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
3807 user scott insecure-password elgato
3808 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003809
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003810 userlist L2
3811 group G1
3812 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003813
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003814 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
3815 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
3816 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003817
3818 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003819
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003820
38213.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003822----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003823It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003824several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003825instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
Willy Tarreaudb2ab822021-10-08 17:53:12 +02003826values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. As an exception, the data
3827type "conn_cur" is never learned from peers, as it is supposed to reflect local
3828values. Earlier versions used to synchronize it and to cause negative values in
3829active-active setups, and always-growing values upon reloads or active-passive
3830switches because the local value would reflect more connections than locally
3831present. This information, however, is pushed so that monitoring systems can
3832watch it.
3833
3834Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
3835known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
3836the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
3837process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
3838during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
3839tables.
3840
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003841Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
3842that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
3843each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003844
3845peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003846 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003847 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
3848
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003849bind [<address>]:port [param*]
3850bind /<path> [param*]
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003851 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
3852 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
3853
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003854disabled
3855 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
3856 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
3857 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
3858
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003859default-bind [param*]
3860 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
3861
3862default-server [param*]
3863 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
3864
3865 Arguments:
3866 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3867 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003868 section dedicated to it. In a peers section, the transport
3869 parameters of a "default-server" line are supported. Please refer
3870 to section 5 for more details, and the "server" keyword below in
3871 this section for some of the restrictions.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003872
3873 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3874
Emeric Brun620761f2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003875enabled
3876 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3877 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003878
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003879log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003880 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3881 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3882 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3883 more details.
3884
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003885peer <peername> [<address>]:port [param*]
3886peer <peername> /<path> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003887 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3888 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003889 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003890 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on the provided
3891 address. Otherwise, the address defines where to connect to in order to join
3892 the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003893 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003894
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003895 During a soft restart, local peer address is used by the old instance to
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003896 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3897
3898 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003899 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3900 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3901 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003902
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003903 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3904 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003905
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003906 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3907 "server" keyword explanation below).
3908
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003909server <peername> [<address>:<port>] [param*]
3910server <peername> [/<path>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003911 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003912 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph that are
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003913 related to transport settings. If the underlying peer is local, the address
3914 parameter must not be present; it must be provided on a "bind" line (see
3915 "bind" keyword of this "peers" section).
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003916
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003917 A number of "server" parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections. Peers by
3918 nature do not support dynamic host name resolution nor health checks, hence
3919 parameters like "init_addr", "resolvers", "check", "agent-check", or "track"
3920 are not supported. Similarly, there is no load balancing nor stickiness, thus
3921 parameters such as "weight" or "cookie" have no effect.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003922
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003923 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003924 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003925 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003926 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3927 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3928 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003929
3930 backend mybackend
3931 mode tcp
3932 balance roundrobin
3933 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3934 stick on src
3935
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003936 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3937 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003938
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003939 Example:
3940 peers mypeers
Emeric Brune77984f2022-05-30 18:13:35 +02003941 bind 192.168.0.1:1024 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3942 default-server ssl verify none
3943 server haproxy1 #local peer
3944 server haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3945 server haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003946
Frédéric Lécaille36d15652022-10-17 14:58:19 +02003947shards <shards>
3948
3949 In some configurations, one would like to distribute the stick-table contents
3950 to some peers in place of sending all the stick-table contents to each peer
3951 declared in the "peers" section. In such cases, "shards" specifies the
3952 number of peer involved in this stick-table contents distribution.
3953 See also "shard" server parameter.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003954
3955table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3956 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3957
3958 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3959 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003960 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003961 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3962 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3963 "stick-table" keyword).
3964
3965 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3966 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3967 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3968 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3969 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3970 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3971 of the stick-table name as follows:
3972
3973 peers mypeers
3974 peer A ...
3975 peer B ...
3976 table t1 ...
3977
3978 frontend fe1
3979 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3980
3981 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3982 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3983
3984 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3985 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3986 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3987 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3988 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3989 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3990 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3991
3992 peers mypeers
3993 peer A ...
3994 peer B ...
3995 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3996
3997 backend t1
3998 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3999
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004000 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01004001 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
4002 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
4003
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090040043.6. Mailers
4005------------
4006It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
4007If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
4008in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
4009
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02004010mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004011 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
4012 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
4013
4014mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
4015 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
4016
4017 Example:
4018 mailers mymailers
4019 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
4020 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
4021
4022 backend mybackend
4023 mode tcp
4024 balance roundrobin
4025
4026 email-alert mailers mymailers
4027 email-alert from test1@horms.org
4028 email-alert to test2@horms.org
4029
4030 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
4031 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
4032
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01004033timeout mail <time>
4034 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
4035 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
4036 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
4037 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
4038
4039 Example:
4040 mailers mymailers
4041 timeout mail 20s
4042 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004043
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020040443.7. Programs
4045-------------
4046In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
4047master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
4048managed the same way as the workers.
4049
4050During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
4051sequence as a worker:
4052
4053 - the master is re-executed
4054 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
4055 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
4056 instance of the program
4057
4058During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
4059
4060program <name>
4061 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
4062 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
4063 the management guide).
4064
4065command <command> [arguments*]
4066 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
4067 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
4068 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
4069 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
4070
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08004071user <user name>
4072 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
4073 See also "group".
4074
4075group <group name>
4076 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
4077 See also "user".
4078
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02004079option start-on-reload
4080no option start-on-reload
4081 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
4082 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
4083 program section.
4084
4085
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010040863.8. HTTP-errors
4087----------------
4088
4089It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
4090imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
4091several places and can be fully or partially imported.
4092
4093http-errors <name>
4094 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
4095 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
4096
4097errorfile <code> <file>
4098 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
4099
4100 Arguments :
4101 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004102 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004103 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004104
4105 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
4106 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
4107 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
4108 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4109 before any chroot is performed.
4110
4111 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
4112
4113 Example:
4114 http-errors website-1
4115 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
4116 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
4117 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
4118
4119 http-errors website-2
4120 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
4121 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
4122 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
4123
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020041243.9. Rings
4125----------
4126
4127It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
4128servers or traces.
4129
4130ring <ringname>
4131 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
4132
Willy Tarreau0b8e9ce2022-08-11 16:38:20 +02004133backing-file <path>
4134 This replaces the regular memory allocation by a RAM-mapped file to store the
4135 ring. This can be useful for collecting traces or logs for post-mortem
4136 analysis, without having to attach a slow client to the CLI. Newer contents
4137 will automatically replace older ones so that the latest contents are always
4138 available. The contents written to the ring will be visible in that file once
4139 the process stops (most often they will even be seen very soon after but
4140 there is no such guarantee since writes are not synchronous).
4141
4142 When this option is used, the total storage area is reduced by the size of
4143 the "struct ring" that starts at the beginning of the area, and that is
4144 required to recover the area's contents. The file will be created with the
4145 starting user's ownership, with mode 0600 and will be of the size configured
Willy Tarreau32872db2022-08-31 18:52:17 +02004146 by the "size" directive. When the directive is parsed (thus even during
4147 config checks), any existing non-empty file will first be renamed with the
4148 extra suffix ".bak", and any previously existing file with suffix ".bak" will
4149 be removed. This ensures that instant reload or restart of the process will
4150 not wipe precious debugging information, and will leave time for an admin to
4151 spot this new ".bak" file and to archive it if needed. As such, after a crash
4152 the file designated by <path> will contain the freshest information, and if
4153 the service is restarted, the "<path>.bak" file will have it instead. This
4154 means that the total storage capacity required will be double of the ring
4155 size. Failures to rotate the file are silently ignored, so placing the file
4156 into a directory without write permissions will be sufficient to avoid the
4157 backup file if not desired.
Willy Tarreau0b8e9ce2022-08-11 16:38:20 +02004158
4159 WARNING: there are stability and security implications in using this feature.
4160 First, backing the ring to a slow device (e.g. physical hard drive) may cause
4161 perceptible slowdowns during accesses, and possibly even panics if too many
4162 threads compete for accesses. Second, an external process modifying the area
4163 could cause the haproxy process to crash or to overwrite some of its own
4164 memory with traces. Third, if the file system fills up before the ring,
4165 writes to the ring may cause the process to crash.
4166
4167 The information present in this ring are structured and are NOT directly
4168 readable using a text editor (even though most of it looks barely readable).
4169 The output of this file is only intended for developers.
4170
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004171description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004172 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004173 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
4174
4175format <format>
4176 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
4177
4178 Arguments:
4179 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
4180 one of the following :
4181
4182 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
4183 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
4184 designed to be used with a local log server.
4185
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01004186 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
4187 field is stripped. This is the default.
4188 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
4189 rfc3164.
4190
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004191 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
4192 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
4193 used in containers or during development, where the severity
4194 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
4195 is the default.
4196
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01004197 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004198 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
4199
4200 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
4201 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
4202
4203 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
4204 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
4205 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
4206 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
4207 logger consumes.
4208
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02004209 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
4210 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
4211 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
4212 with a local log server.
4213
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004214 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
4215 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
4216 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
4217 used with a local log server.
4218
4219maxlen <length>
4220 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
4221 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
4222 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
4223
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02004224server <name> <address> [param*]
4225 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
4226 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
4227 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
4228 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
4229 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
4230 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
4231 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
4232 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
4233 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02004234 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
4235 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02004236
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004237size <size>
4238 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
4239 set to BUFSIZE.
4240
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02004241timeout connect <timeout>
4242 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
4243
4244 Arguments :
4245 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4246 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4247 as explained at the top of this document.
4248
4249timeout server <timeout>
4250 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
4251
4252 Arguments :
4253 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4254 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4255 as explained at the top of this document.
4256
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004257 Example:
4258 global
4259 log ring@myring local7
4260
4261 ring myring
4262 description "My local buffer"
4263 format rfc3164
4264 maxlen 1200
4265 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02004266 timeout connect 5s
4267 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02004268 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004269
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020042703.10. Log forwarding
4271-------------------
4272
4273It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004274HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004275
4276log-forward <name>
4277 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
4278
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004279backlog <conns>
4280 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
4281 on connections accept.
4282
4283bind <addr> [param*]
4284 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02004285 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
4286 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
4287 syslog protocol over TCP.
4288 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004289 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
4290
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02004291dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004292 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
4293 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
4294 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
4295 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02004296 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004297
4298log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01004299log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004300 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
4301 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
4302 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004303 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004304 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
4305 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
4306 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004307 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004308
4309 Example:
4310 global
4311 log stderr format iso local7
4312
4313 ring myring
4314 description "My local buffer"
4315 format rfc5424
4316 maxlen 1200
4317 size 32764
4318 timeout connect 5s
4319 timeout server 10s
4320 # syslog tcp server
4321 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
4322
4323 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004324 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
4325 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004326 # all messages on stderr
4327 log global
4328 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
4329 log ring@myring local0
4330 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
4331 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
4332 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
4333 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
4334 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004335
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004336maxconn <conns>
4337 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
4338 10 is the default.
4339
4340timeout client <timeout>
4341 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
4342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020043434. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004344----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004345
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004346Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004347 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
4348 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
4349 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
4350 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004351
4352A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
4353connections.
4354
4355A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
4356to forward incoming connections.
4357
4358A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
4359parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
4360
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004361A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
4362ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
4363sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
4364the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
4365explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
4366from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
4367"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
4368for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
4369to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
4370optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
4371are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
4372any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
4373names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
4374that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
4375duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
Christopher Fauletb4054202021-10-12 18:57:43 +02004376names. This rule might be enforced in a future version. In addition, a warning
4377is emitted if a defaults section is explicitly used by a proxy while it is also
4378implicitly used by another one because it is the last one defined. It is highly
4379encouraged to not mix both usages by always using explicit references or by
4380adding a last common defaults section reserved for all implicit uses.
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004381
4382Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
4383settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
4384of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
4385profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
4386timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
4387
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004388All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
4389'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
4390case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
4391
4392Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
4393logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
4394proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
4395However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
4396name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
4397
4398Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
4399and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004400bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004401protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
4402modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
4403arbitrary criteria.
4404
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004405In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
4406a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01004407the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004408
4409 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
4410 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
4411 between responses and new requests.
4412
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004413 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
4414 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
4415 client-facing connection remains open.
4416
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004417 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
4418 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004419
4420The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
4421frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
4422following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004423weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004424
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004425 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004426
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004427 | KAL | SCL | CLO
4428 ----+-----+-----+----
4429 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
4430 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004431 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
4432 ----+-----+-----+----
4433 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004434
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004435It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004436only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
4437within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004438as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004439content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004440and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
4441possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004442
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004443There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004444first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004445processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004446second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004447protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
4448is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
4449new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004450to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004451process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
4452already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
4453HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
4454evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
4455one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
4456
4457There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
4458performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
4459tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
4460preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
4461analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
4462HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
4463header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
4464mitigate this drawback.
4465
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004466There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004467method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
4468set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
4469in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
4470is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
4471to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
4472above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
4473to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
4474"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
4475frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
4476frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
4477as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
4478upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
4479on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
4480the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
4481upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
4482frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
4483remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004484
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044854.1. Proxy keywords matrix
4486--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004487
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004488The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
4489limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
4490they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
4491limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004492marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004493option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02004494and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
4495with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004496specified in a previous "defaults" section. Keywords supported in defaults
4497sections marked with "(!)" are only supported in named defaults sections, not
4498anonymous ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004499
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004500
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004501 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
4502------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004503acl X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004504backlog X X X -
4505balance X - X X
4506bind - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004507capture cookie - X X -
4508capture request header - X X -
4509capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004510clitcpka-cnt X X X -
4511clitcpka-idle X X X -
4512clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004513compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004514cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004515declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004516default-server X - X X
4517default_backend X X X -
4518description - X X X
4519disabled X X X X
4520dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004521email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004522email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004523email-alert mailers X X X X
4524email-alert myhostname X X X X
4525email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004526enabled X X X X
4527errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004528errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004529errorloc X X X X
4530errorloc302 X X X X
4531-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4532errorloc303 X X X X
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02004533error-log-format X X X -
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004534force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004535filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004536fullconn X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004537hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004538http-after-response X (!) X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004539http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004540http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004541http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004542http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02004543http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02004544http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004545http-check set-var X - X X
4546http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004547http-error X X X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004548http-request X (!) X X X
4549http-response X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004550http-reuse X - X X
Aurelien DARRAGONdf238c32023-01-12 15:59:27 +01004551http-send-name-header X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004552id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004553ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004554load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004555log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004556log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004557log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004558log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004559max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Aurelien DARRAGONb8e4f222023-11-29 10:13:18 +01004560max-session-srv-conns X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004561maxconn X X X -
4562mode X X X X
4563monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004564monitor-uri X X X -
4565option abortonclose (*) X - X X
4566option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
4567option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
4568option allbackups (*) X - X X
4569option checkcache (*) X - X X
4570option clitcpka (*) X X X -
4571option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02004572option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004573option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
4574option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004575-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4576option forwardfor X X X X
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01004577option forwarded (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02004578option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
4579option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004580option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02004581option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004582option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004583option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02004584option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +02004585option http-restrict-req-hdr-names X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004586option http-server-close (*) X X X X
4587option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
4588option httpchk X - X X
4589option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01004590option httplog X X X -
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02004591option httpslog X X X -
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004592option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004593option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004594option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004595option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
4596option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
4597option logasap (*) X X X -
4598option mysql-check X - X X
4599option nolinger (*) X X X X
4600option originalto X X X X
4601option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02004602option pgsql-check X - X X
4603option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004604option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004605option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004606option smtpchk X - X X
4607option socket-stats (*) X X X -
4608option splice-auto (*) X X X X
4609option splice-request (*) X X X X
4610option splice-response (*) X X X X
Aurelien DARRAGONf3a2ae72023-01-12 15:06:11 +01004611option spop-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004612option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
4613option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
4614-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004615option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004616option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
4617option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
4618option tcpka X X X X
4619option tcplog X X X X
4620option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +01004621option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004622external-check command X - X X
4623external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004624persist rdp-cookie X - X X
4625rate-limit sessions X X X -
4626redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004627-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004628retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02004629retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004630server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004631server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02004632server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004633source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004634srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
4635srvtcpka-idle X - X X
4636srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02004637stats admin - X X X
4638stats auth X X X X
4639stats enable X X X X
4640stats hide-version X X X X
4641stats http-request - X X X
4642stats realm X X X X
4643stats refresh X X X X
4644stats scope X X X X
4645stats show-desc X X X X
4646stats show-legends X X X X
4647stats show-node X X X X
4648stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004649-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4650stick match - - X X
4651stick on - - X X
4652stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02004653stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01004654stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004655tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004656tcp-check connect X - X X
4657tcp-check expect X - X X
4658tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02004659tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004660tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02004661tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004662tcp-check set-var X - X X
4663tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004664tcp-request connection X (!) X X -
4665tcp-request content X (!) X X X
4666tcp-request inspect-delay X (!) X X X
4667tcp-request session X (!) X X -
4668tcp-response content X (!) - X X
4669tcp-response inspect-delay X (!) - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004670timeout check X - X X
4671timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02004672timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004673timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004674timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
4675timeout http-request X X X X
4676timeout queue X - X X
4677timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02004678timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004679timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004680timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004681transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01004682unique-id-format X X X -
4683unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004684use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02004685use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02004686use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004687------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
4688 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004689
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004690
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046914.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
4692---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004693
4694This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
4695
4696
4697acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
4698 Declare or complete an access list.
4699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004700 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
4701
4702 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
4703 ones. ACLs defined in a defaults section are not visible from other sections
4704 using it.
4705
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004706 Example:
4707 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
4708 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
4709 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
4710
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004711 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004712
4713
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004714backlog <conns>
4715 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
4716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4717 yes | yes | yes | no
4718 Arguments :
4719 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
4720 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004721 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004722
4723 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
4724 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
4725 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
4726 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
4727 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
4728 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
4729 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
4730 backlog parameter.
4731
4732 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
4733 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
4734 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
4735
4736 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
4737
4738
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004739balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004740balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004741 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
4742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4743 yes | no | yes | yes
4744 Arguments :
4745 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
4746 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
4747 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
4748 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
4749
4750 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4751 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
4752 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
4753 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004754 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08004755 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004756 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
4757 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
4758 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
4759 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
4760 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
4761 it, so that you don't worry.
4762
4763 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4764 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
4765 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
4766 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
4767 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
4768 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
4769 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
4770 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004771
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004772 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
4773 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
4774 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
4775 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
4776 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
4777 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
4778 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02004779 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
4780 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
4781 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004782
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004783 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004784 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004785 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
4786 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004787 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004788 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
4789 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
4790 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
4791 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
4792 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004793 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
4794 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
4795 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
4796 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
4797 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
4798 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004799
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004800 hash Takes a regular sample expression in argument. The expression
4801 is evaluated for each request and hashed according to the
4802 configured hash-type. The result of the hash is divided by
4803 the total weight of the running servers to designate which
4804 server will receive the request. This can be used in place of
4805 "source", "uri", "hdr()", "url_param()", "rdp-cookie" to make
4806 use of a converter, refine the evaluation, or be used to
4807 extract data from local variables for example. When the data
4808 is not available, round robin will apply. This algorithm is
4809 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4810 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
4811 changed using "hash-type".
4812
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004813 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
4814 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
4815 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
4816 address will always reach the same server as long as no
4817 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
4818 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
4819 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
4820 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004821 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004822 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004823 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4824 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004825 changed using "hash-type". See also the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004826
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004827 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
4828 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
4829 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
4830 the running servers. The result designates which server will
4831 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
4832 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
4833 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
4834 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
4835 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
4836 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4837 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4838 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004839
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004840 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004841 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
4842 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
4843 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
4844 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
4845 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
4846 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
4847 URIs start with a leading "/".
4848
4849 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
4850 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
4851 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
4852 evaluation stops when either is reached.
4853
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004854 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
4855 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
4856 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004857 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash. See also the
4858 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004859
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004860 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004861 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
4862
4863 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004864 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
4865 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004866 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
4867 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
4868 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
4869 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004870 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004871 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
4872 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004873
4874 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
4875 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
4876 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
4877 server will receive the request.
4878
4879 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
4880 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
4881 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
4882 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
4883 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004884 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
4885 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004886 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also
4887 the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004888
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004889 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
4890 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
4891 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
4892 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
4893 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004894
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004895 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004896 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
4897 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
4898 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
4899
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004900 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4901 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004902 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
4903 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004904
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004905 random
4906 random(<draws>)
4907 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004908 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
4909 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
4910 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
4911 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004912 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
4913 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
4914 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
4915 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
4916 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
4917 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
4918 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
4919 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
4920 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
4921 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
4922 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
4923 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
4924 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
4925 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
4926 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
4927 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
4928 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
4929 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
4930 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
4931 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004932
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004933 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004934 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004935 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
4936 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004937 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004938 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
4939 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
4940 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004941 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004942 used instead.
4943
4944 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
4945 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
4946 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004947 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004948
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004949 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4950 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004951 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
4952 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004953
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004954 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004955 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4956 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004957
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004958 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4959 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4960 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004961
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004962 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004963 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004964 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4965 NTLM relies on.
4966
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004967 Examples :
4968 balance roundrobin
4969 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004970 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004971 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4972 balance hdr(host)
4973 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004974 balance hash req.cookie(clientid)
4975 balance hash var(req.client_id)
4976 balance hash req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1),ipmask(24)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004977
4978 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4979 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4980
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004981 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004982 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4983 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4984 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004985 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004986
4987 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4988 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4989 defaults to 16 kB.
4990
4991 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4992 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4993
4994 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4995 Round Robin.
4996
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004997 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004998 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4999 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
5000 actually appeared in the first chunk).
5001
5002 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
5003
5004 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005005 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02005006 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
5007 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
5008 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005009
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +02005010 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005011
5012
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005013bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
5014bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005015 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
5016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5017 no | yes | yes | no
5018 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01005019 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
5020 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
5021 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
5022 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02005023 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'. Note
5024 that if you bind a frontend to multiple UDP addresses you have
5025 no guarantee about the address which will be used to respond.
5026 This is why "0.0.0.0" addresses and lists of comma-separated
5027 IP addresses have been forbidden to bind QUIC addresses.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005028 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
5029 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
5030 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
5031 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5032 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5033 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02005034 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02005035 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
5036 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02005037 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02005038 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
5039 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02005040 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02005041 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
5042 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005043 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02005044 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01005045 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
5046 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
5047 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02005048 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
5049 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
5050 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
5051 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
Amaury Denoyelle936c1352022-11-14 17:14:41 +01005052 - 'quic4@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 and protocol UDP
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01005053 is used. Note that to achieve the best performance with a
Artur Pydoe6ca4182023-06-06 11:49:59 +02005054 large traffic you should keep "tune.quic.socket-owner" on
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01005055 connection. Else QUIC connections will be multiplexed
5056 over the listener socket. Another alternative would be to
5057 duplicate QUIC listener instances over several threads,
5058 for example using "shards" keyword to at least reduce
5059 thread contention.
Amaury Denoyelle936c1352022-11-14 17:14:41 +01005060 - 'quic6@' -> address is resolved as IPv6 and protocol UDP
Amaury Denoyelle7078fb12022-11-22 11:26:16 +01005061 is used. The performance note for QUIC over IPv4 applies
5062 as well.
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02005063
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005064 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5065 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
5066 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01005067
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01005068 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
5069 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01005070 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
5071 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
5072 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01005073 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
5074 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
5075 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
5076 the range.
5077
5078 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
5079 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
5080 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
5081 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
5082 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
5083 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
5084 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005085 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01005086 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005087
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01005088 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005089 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01005090 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
5091 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
5092 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
5093 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
5094 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
5095 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
5096
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005097 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
5098 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
5099 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
5100 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02005101
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005102 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
5103 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
5104 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
5105 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
5106 in a frontend.
5107
5108 Example :
5109 listen http_proxy
5110 bind :80,:443
5111 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01005112 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005113
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02005114 listen http_https_proxy
5115 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02005116 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02005117
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005118 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
5119 bind ipv6@:80
5120 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
5121 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
5122
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005123 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005124 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005125
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02005126 listen h3_quic_proxy
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +02005127 bind quic4@10.0.0.1:8888 ssl crt /etc/mycrt
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02005128
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02005129 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
5130 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
5131 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
5132 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
5133 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
5134
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01005135 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005136 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005137
5138
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005139capture cookie <name> len <length>
5140 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
5141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5142 no | yes | yes | no
5143 Arguments :
5144 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
5145 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
5146 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
5147 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005148 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005149
5150 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
5151 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
5152 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
5153 right if it exceeds <length>.
5154
5155 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
5156 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
5157 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
5158 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
5159
5160 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
5161 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
5162 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
5163
5164 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
5165 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
5166 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01005167 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
5168 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
5169 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005170
5171 Example:
5172 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
5173
5174 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005175 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005176
5177
5178capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01005179 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5181 no | yes | yes | no
5182 Arguments :
5183 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005184 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005185 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
5186 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
5187 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
5188
5189 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
5190 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
5191 it exceeds <length>.
5192
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01005193 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005194 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
5195 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005196 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
5197 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
5198 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
5199 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005200 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005201 environments to find where the request came from.
5202
5203 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
5204 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
5205 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
5206 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005207
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01005208 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
5209 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
5210 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
5211 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
5212 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005213
5214 Example:
5215 capture request header Host len 15
5216 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01005217 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005218
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005219 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005220 about logging.
5221
5222
5223capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01005224 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5226 no | yes | yes | no
5227 Arguments :
5228 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005229 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005230 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
5231 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
5232 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
5233
5234 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
5235 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
5236 it exceeds <length>.
5237
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01005238 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005239 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
5240 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
5241 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005242 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
5243 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
5244 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
5245 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005246
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01005247 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
5248 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
5249 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
5250 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
5251 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005252
5253 Example:
5254 capture response header Content-length len 9
5255 capture response header Location len 15
5256
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005257 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005258 about logging.
5259
5260
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09005261clitcpka-cnt <count>
5262 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
5263 the connection on the client side.
5264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5265 yes | yes | yes | no
5266 Arguments :
5267 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
5268
5269 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
5270 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02005271 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
5272 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09005273
5274 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
5275
5276
5277clitcpka-idle <timeout>
5278 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
5279 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
5280 client side.
5281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5282 yes | yes | yes | no
5283 Arguments :
5284 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
5285 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
5286 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
5287 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
5288
5289 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
5290 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02005291 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
5292 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09005293
5294 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
5295
5296
5297clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
5298 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
5299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5300 yes | yes | yes | no
5301 Arguments :
5302 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
5303 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
5304 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
5305 document.
5306
5307 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
5308 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02005309 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
5310 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09005311
5312 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
5313
5314
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005315compression algo <algorithm> ...
Olivier Houchardead43fe2023-04-06 00:33:48 +02005316compression algo-req <algorithm>
5317compression algo-res <algorithm>
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005318compression type <mime type> ...
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02005319 Enable HTTP compression.
5320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5321 yes | yes | yes | yes
5322 Arguments :
Olivier Houchardead43fe2023-04-06 00:33:48 +02005323 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms for
5324 responses (legacy keyword)
5325 algo-req is followed by compression algorithm for request (only one is
5326 provided).
5327 algo-res is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms for
5328 responses.
5329 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed for
5330 responses (legacy keyword).
5331 type-req is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed for
5332 requests.
5333 type-res is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed for
5334 responses.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005335
5336 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005337 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
5338 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
5339 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005340
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005341 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01005342 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005343
5344 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
5345 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
5346 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
5347 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
5348 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01005349 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005350
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005351 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
5352 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
5353 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
5354 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
5355 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
5356 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
5357 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01005358 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005359
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04005360 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005361 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005362 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005363 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005364 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005365 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005366 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02005367
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005368 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01005369 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
5370 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02005371 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01005372 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01005373 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
5374 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
5375 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
5376 "multipart"
5377 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
5378 header
5379 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
5380 and later
5381 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
5382 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01005383 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005384
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01005385 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005386
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02005387 Examples :
5388 compression algo gzip
5389 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005390
Olivier Houchardead43fe2023-04-06 00:33:48 +02005391 See also : "compression offload", "compression direction"
Christopher Faulet44d34bf2021-11-05 12:06:14 +01005392
5393compression offload
5394 Makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only.
5395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5396 no | yes | yes | yes
5397
5398 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
5399 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
5400 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
5401 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
5402 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
5403 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
5404 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
5405 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
5406 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
5407 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
5408 then be used for such scenarios.
5409
5410 If this setting is used in a defaults section, a warning is emitted and the
5411 option is ignored.
5412
Olivier Houchardead43fe2023-04-06 00:33:48 +02005413 See also : "compression type", "compression algo", "compression direction"
5414
5415compression direction <direction>
5416 Makes haproxy able to compress both requests and responses.
5417 Valid values are "request", to compress only requests, "response", to
5418 compress only responses, or "both", when you want to compress both.
5419 The default value is "response".
5420
5421 See also : "compression type", "compression algo", "compression offload"
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005422
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005423cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005424 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
5425 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01005426 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005427 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
5428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5429 yes | no | yes | yes
5430 Arguments :
5431 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
5432 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
5433 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
5434 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
5435 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
5436 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005437 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005438 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
5439 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
5440
5441 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005442 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005443 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
5444 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
5445 headers is left to the application. The application can then
5446 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005447 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
5448 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005449 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005450 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
5451 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005452
5453 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005454 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005455
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02005456 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005457 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005458 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005459 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005460 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
5461 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
5462 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
5463 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
5464 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
5465 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
5466 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005467
5468 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
5469 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
5470 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
5471 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
5472 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
5473 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
5474 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
5475 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
5476 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005477 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02005478 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
5479 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
5480 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005481
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02005482 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
5483 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
5484 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005485 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
5486 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
5487 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
5488 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02005489 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
5490 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
5491 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005492
5493 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
5494 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
5495 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
5496 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
5497 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
5498 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
5499 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
5500 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
5501 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
5502
5503 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
5504 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
5505 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
5506 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
5507 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
5508 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
5509 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
5510 persistence cookie in the cache.
5511 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
5512
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005513 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
5514 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005515 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005516 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
5517 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005518 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005519 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
5520 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
5521 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
5522 they logout.
5523
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005524 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005525 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
5526 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
5527 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
5528
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005529 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005530 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
5531 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
5532 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
5533 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
5534 this attribute.
5535
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02005536 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005537 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01005538 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
5539 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
5540 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
5541 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
5542 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
5543 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02005544
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005545 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
5546 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
5547 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
5548 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
5549 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
5550 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
5551 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
5552 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005553 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005554 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
5555 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
5556 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
5557 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
5558 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
5559 the site.
5560
5561 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
5562 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
5563 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
5564 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
5565 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
5566 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
5567 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
5568 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
5569 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
5570 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
5571 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
5572 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
5573 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005574 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005575 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
5576 redispatch after some absolute delay.
5577
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005578 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
5579 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
5580 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
5581 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
5582 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
5583 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
5584
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005585 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01005586 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
5587 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
5588 repeated.
5589
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005590 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
5591 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
5592 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
5593 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02005594
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005595 Examples :
5596 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
5597 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5598 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005599 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005600
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02005601 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005602
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005603
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02005604declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
5605 Declares a capture slot.
5606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5607 no | yes | yes | no
5608 Arguments:
5609 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
5610
5611 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
5612 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
5613 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
5614 for use in the response.
5615
5616 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02005617 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02005618 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
5619
5620
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005621default-server [param*]
5622 Change default options for a server in a backend
5623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5624 yes | no | yes | yes
5625 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005626 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
5627 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
5628 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
5629 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005630
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005631 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005632 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
5633
5634 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005635
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005636
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005637default_backend <backend>
5638 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
5639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5640 yes | yes | yes | no
5641 Arguments :
5642 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
5643
5644 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
5645 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
5646 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
5647 will catch all undetermined requests.
5648
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005649 Example :
5650
5651 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
5652 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
5653 default_backend dynamic
5654
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02005655 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005656
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005657
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02005658description <string>
5659 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
5660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5661 no | yes | yes | yes
5662 Arguments : string
5663
5664 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
5665 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
5666 it describes.
5667 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
5668
5669
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005670disabled
5671 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
5672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5673 yes | yes | yes | yes
5674 Arguments : none
5675
5676 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
5677 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
5678 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
5679 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
5680 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
5681 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
5682 keyword in a "defaults" section.
5683
5684 See also : "enabled"
5685
5686
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005687dispatch <address>:<port>
5688 Set a default server address
5689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5690 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005691 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005692
5693 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
5694 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5695 during start-up.
5696
5697 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
5698 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
5699 possible with normal servers.
5700
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02005701 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005702 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
5703 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
5704 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
5705 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
5706
5707 See also : "server"
5708
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005709
5710dynamic-cookie-key <string>
5711 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
5712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5713 yes | no | yes | yes
5714 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
5715
5716 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005717 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005718 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
5719 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005720 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005721 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005722
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005723enabled
5724 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
5725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5726 yes | yes | yes | yes
5727 Arguments : none
5728
5729 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
5730 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
5731
5732 See also : "disabled"
5733
5734
5735errorfile <code> <file>
5736 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5738 yes | yes | yes | yes
5739 Arguments :
5740 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005741 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005742 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005743
5744 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005745 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005746 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005747 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
5748 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005749
5750 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5751 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5752 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5753
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005754 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5755
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02005756 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
5757 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
5758 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
5759 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
5760 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
5761 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
5762 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
5763 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
5764 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005765
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005766 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5767 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5768 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005769 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005770 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
5771
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005772 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005773
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005774 Example :
5775 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005776 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005777 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
5778 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
5779
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005780
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005781errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
5782 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
5783 section.
5784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5785 yes | yes | yes | yes
5786 Arguments :
5787 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
5788
5789 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005790 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005791 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
5792 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005793
5794 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
5795 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
5796 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
5797 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
5798 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005799 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005800 hand using "errorfile" directives.
5801
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005802 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
5803 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005804
5805 Example :
5806 errorfiles generic
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01005807 errorfiles site-1 403 404
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005808
5809
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005810errorloc <code> <url>
5811errorloc302 <code> <url>
5812 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5814 yes | yes | yes | yes
5815 Arguments :
5816 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005817 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005818 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005819
5820 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5821 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5822 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5823 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005824 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005825
5826 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5827 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5828 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5829
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005830 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5831
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005832 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
5833 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
5834 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
5835 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005836 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005837 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
5838 request.
5839
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005840 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005841
5842
5843errorloc303 <code> <url>
5844 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5846 yes | yes | yes | yes
5847 Arguments :
5848 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005849 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005850 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005851
5852 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5853 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5854 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5855 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005856 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005857
5858 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5859 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5860 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5861
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005862 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5863
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005864 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
5865 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
5866 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
5867 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005868 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005869
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005870 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005871
5872
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005873email-alert from <emailaddr>
5874 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005875 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005876 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5877 yes | yes | yes | yes
5878
5879 Arguments :
5880
5881 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
5882
5883 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5884 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5885
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005886 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02005887 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
5888 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005889
5890
5891email-alert level <level>
5892 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
5893 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
5894 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5895 yes | yes | yes | yes
5896
5897 Arguments :
5898
5899 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
5900 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5901 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
5902
5903 By default level is alert
5904
5905 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5906 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5907 for the proxy.
5908
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09005909 Alerts are sent when :
5910
5911 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
5912 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
5913 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
5914 is notice or lower
5915 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
5916 and a health check status update occurs
5917
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005918 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
5919 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005920 section 3.6 about mailers.
5921
5922
5923email-alert mailers <mailersect>
5924 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
5925 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5926 yes | yes | yes | yes
5927
5928 Arguments :
5929
5930 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
5931
5932 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5933 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5934
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005935 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5936 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005937
5938
5939email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5940 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5941 mailers.
5942 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5943 yes | yes | yes | yes
5944
5945 Arguments :
5946
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005947 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005948
5949 By default the systems hostname is used.
5950
5951 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5952 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5953 for the proxy.
5954
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005955 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5956 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005957
5958
5959email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005960 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005961 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5962 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5963 yes | yes | yes | yes
5964
5965 Arguments :
5966
5967 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5968
5969 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5970 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5971
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005972 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005973 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5974
5975
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005976error-log-format <string>
5977 Specifies the log format string to use in case of connection error on the frontend side.
5978 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5979 yes | yes | yes | no
5980
5981 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for logs
5982 containing information related to errors, timeouts, retries redispatches or
5983 HTTP status code 5xx. This format will in short be used for every log line
5984 that would be concerned by the "log-separate-errors" option, including
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01005985 connection errors described in section 8.2.5.
5986
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005987 If the directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will
5988 use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5989 string in depth.
5990
5991 "error-log-format" directive overrides previous "error-log-format"
5992 directives.
5993
5994
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005995force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5996 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5997 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005998 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005999
6000 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
6001 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
6002 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
6003 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
6004 marked down for maintenance operations.
6005
6006 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6007 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
6008 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
6009 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
6010 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
6011 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
6012 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
6013 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
6014 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
6015
6016 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6017 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
6018 is used.
6019
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006020 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02006021 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006022
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02006023
6024filter <name> [param*]
6025 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
6026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6027 no | yes | yes | yes
6028 Arguments :
6029 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
6030 referenced in section 9.
6031
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006032 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02006033 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006034 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
6035 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02006036
6037 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
6038 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
6039
6040 Example:
6041 listen
6042 bind *:80
6043
6044 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
6045 filter compression
6046 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
6047
6048 compression algo gzip
6049 compression offload
6050
6051 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6052
6053 See also : section 9.
6054
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006055
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006056fullconn <conns>
6057 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
6058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6059 yes | no | yes | yes
6060 Arguments :
6061 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
6062 servers use the maximal number of connections.
6063
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006064 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006065 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006066 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006067 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
6068 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
6069 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
6070 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
6071 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006072 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006073
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006074 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02006075 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01006076 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
6077 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
6078 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02006079
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006080 Example :
6081 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
6082 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
6083 # connections.
6084 backend dynamic
6085 fullconn 10000
6086 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
6087 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
6088
6089 See also : "maxconn", "server"
6090
6091
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04006092hash-balance-factor <factor>
6093 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
6094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6095 yes | no | no | yes
6096 Arguments :
6097 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
6098 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006099 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04006100
6101 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
6102 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
6103 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
6104 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
6105 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
6106 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
6107 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
6108
6109 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
6110 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
6111 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
6112 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
6113 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
6114
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02006115 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
6116 consistent hashing mechanism.
6117
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04006118 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
6119
6120
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05006121hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02006122 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
6123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6124 yes | no | yes | yes
6125 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006126 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
6127 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02006128
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006129 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
6130 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
6131 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
6132 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
6133 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
6134 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
6135 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
6136 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
6137 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
6138 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01006139
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006140 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
6141 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
6142 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
6143 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
6144 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
6145 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
6146 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
6147 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
6148 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
6149 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
6150 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
6151 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
6152 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05006153 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
6154 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006155
6156 <function> is the hash function to be used :
6157
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006158 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006159 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
6160 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
6161 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05006162 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
6163 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
6164 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006165
6166 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
6167 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05006168 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
6169 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
6170 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
6171 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
6172
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006173 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01006174 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
6175 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
6176 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
6177 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
6178 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
6179 parameter.
6180
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01006181 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
6182 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
6183 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
6184 used on strings.
6185
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05006186 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
6187
6188 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
6189 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
6190 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
6191 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
6192 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
6193 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
6194 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
6195 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
6196 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
6197 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
6198 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
6199 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02006200
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006201 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
6202 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
6203 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02006204
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04006205 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02006206
6207
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006208http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6209 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
6210 ones).
6211
6212 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006213 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006214
6215 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
6216 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
6217 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6218 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6219 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6220 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6221
6222 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
6223 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
6224 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
6225
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006226 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
6227 supported:
6228 - add-header <name> <fmt>
6229 - allow
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01006230 - capture <sample> id <id>
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006231 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006232 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006233 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006234 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6235 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01006236 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006237 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
6238 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
6239 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
6240 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6241 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006242 - set-header <name> <fmt>
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006243 - set-log-level <level>
6244 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006245 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01006246 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
6247 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006248 - strict-mode { on | off }
6249 - unset-var(<var-name>)
6250
6251 The supported actions are described below.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006252
6253 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
6254 instance.
6255
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006256 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
6257 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
6258 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
6259 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
6260 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
6261 a defaults section defining such rules.
6262
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01006263 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
6264 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
6265 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
6266
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006267 Example:
6268 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
6269 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
6270 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
6271
6272http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6273
6274 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006275 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
6276 complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006277
Christopher Fauletd9d36b82023-01-05 10:25:30 +01006278http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6279
6280 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6281 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
6282
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01006283http-after-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6284
6285 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6286 converts it to a string. Please refer to "http-response capture" for a
6287 complete description.
6288
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006289http-after-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6290
6291 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
6292 del-acl" for a complete description.
6293
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006294http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006295
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006296 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
6297 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006298
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006299http-after-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6300
6301 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
6302 del-map" for a complete description.
6303
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006304http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6305 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6306
6307 This works like "http-response replace-header".
6308
6309 Example:
6310 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
6311
6312 # applied to:
6313 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
6314
6315 # outputs:
6316 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
6317
6318 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
6319
6320http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6321 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6322
6323 This works like "http-response replace-value".
6324
6325 Example:
6326 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
6327
6328 # applied to:
6329 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
6330
6331 # outputs:
6332 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
6333
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01006334http-after-response sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6335 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6336
6337 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
6338 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
6339 a complete description.
6340
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006341http-after-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6342http-after-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6343http-after-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6344
6345 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
6346 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
6347 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
6348 description.
6349
6350http-after-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6351 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6352http-after-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6353 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6354
6355 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
6356 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +02006357 sc-set-gpt" and "http-request sc-set-gpt0" for a complete description.
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006358
6359http-after-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6360
6361 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
6362 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
6363
6364http-after-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6365
6366 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
6367 set-map" for a complete description.
6368
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006369http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6370
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006371 This does the same as "http-after-response add-header" except that the header
6372 name is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6373 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6374 external users.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006375
6376http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6377 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6378
6379 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +05006380 between 100 and 999. Please refer to "http-response set-status" for a complete
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006381 description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006382
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01006383http-after-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6384http-after-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006385
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006386 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6387 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
6388 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006389
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006390http-after-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006391
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006392 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
6393 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006394
6395http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6396
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006397 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
6398 about <var-name>.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006399
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006400
6401http-check comment <string>
6402 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
6403 it fails.
6404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6405 yes | no | yes | yes
6406
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006407 Arguments :
6408 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
6409 rule fails.
6410
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006411 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
6412 user-friendly error reporting.
6413
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006414 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006415 "http-check expect".
6416
6417
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006418http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
6419 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01006420 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006421 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
6422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6423 yes | no | yes | yes
6424
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006425 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006426 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6427
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006428 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006429 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006430
6431 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
6432 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
6433 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
6434 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
6435
6436 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
6437
6438 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
6439
6440 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
6441
6442 ssl opens a ciphered connection
6443
6444 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
6445
6446 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
6447 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
6448 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
6449 is used.
6450
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02006451 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
6452 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
6453 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
6454 haproxy -vv.
6455
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006456 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
6457
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006458 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
6459 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
6460 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
6461 different ports or with different servers.
6462
6463 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
6464 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
6465 the port with a "http-check connect".
6466
6467 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
6468 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
6469 do.
6470
6471 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
6472 unset-var or comment rules.
6473
6474 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006475 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
6476 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
6477 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
6478 option httpchk
6479
6480 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02006481 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006482 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006483 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02006484 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006485 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006486
6487 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
6488
6489 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006490
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006491
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006492http-check disable-on-404
6493 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
6494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006495 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006496 Arguments : none
6497
6498 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
6499 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
6500 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
6501 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
6502 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
6503 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
6504 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
6505 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006506 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
6507 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01006508 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
6509 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
6510 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006511
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006512 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006513
6514
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006515http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006516 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
6517 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
6518 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006519 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02006521 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006522
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006523 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006524 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6525
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006526 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
6527 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
6528 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
6529 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
6530 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
6531 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
6532 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
6533 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
6534 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
6535 result is always conclusive.
6536
6537 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6538 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
6539 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006540 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
6541 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01006542 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
6543 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006544 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
6545 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
6546 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006547
6548 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6549 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01006550 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
6551 supported :
6552 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
6553 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006554 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
6555 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
6556 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
6557 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
6558 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006559
6560 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6561 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006562 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
6563 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
6564 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
6565 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006566 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
6567
6568 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
6569 informational message reported in logs if the expect
6570 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
6571 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
6572
6573 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
6574 informational message reported in logs if an error
6575 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
6576 log-format string.
6577
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006578 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006579 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
6580 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006581 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
6582 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
6583 details on the supported keywords.
6584
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006585 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
6586 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
6587 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
6588 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006589
6590 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
6591 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
6592 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
6593 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
6594 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
6595
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006596 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
6597 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
6598 codes. A health check response will be considered as
6599 valid if the response's status code matches any status
6600 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
6601 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6602 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006603
6604 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006605 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006606 response's status code matches the expression. If the
6607 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
6608 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
6609 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
6610
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006611 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
6612 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006613 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
6614 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
6615 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
6616 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
6617 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
6618 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
6619 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
6620 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006621 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
6622 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
6623 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
6624 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
6625 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
6626 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
6627 insensitive on the header names.
6628
6629 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
6630 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
6631 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
6632 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
6633 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
6634 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006635
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006636 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006637 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006638 response's body contains this exact string. If the
6639 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
6640 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
6641 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
6642 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006643 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006644 trace).
6645
6646 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006647 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006648 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
6649 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6650 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
6651 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
6652 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006653 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006654
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02006655 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
6656 A health check response will be considered valid if the
6657 response's body contains the string resulting of the
6658 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
6659 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6660 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
6661
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006662 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01006663 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006664 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
6665 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
6666 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
6667 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
6668 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
6669 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
6670
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006671 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
6672 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
6673 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
6674 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
6675 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01006676
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006677 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
6678 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
6679
6680 Examples :
6681 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006682 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006683
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006684 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
6685 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
6686
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006687 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01006688 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006689
6690 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01006691 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006692
6693 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006694 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006695
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006696 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006697 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006698
6699
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02006700http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02006701 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
6702 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006703 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
6704 health checks.
6705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6706 yes | no | yes | yes
6707 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006708 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6709
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006710 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
6711 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
6712 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
6713 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
6714 to invent non-standard ones.
6715
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02006716 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
6717 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
6718 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
6719 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6720
6721 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
6722 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
6723 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6724 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006725
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02006726 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006727 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006728 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006729 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
6730 to add it.
6731
6732 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
6733 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
6734 to the log-format rules.
6735
6736 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
6737 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
6738 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006739
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02006740 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
6741 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
6742 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
6743 request.
6744
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006745 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
6746 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
6747 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02006748 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
6749 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
6750 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
6751 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01006752 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006753
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006754 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01006755 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
6756 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02006757
6758 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
6759 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
6760 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
6761 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
6762 configured request authority.
6763
6764 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
6765 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006766
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006767 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006768
6769
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006770http-check send-state
6771 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
6772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6773 yes | no | yes | yes
6774 Arguments : none
6775
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006776 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006777 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006778 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
6779 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
6780 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006781
6782 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
6783 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
6784 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
6785 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
6786 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08006787 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
6788 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
6789 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6790
6791 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
6792 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
6793 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6794
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006795 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
6796 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
6797 checked in multiple backends.
6798
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006799 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006800 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
6801
6802 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
6803 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
6804 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
6805 one fails.
6806
6807 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
6808 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
6809 connections on all servers of the same backend.
6810
6811 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
6812 server's queue.
6813
6814 Example of a header received by the application server :
6815 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
6816 scur=13/22; qcur=0
6817
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006818 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
6819 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006820
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006821
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01006822http-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
6823http-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006824 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006825 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6826 yes | no | yes | yes
6827
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006828 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006829 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6830 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6831 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6832 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6833 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6834 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6835 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6836 and '-'.
6837
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006838 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
6839 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05006840 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006841 conditions.
6842
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006843 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
6844
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006845 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
6846 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
6847
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006848 Examples :
6849 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006850 http-check set-var-fmt(check.port) "name=%H"
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006851
6852
6853http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006854 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006855 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6856 yes | no | yes | yes
6857
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006858 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006859 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6860 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6861 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6862 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6863 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6864 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6865 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6866 and '-'.
6867
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006868 Examples :
6869 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006870
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006871
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006872http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
6873 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6874 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6875 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6876 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
6877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6878 yes | yes | yes | yes
6879 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006880 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006881 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006882 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006883 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006884
6885 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
6886 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
6887 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
6888 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
6889
6890 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
6891 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
6892 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
6893 a frontend, the default error message is used.
6894
6895 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
6896 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
6897 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
6898 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
6899 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
6900 chroot is performed.
6901
6902 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
6903 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
6904 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
6905 considered.
6906
6907 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6908 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6909 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6910 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6911 considered as a raw string.
6912
6913 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
6914 The content-type must always be set as argument to
6915 "content-type".
6916
6917 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6918 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6919 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6920 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6921 evaluated as a log-format string.
6922
6923 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
6924 payload. The content-type must always be set as
6925 argument to "content-type".
6926
6927 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
6928 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
6929 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
6930 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
6931
6932 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
6933 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
6934 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
6935 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
6936 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
6937 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
6938 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
6939 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
6940
6941 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
6942 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
6943 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
6944
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01006945 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
6946 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
6947 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
6948 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
6949 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
6950
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006951 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
6952 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
6953
6954
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006955http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006956 Access control for Layer 7 requests
6957
6958 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006959 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006960
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006961 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6962 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6963 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6964 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6965 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006966
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006967 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
6968 supported:
6969 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6970 - add-header <name> <fmt>
6971 - allow
6972 - auth [realm <realm>]
6973 - cache-use <name>
6974 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6975 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6976 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
6977 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6978 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6979 - disable-l7-retry
6980 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
6981 - early-hint <name> <fmt>
6982 - normalize-uri <normalizer>
6983 - redirect <rule>
6984 - reject
6985 - replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6986 - replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6987 - replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6988 - replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6989 - replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6990 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01006991 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006992 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
6993 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
6994 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
6995 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6996 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01006997 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006998 - set-dst <expr>
6999 - set-dst-port <expr>
7000 - set-header <name> <fmt>
7001 - set-log-level <level>
7002 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7003 - set-mark <mark>
7004 - set-method <fmt>
7005 - set-nice <nice>
7006 - set-path <fmt>
7007 - set-pathq <fmt>
7008 - set-priority-class <expr>
7009 - set-priority-offset <expr>
7010 - set-query <fmt>
7011 - set-src <expr>
7012 - set-src-port <expr>
7013 - set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
7014 - set-tos <tos>
7015 - set-uri <fmt>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01007016 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
7017 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007018 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01007019 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007020 - strict-mode { on | off }
7021 - tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
7022 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
7023 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
7024 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
7025 - unset-var(<var-name>)
7026 - use-service <service-name>
7027 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7028 - wait-for-handshake
7029 - cache-use <name>
7030
7031 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007032
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007033 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007034
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007035 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
7036 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
7037 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
7038 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
7039 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
7040 a defaults section defining such rules.
7041
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007042 Example:
7043 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
7044 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
7045 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007046
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007047 http-request allow if nagios
7048 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
7049 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
7050 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01007051
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007052 Example:
7053 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
7054 acl add path /addacl
7055 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007056
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007057 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007058
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007059 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
7060 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007061
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007062 Example:
7063 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
7064 acl setmap path /setmap
7065 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007066
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007067 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007068
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007069 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
7070 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007071
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007072 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7073 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007074
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007075http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007076
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007077 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7078 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7079 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7080 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
7081 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
7082 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7083 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7084 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007085
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007086http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007087
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007088 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
7089 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
7090 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
7091 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
7092 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
7093 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
7094 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
7095 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007096
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007097http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007098
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007099 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +01007100 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007101
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007102http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007103
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007104 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
7105 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
7106 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
7107 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
7108 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007109
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02007110 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
7111 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
7112 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
7113 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
7114 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
7115 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
7116 instead.
7117
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007118 Example:
7119 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
7120 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007121
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007122http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007123
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007124 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007125
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007126http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
7127 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007128
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007129 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
7130 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
7131 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
7132 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
7133 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
7134 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
7135 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
7136 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
7137 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007138
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007139 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
7140 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
7141 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007142 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
7143
7144 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7145 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7146 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7147 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007148
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007149http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007150
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007151 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7152 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7153 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7154 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7155 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7156 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007157
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007158http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007159
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007160 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7161 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7162 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7163 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7164 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007165
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007166http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007167
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007168 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7169 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7170 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7171 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7172 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7173 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007174
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007175http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7176http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7177 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7178 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7179 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7180 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04007181
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007182 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
7183 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7184 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007185 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007186 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
7187 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
7188 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007189 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007190 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04007191
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02007192http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7193 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
7194 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
7195 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
7196
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007197http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
7198 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01007199
7200 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
7201 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
7202 pointed by <resolvers>.
7203 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
7204 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
7205 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
7206 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
7207 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
7208 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
7209 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
7210 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
7211 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
7212 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
William Lallemand1ef24602022-08-26 16:38:43 +02007213 to 0.0.0.0. The do-resolve action takes an host-only parameter, any port must
7214 be removed from the string.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01007215
7216 Example:
7217 resolvers mydns
7218 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
7219 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
7220 timeout retry 1s
7221 hold valid 10s
7222 hold nx 3s
7223 hold other 3s
7224 hold obsolete 0s
7225 accepted_payload_size 8192
7226
7227 frontend fe
7228 bind 10.42.0.1:80
William Lallemandb5c2cd42022-08-26 16:48:07 +02007229 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),host_only
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01007230 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
7231
7232 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
7233 # which mean DNS resolution error
7234 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
7235
7236 default_backend be
7237
7238 backend b_503
7239 # dummy backend used to return 503.
7240 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
7241 # 503 error page to end users
7242
7243 backend be
7244 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
7245 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
7246 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
7247 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
7248 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
7249
7250 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
7251 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
7252
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01007253http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7254
7255 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
7256 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
7257 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
7258 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01007259 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
7260 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01007261
7262 See RFC 8297 for more information.
7263
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02007264http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02007265http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02007266http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007267http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02007268http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007269http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007270http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007271http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7272http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02007273
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02007274 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
7275
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02007276 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02007277 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
7278 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
7279 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
7280 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02007281
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02007282 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
7283 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
7284 the supported backend.
7285
7286 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
7287 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
7288 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
7289 number of segments in the path.
7290
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007291 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
7292 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
7293 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
7294 when improperly combined.
7295
7296 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
7297 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
7298 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
7299 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
7300 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
7301
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02007302 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02007303
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02007304 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
7305
7306 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
7307 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
7308
7309 Example:
7310 - /#foo -> /%23foo
7311
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02007312 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
7313
7314 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
7315 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
7316
7317 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
7318 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
7319
7320 Example:
7321 - /#foo -> /
7322
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02007323 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
7324 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02007325
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007326 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
7327 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
7328
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02007329 Example:
7330 - /. -> /
7331 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
7332 - /a/./a -> /a/a
7333 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02007334
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02007335 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
7336 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
7337
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007338 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007339 their preceding segment.
7340
7341 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
7342 normalizer first if this is undesired.
7343
7344 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
7345 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02007346
7347 Example:
7348 - /foo/../ -> /
7349 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
7350 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
7351 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02007352 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02007353 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007354 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02007355
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02007356 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
7357 removed as well:
7358
7359 Example:
7360 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
7361 - /bar/../../ -> /
7362
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007363 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
7364 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02007365
7366 Example:
7367 - // -> /
7368 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
7369
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007370 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
7371 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
7372
7373 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
7374 ".", "_", and "~".
7375
7376 Example:
7377 - /%61dmin -> /admin
7378 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
7379 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
7380 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
7381
7382 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
7383 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
7384
7385 Example:
7386 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
7387 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
7388
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007389 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02007390 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02007391
7392 Example:
7393 - /%6f -> /%6F
7394 - /%zz -> /%zz
7395
7396 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
7397 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
7398
7399 Example:
7400 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
7401
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007402 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02007403 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
7404 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
7405
7406 Example:
7407 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
7408 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
7409 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
7410
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007411http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007412
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007413 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
7414 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
7415 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
7416 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
7417 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007418
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007419http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007420
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007421 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
7422 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
7423 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
7424 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007425
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007426http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7427 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02007428
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007429 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007430 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
7431 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
7432 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
7433 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
7434 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02007435
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007436 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
7437 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
7438 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
7439 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
7440 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007441
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007442 Example:
7443 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
7444
7445 # applied to:
7446 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
7447
7448 # outputs:
7449 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
7450
7451 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007452
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007453 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
7454
7455 # applied to:
7456 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007457
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007458 # outputs:
7459 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007460
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007461http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7462 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7463
7464 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
7465 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02007466 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
7467 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
7468 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007469
7470 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
7471 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
7472 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
7473
7474 Example:
7475 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
7476 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
7477
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007478 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
7479 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
7480 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
7481 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
7482
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02007483http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7484 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7485
7486 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
7487 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
7488 query-string are replaced.
7489
7490 Example:
7491 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
7492 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
7493
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007494http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7495 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7496
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007497 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
7498 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
7499 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
7500 against.
7501
7502 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
7503 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
7504 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007505
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007506 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
7507 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
7508 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
7509 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
7510 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
7511 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
7512 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
7513 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
7514 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007515 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
7516 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007517
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007518 Example:
7519 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
7520 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007521
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007522 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
7523 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007524
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007525http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7526 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007527
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007528 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
7529 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
7530 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
7531 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007532
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007533 Example:
7534 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007535
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007536 # applied to:
7537 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007538
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007539 # outputs:
7540 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007541
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007542http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7543 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7544 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01007545 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007546 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7547
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007548 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007549 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7550 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007551 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007552 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007553 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007554 are followed to create the response :
7555
7556 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7557 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7558 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7559 ignored.
7560
7561 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7562 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007563 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007564 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7565 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007566
7567 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7568 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7569 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007570 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007571 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007572
7573 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7574 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7575 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007576 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007577 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007578 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007579
7580 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7581 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7582 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7583 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7584 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7585 as a raw content.
7586
7587 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7588 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7589 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7590 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7591 considered as a raw string.
7592
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007593 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007594 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7595 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7596 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7597
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007598 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7599 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007600 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007601
7602 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7603
7604 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007605 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007606 if { path /ping }
7607
7608 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
7609 if { path /favicon.ico }
7610
7611 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
7612 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
7613 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
7614
Willy Tarreau5a72d032023-01-02 18:15:20 +01007615http-request sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7616 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7617
7618 This action increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
7619 array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> by the value of
7620 either integer <int> or the integer evaluation of expression <expr>. Integers
7621 and expressions are limited to unsigned 32-bit values. If an error occurs,
7622 this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues. <idx> is an
7623 integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer between 0 and 2. It also
7624 silently fails if the there is no GPC stored at this index. The entry in the
7625 table is refreshed even if the value is zero. The 'gpc_rate' is automatically
7626 adjusted to reflect the average growth rate of the gpc value.
7627
7628 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7629 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7630 There is no equivalent function for legacy data types, but if the value is
7631 always 1, please see 'sc-inc-gpc()', 'sc-inc-gpc0()' and 'sc-inc-gpc1()'.
7632 There is no way to decrement the value either, but it is possible to store
7633 exact values in a General Purpose Tag using 'sc-set-gpt()' instead.
7634
7635 The main use of this action is to count scores or total volumes (e.g.
7636 estimated danger per source IP reported by the server or a WAF, total
7637 uploaded bytes, etc).
7638
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007639http-request sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7640
7641 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
7642 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
7643 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7644 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7645 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
7646 at this index.
7647 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7648 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7649
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007650http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7651http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007652
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007653 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7654 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7655 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007656
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007657http-request sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7658 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7659 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
7660 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
7661 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
7662 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7663 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7664 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
7665 at this index.
7666 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
7667 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
7668
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007669http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7670 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007671
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007672 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7673 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7674 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7675 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007676
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007677http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7678 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7679
7680 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7681 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7682 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7683 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7684 agent name must be used.
7685
7686 Arguments:
7687 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
7688
7689 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7690 configuration.
7691
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01007692http-request set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
7693 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02007694
7695 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
7696 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Custom
7697 limit and period may be defined, if and only if <name> references a
7698 per-stream bandwidth limitation filter. When a set-bandwidth-limit rule is
7699 executed, it first resets all settings of the filter to their defaults prior
7700 to enabling it. As a consequence, if several "set-bandwidth-limit" actions
7701 are executed for the same filter, only the last one is considered. Several
7702 bandwidth limitation filters can be enabled on the same stream.
7703
7704 Note that this action cannot be used in a defaults section because bandwidth
7705 limitation filters cannot be defined in defaults sections. In addition, only
7706 the HTTP payload transfer is limited. The HTTP headers are not considered.
7707
7708 Arguments:
7709 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7710 by some converters. The result is converted to an integer. It is
7711 interpreted as a size in bytes for the "limit" parameter and as a
7712 duration in milliseconds for the "period" parameter.
7713
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01007714 <size> Is a number. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
7715 bytes.
7716
7717 <time> Is a number. It follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in
7718 milliseconds.
7719
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02007720 Example:
7721 http-request set-bandwidth-limit global-limit
7722 http-request set-bandwidth-limit my-limit limit 1m period 10s
7723
7724 See section 9.7 about bandwidth limitation filter setup.
7725
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007726http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007727
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007728 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
7729 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
7730 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
7731 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
7732 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007733
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007734 Arguments:
7735 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7736 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007737
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007738 Example:
7739 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
7740 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007741
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007742 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
7743 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007744
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007745http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007746
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007747 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
7748 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
7749 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007750
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007751 Arguments:
7752 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7753 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007754
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007755 Example:
7756 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
7757 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007758
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007759 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
7760 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
7761 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007762
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007763http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007764
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007765 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
7766 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
7767 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
7768 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
7769 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007770
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007771 Example:
7772 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
7773 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
7774 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
7775 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
7776 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
7777 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
7778 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
7779 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
7780 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007781
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007782http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007783
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007784 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7785 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7786 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7787 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
7788 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007789
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007790http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7791 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007792
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007793 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7794 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7795 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7796 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7797 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
7798 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
7799 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
7800 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
7801 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007802
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007803http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007804
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01007805 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
7806 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7807 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
7808 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace. It can be expressed
7809 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
7810 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
7811 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01007812 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
7813 and OpenBSD.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02007814
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007815http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007816
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007817 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
7818 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
7819 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007820
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007821http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007822
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007823 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
7824 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
7825 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
7826 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
7827 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
7828 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7829 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7830 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007831
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007832http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02007833
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007834 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
7835 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
7836 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
7837 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
7838 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
7839 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007840
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007841 Example :
7842 # prepend the host name before the path
7843 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007844
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02007845http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7846
7847 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
7848 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
7849 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
7850
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007851http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02007852
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007853 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
7854 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
7855 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7856 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
7857 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007858
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007859http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007860
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007861 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
7862 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
7863 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7864 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
7865 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
7866 values have higher priority.
7867 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
7868 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
7869 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
7870 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
7871 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007872
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007873http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007874
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007875 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
7876 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
7877 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
7878 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
7879 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
7880 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
7881 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007882
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007883 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007884
7885 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007886 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
7887 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007888
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007889http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7890 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
7891 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
7892 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007893 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
7894 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007895
7896 Arguments :
7897 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7898 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007899
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007900 See also "option forwardfor".
7901
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007902 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007903 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
7904 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
7905
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007906 # After the masking this will track connections
7907 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
7908 http-request track-sc0 src
7909
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007910 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
7911 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
7912
7913http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7914
7915 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
7916 expression.
7917
7918 Arguments:
7919 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7920 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007921
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007922 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007923 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
7924 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
7925
7926 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
7927 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
7928 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
7929
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02007930http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01007931 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7932
7933 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
7934 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
7935 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
7936 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
7937 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
7938
7939 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
7940 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
7941 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
7942 results.
7943
7944 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02007945 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
7946 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01007947
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007948http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7949
7950 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7951 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
7952 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
7953 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
7954 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
7955 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
7956 information from the request.
7957
7958 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7959
7960http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7961
7962 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
7963 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
Christopher Faulet84cdbe42022-11-22 15:41:48 +01007964 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to perform
7965 complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the path and
7966 the query string. If an absolute URI is set, it will be sent as is to
7967 HTTP/1.1 servers. If it is not the desired behavior, the host, the path
7968 and/or the query string should be set separately.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007969 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
7970
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01007971http-request set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7972http-request set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007973
7974 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7975 inline.
7976
7977 Arguments:
7978 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7979 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7980 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7981 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7982 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7983 (request and response)
7984 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7985 processing
7986 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7987 processing
7988 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7989 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
7990 and '_'.
7991
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007992 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
7993 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05007994 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007995 conditions.
7996
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007997 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7998 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007999
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02008000 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
8001 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
8002
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008003 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008004 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02008005 http-request set-var-fmt(txn.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
8006
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01008007http-request silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008008
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01008009 This stops the evaluation of the rules and removes the client-facing
8010 connection in a configurable way: When called without the rst-ttl argument,
8011 we try to prevent sending any FIN or RST packet back to the client by
8012 using TCP_REPAIR. If this fails (mainly because of missing privileges),
8013 we fall back to sending a RST packet with a TTL of 1.
8014
8015 The effect is that the client still sees an established connection while
8016 there is none on HAProxy, saving resources. However, stateful equipment
8017 placed between the HAProxy and the client (firewalls, proxies,
8018 load balancers) will also keep the established connection in their
8019 session tables.
8020
8021 The optional rst-ttl changes this behaviour: TCP_REPAIR is not used,
8022 and a RST packet with a configurable TTL is sent. When set to a
8023 reasonable value, the RST packet travels through your own equipment,
8024 deleting the connection in your middle-boxes, but does not arrive at
8025 the client. Future packets from the client will then be dropped
8026 already by your middle-boxes. These "local RST"s protect your resources,
8027 but not the client's. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008028
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008029http-request strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008030
8031 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
8032 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
8033 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
8034 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
8035 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05008036 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008037 processing.
8038
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01008039 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008040 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
8041 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
8042 rules evaluation.
8043
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008044http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8045http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
8046 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
8047 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
8048 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
8049 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008050
8051 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
8052 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
8053 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008054 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
8055 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
8056 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
8057 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
8058 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
8059 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008060 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008061 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
8062 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
8063 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05008064 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008065 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
8066 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
8067 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
8068 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
8069 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008070
8071http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8072http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8073http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8074
8075 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
8076 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01008077 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set by the
8078 global "tune.stick-counters" setting, which defaults to MAX_SESS_STKCTR if
8079 set at build time (it is reported in haproxy -vv) and which defaults to 3,
8080 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (tune.stick-counters-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008081 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
8082 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
8083 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
8084 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
8085 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
8086 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
8087 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
8088
8089 Arguments :
8090 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
8091 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
8092 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
8093 select which table entry to update the counters.
8094
8095 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
8096 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
8097 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
8098 that table until the session ends.
8099
8100 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
8101 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
8102 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
8103 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
8104 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
8105 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
8106 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
8107 useful information.
8108
8109 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
8110 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
8111 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
8112 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
8113 checks that make use of it.
8114
8115http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8116
8117 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008118
8119 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008120 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008121
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01008122http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8123
8124 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
8125 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
8126 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
8127 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
8128 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
8129 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
8130
8131 Arguments :
8132 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
8133
8134 Example:
8135 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
8136
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008137http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
8138 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8139
8140 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
8141 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
8142 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
8143 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
8144 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
8145 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
8146 http-buffer-request".
8147
8148 Arguments :
8149
8150 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
8151 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
8152
8153 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05008154 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008155 bytes.
8156
8157 Example:
8158 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
8159
8160 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8161
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008162http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008163
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008164 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
8165 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
8166 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008167
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01008168
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008169http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008170 Access control for Layer 7 responses
8171
8172 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02008173 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008174
8175 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
8176 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
8177 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
8178 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
8179 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
8180 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
8181
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008182 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
8183 supported:
8184 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
8185 - add-header <name> <fmt>
8186 - allow
8187 - cache-store <name>
8188 - capture <sample> id <id>
8189 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
8190 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
8191 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
8192 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
8193 - redirect <rule>
8194 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
8195 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
8196 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01008197 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008198 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
8199 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
8200 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
8201 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
8202 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
8203 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01008204 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008205 - set-header <name> <fmt>
8206 - set-log-level <level>
8207 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
8208 - set-mark <mark>
8209 - set-nice <nice>
8210 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
8211 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01008212 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
8213 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +01008214 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008215 - strict-mode { on | off }
8216 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
8217 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
8218 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
8219 - unset-var(<var-name>)
8220 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
8221
8222 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008223
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008224 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008225
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02008226 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
8227 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
8228 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
8229 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
8230 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
8231 a defaults section defining such rules.
8232
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008233 Example:
8234 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02008235
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008236 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008237
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008238 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
8239 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008240
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008241 Example:
8242 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008243
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008244 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008245
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008246 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
8247 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008248
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008249 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8250 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008251
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008252http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008253
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008254 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
8255 add-acl" for a complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008256
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008257http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008258
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008259 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008260 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
8261 complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008262
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008263http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008264
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008265 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
8266 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008267
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02008268http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008269
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008270 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008271
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008272http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008273
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008274 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
8275 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
8276 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
8277 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
8278 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
8279 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
8280 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02008281
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008282 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
8283 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
8284 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
8285 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
8286 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01008287
8288 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
8289 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
8290 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
8291 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02008292
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008293http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02008294
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008295 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
8296 del-acl" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02008297
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00008298http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02008299
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008300 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
8301 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02008302
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008303http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02008304
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008305 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
8306 del-map" for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008307
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008308http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8309http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
8310 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
8311 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
8312 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
8313 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008314
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008315 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
8316 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
8317 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05008318 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008319 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
8320 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
8321 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01008322 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008323 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008324
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008325http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008326
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008327 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
8328 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
8329 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
8330 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
8331 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
8332 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02008333
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008334http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
8335 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02008336
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01008337 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
8338 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01008339
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008340 Example:
8341 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02008342
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008343 # applied to:
8344 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008345
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008346 # outputs:
8347 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008348
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008349 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008350
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008351http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
8352 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008353
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01008354 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01008355 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008356
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008357 Example:
8358 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01008359
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008360 # applied to:
8361 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01008362
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008363 # outputs:
8364 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01008365
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01008366http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
8367 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
8368 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01008369 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01008370 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8371
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008372 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a
8373 response. Please refer to "http-request return" for a complete
8374 description. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01008375
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01008376http-response sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
8377 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8378
8379 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
8380 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
8381 a complete description.
8382
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02008383http-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008384http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8385http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08008386
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008387 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
8388 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
8389 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
8390 description.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008391
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02008392http-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008393 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01008394http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
8395 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008396
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008397 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
8398 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +02008399 sc-set-gpt" and "http-request sc-set-gpt0" for a complete description.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01008400
Christopher Faulet24e7f352021-08-12 09:32:07 +02008401http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
8402 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008403
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008404 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
8405 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02008406
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01008407http-response set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
8408 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02008409
8410 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
8411 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
8412 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
8413
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008414http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008415
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008416 This does the same as "http-response add-header" except that the header name
8417 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
8418 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
8419 external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008420
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008421http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8422
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008423 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
8424 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008425
8426http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
8427
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008428 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
8429 set-map" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008430
8431http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8432
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008433 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
8434 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
8435 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008436
8437http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8438
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008439 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
8440 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008441
8442http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
8443 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8444
8445 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
8446 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
8447 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
8448 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008449
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008450 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008451 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
8452 http-response set-status 431
8453 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
8454 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008455
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008456http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008457
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008458 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008459 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
8460 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008461
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01008462http-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8463http-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008464
8465 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008466 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
8467 for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008468
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01008469http-response silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008470
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008471 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
8472 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008473 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
8474 complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008475
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008476http-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008477
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008478 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
8479 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008480
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008481http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8482http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8483http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008484
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008485 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
8486 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
8487 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008488
8489http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8490
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008491 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008492 about <var-name>.
8493
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008494http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
8495 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8496
8497 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008498 most <time> milliseconds. Please refer to "http-request wait-for-body" for a
8499 complete description.
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008500
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02008501
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008502http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
8503 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
8504
8505 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8506 yes | no | yes | yes
8507
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008508 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008509 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
8510 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
8511 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008512
8513 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
8514
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008515 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
8516 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
8517 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
8518 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
8519 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
8520 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
8521 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008522 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008523 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
8524 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008525
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008526 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
8527 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
8528 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
8529 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
8530 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
8531 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
8532 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02008533 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
8534 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
8535 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
8536 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
8537 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
8538 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008539
8540 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
8541 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
8542 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
8543 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
8544 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
8545 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
8546 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
8547 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02008548 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008549 downsides of rare connection failures.
8550
8551 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
8552 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
8553 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
8554 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
8555 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
8556 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008557 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008558 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
8559 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
8560 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
8561 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
8562 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
8563
8564 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01008565 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
8566 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
8567 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
8568 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008569
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01008570 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
8571 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008572
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01008573 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008574
8575 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
8576 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
8577 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
8578
Willy Tarreau44fce8b2022-11-25 09:17:18 +01008579 The rules to decide to keep an idle connection opened or to close it after
8580 processing are also governed by the "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio" (default: 20%)
8581 and "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio" (default: 25%). These correspond to the
8582 percentage of total file descriptors spent in idle connections above which
8583 haproxy will respectively refrain from keeping a connection opened after a
8584 response, and actively kill idle connections. Some setups using a very high
8585 ratio of idle connections, either because of too low a global "maxconn", or
8586 due to a lot of HTTP/2 or HTTP/3 traffic on the frontend (few connections)
8587 but HTTP/1 connections on the backend, may observe a lower reuse rate because
8588 too few connections are kept open. It may be desirable in this case to adjust
8589 such thresholds or simply to increase the global "maxconn" value.
8590
8591 Similarly, when thread groups are explicitly enabled, it is important to
8592 understand that idle connections are only usable between threads from a same
8593 group. As such it may happen that unfair load between groups leads to more
8594 idle connections being needed, causing a lower reuse rate. The same solution
8595 may then be applied (increase global "maxconn" or increase pool ratios).
8596
8597 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn", "thread-groups",
8598 "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio", "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio"
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008599
8600
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008601http-send-name-header [<header>]
8602 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008603 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8604 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008605 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008606 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
8607
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02008608 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
8609 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
8610 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
8611 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
8612 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
8613 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
8614 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
8615 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
8616 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
8617 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
8618 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
8619 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
8620 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
8621 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
8622 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
8623 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008624
8625 See also : "server"
8626
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008627id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008628 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
8629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8630 no | yes | yes | yes
8631 Arguments : none
8632
8633 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
8634 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
8635 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008636
8637
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008638ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
8639 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
8640 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01008641 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008642
8643 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
8644 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
8645 and running).
8646
8647 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
8648 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
8649 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008650 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008651 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
8652
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008653 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
8654 "unless" condition is met.
8655
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008656 Example:
8657 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8658 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8659 ignore-persist if url_static
8660
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008661 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
8662
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008663load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
8664 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
8665 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8666 yes | no | yes | yes
8667
8668 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
8669 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
8670 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008671 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008672 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008673 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
8674 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
8675 over the stats socket and redirect output.
8676
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008677 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008678 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02008679 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008680
8681 Arguments:
8682 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
8683 named "server-state-file".
8684
8685 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
8686 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
8687 name is used as a file name.
8688
8689 none don't load any stat for this backend
8690
8691 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01008692 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
8693 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
8694 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008695 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01008696 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008697
8698 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
8699 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
8700
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008701 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008702
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008703 global
8704 stats socket /tmp/socket
8705 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008706
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008707 defaults
8708 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008709
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008710 backend bk
8711 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
8712 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008713
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008714
8715 Then one can run :
8716
8717 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
8718
8719 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
8720
8721 1
8722 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
8723 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8724 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8725
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008726 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008727
8728 global
8729 stats socket /tmp/socket
8730 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
8731
8732 defaults
8733 load-server-state-from-file local
8734
8735 backend bk
8736 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
8737 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
8738
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008739
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008740 Then one can run :
8741
8742 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
8743
8744 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
8745
8746 1
8747 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
8748 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8749 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8750
8751 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
8752 "show servers state"
8753
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008754
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008755log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01008756log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02008757 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008758no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008759 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
8760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8761 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008762
8763 Prefix :
8764 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
8765 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
8766 prefix does not allow arguments.
8767
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008768 Arguments :
8769 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
8770 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
8771 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
8772 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
8773 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
8774 parameter.
8775
8776 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
8777 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
8778
8779 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
8780 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
8781 standard syslog port).
8782
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01008783 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
8784 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
8785 standard syslog port).
8786
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008787 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
8788 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
8789 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008790 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008791
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008792 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
8793 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
8794 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
8795 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
8796 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
8797 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
8798 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
8799 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
8800 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
8801 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
8802 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
8803 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008804 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008805 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
8806 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
8807 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008808 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
8809 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008810
8811 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
8812 and "fd@2", see above.
8813
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02008814 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
8815 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
8816 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
8817 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
8818 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
8819 having the logs instantly available.
8820
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02008821 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
8822 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
8823 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
8824
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008825 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8826 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01008827
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02008828 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
8829 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
8830 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
8831 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
8832 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
8833 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
8834 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
8835 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
8836 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
8837 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008838 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02008839
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02008840 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
8841 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
8842 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
8843 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
8844 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
8845
8846 <sample_size>
8847 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
8848 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
8849 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
8850 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
8851 (see also <ranges> parameter).
8852
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01008853 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
8854 one of the following :
8855
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01008856 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
8857 field is stripped. This is the default.
8858 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
8859 rfc3164.
8860
8861 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01008862 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
8863
8864 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
8865 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
8866
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02008867 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
8868 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
8869 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
8870 designed to be used with a local log server.
8871
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01008872 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
8873 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
8874 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
8875 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
8876 systemd logger consumes.
8877
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02008878 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
8879 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
8880 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
8881 used with a local log server.
8882
8883 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
8884 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
8885 designed to be used with a local log server.
8886
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008887 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
8888 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
8889 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
8890 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
8891
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008892 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
8893
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01008894 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
8895 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
8896 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
8897
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008898 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
8899 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
8900 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
8901 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008902
8903 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
8904 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
8905 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02008906 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
8907 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
8908 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
8909 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
8910 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008911
8912 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
8913
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008914 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
8915 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
8916 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008917
8918 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
8919 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
8920 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
8921 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
8922
8923 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
8924 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008925
8926 Example :
8927 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008928 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
8929 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
8930 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02008931 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02008932 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
8933 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008934 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01008935
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008936
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008937log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01008938 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
8939 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8940 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008941
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01008942 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
8943 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
8944 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
8945 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
8946 string in depth.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02008947 A specific log-format used only in case of connection error can also be
8948 defined, see the "error-log-format" option.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008949
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02008950 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format",
8951 "option httplog" and "option httpslog" directives.
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008952
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02008953log-format-sd <string>
8954 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
8955 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8956 yes | yes | yes | no
8957
8958 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
8959 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
8960 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
8961 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
8962 which covers the log format string in depth.
8963
8964 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
8965 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
8966
8967 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
8968 log format to "rfc5424".
8969
8970 Example :
8971 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
8972
8973
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01008974log-tag <string>
8975 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
8976 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8977 yes | yes | yes | yes
8978
8979 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
8980 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008981 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01008982 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
8983 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
8984 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
8985 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
8986 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
8987 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008988
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008989max-keep-alive-queue <value>
8990 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
8991 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8992 yes | no | yes | yes
8993
8994 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
8995 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
8996 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
8997 servers.
8998
8999 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009000 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02009001 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
9002 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
9003 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009004 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02009005 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
9006 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
9007 picking a different server.
9008
9009 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
9010 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
9011 even if they have to be queued.
9012
9013 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
9014 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
9015
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01009016max-session-srv-conns <nb>
9017 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
9018 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
9019 defined at build time).
Aurelien DARRAGON04445cf2023-11-20 17:53:36 +01009020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9021 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02009022
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009023maxconn <conns>
9024 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
9025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9026 yes | yes | yes | no
9027 Arguments :
9028 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
9029 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
9030 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
9031 closes.
9032
9033 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009034 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009035 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
9036 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01009037 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
9038 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
9039 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
9040 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009041
9042 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
9043 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
9044 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
9045
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01009046 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
9047 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02009048
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009049 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
9050
9051
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02009052mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009053 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
9054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9055 yes | yes | yes | yes
9056 Arguments :
9057 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
9058 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
9059 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
9060 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
9061
9062 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
9063 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
9064 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
9065 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
9066 brings HAProxy most of its value.
9067
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009068 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
9069 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
9070 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009071
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009072 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009073 defaults http_instances
9074 mode http
9075
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009076
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009077monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009078 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9080 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009081 Arguments :
9082 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
9083 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009084 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009085 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
9086 backend and its backup.
9087
9088 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
9089 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
9090 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
9091 servers in a list of backends.
9092
9093 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
9094 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
9095 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009096 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009097 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
9098 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009099 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02009100 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
9101 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009102
9103 Example:
9104 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009105 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009106 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9107 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9108 monitor-uri /site_alive
9109 monitor fail if site_dead
9110
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02009111 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009112
9113
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009114monitor-uri <uri>
9115 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
9116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9117 yes | yes | yes | no
9118 Arguments :
9119 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
9120 health status instead of forwarding the request.
9121
9122 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
9123 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
9124 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
9125 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
9126 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
9127 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
9128 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
9129 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
9130
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01009131 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009132 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
9133 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
Willy Tarreau7fe0c622022-11-25 10:24:44 +01009134 purpose. Only one URI may be configured for monitoring; when multiple
9135 "monitor-uri" statements are present, the last one will define the URI to
9136 be used. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009137 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
9138 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
9139 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009140
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01009141 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
9142 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
9143 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
9144 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
9145
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009146 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009147 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009148 frontend www
9149 mode http
9150 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
9151
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02009152 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009153
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009154
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009155option abortonclose
9156no option abortonclose
9157 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
9158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9159 yes | no | yes | yes
9160 Arguments : none
9161
9162 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
9163 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
9164 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
9165 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009166 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009167 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
9168 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
9169 encountered while delivering the response.
9170
9171 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
9172 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
9173 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
9174 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
9175 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
9176 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009177 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009178 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009179 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009180 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
9181 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
9182 still not served and not pollute the servers.
9183
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009184 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
9185 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009186 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
9187 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
9188 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
9189 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
9190 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
9191 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009192 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009193
9194 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9195 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9196
9197 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
9198
9199
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009200option accept-invalid-http-request
9201no option accept-invalid-http-request
9202 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
9203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9204 yes | yes | yes | no
9205 Arguments : none
9206
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02009207 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009208 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009209 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009210 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
9211 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
9212 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
9213 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
9214 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01009215 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
9216 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
9217 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
9218 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009219 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02009220 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02009221 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
Willy Tarreau1ba30162022-05-24 15:34:26 +02009222 to pass through (no version specified), as well as different protocol names
9223 (e.g. RTSP), and multiple digits for both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau965fb742023-08-08 19:35:25 +02009224 Finally, this option also allows incoming URLs to contain fragment references
9225 ('#' after the path).
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009226
9227 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
9228 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
9229 been confirmed.
9230
9231 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
9232 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01009233 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
9234 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009235 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
9236
9237 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9238 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9239
9240 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
9241 stats socket.
9242
9243
9244option accept-invalid-http-response
9245no option accept-invalid-http-response
9246 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
9247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9248 yes | no | yes | yes
9249 Arguments : none
9250
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02009251 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009252 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009253 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009254 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
9255 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
9256 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
9257 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
9258 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02009259 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
9260 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
9261 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009262
9263 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
9264 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
9265 been confirmed.
9266
9267 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
9268 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
9269 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
9270 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
9271
9272 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9273 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9274
9275 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
9276 stats socket.
9277
9278
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009279option allbackups
9280no option allbackups
9281 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
9282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9283 yes | no | yes | yes
9284 Arguments : none
9285
9286 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
9287 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
9288 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
9289 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
9290 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
9291 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
9292 order between the backup servers anymore.
9293
9294 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
9295 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
9296
9297 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9298 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9299
9300
9301option checkcache
9302no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08009303 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9305 yes | no | yes | yes
9306 Arguments : none
9307
9308 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
9309 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009310 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009311 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
9312 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009313 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009314
9315 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009316 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009317 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009318 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
9319 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009320 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009321 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01009322 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
9323 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009324 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01009325 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
9326 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009327 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009328 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
9329 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
9330 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
9331 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
9332 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
9333 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
9334 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
9335 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
9336 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
9337
9338 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009339 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
9340 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
9341 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
9342 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009343
9344 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
9345 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009346 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009347 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009348
9349 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9350 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9351
9352
9353option clitcpka
9354no option clitcpka
9355 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
9356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9357 yes | yes | yes | no
9358 Arguments : none
9359
9360 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9361 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009362 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009363 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9364
9365 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9366 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9367 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9368 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9369
9370 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9371 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9372 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9373 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9374 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9375
9376 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9377
9378 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9379 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9380 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
9381
9382 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9383 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9384
9385 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
9386
9387
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009388option contstats
9389 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
9390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9391 yes | yes | yes | no
9392 Arguments : none
9393
9394 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
9395 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
9396 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009397 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01009398 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
9399 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
9400 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
9401 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
9402 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009403
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02009404option disable-h2-upgrade
9405no option disable-h2-upgrade
9406 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
9407 connection.
9408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9409 yes | yes | yes | no
9410 Arguments : none
9411
9412 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
9413 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
9414 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
9415 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01009416 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
9417 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
9418 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
9419 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
9420 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
9421 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02009422
9423 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9424 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009425
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009426option dontlog-normal
9427no option dontlog-normal
9428 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
9429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9430 yes | yes | yes | no
9431 Arguments : none
9432
9433 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
9434 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
9435 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
9436 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
9437 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
9438 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
9439 logged.
9440
9441 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
9442 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
9443 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
9444
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009445 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009446 logging.
9447
9448
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009449option dontlognull
9450no option dontlognull
9451 Enable or disable logging of null connections
9452 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9453 yes | yes | yes | no
9454 Arguments : none
9455
9456 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
9457 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
9458 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
9459 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
9460 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
9461 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009462 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
9463 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
9464 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009465
9466 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009467 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009468 would not be logged.
9469
9470 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9471 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9472
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02009473 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009474 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009475
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009476option forwarded [ proto ]
9477 [ host | host-expr <host_expr> ]
9478 [ by | by-expr <by_expr> ] [ by_port | by_port-expr <by_port_expr>]
9479 [ for | for-expr <for_expr> ] [ for_port | for_port-expr <for_port_expr>]
9480no option forwarded
9481 Enable insertion of the rfc 7239 forwarded header in requests sent to servers
9482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9483 yes | no | yes | yes
9484 Arguments :
9485 <host_expr> optional argument to specify a custom sample expression
9486 those result will be used as 'host' parameter value
9487
9488 <by_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9489 those result will be used as 'by' parameter nodename value
9490
9491 <for_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9492 those result will be used as 'for' parameter nodename value
9493
9494 <by_port_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9495 those result will be used as 'by' parameter nodeport value
9496
9497 <for_port_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9498 those result will be used as 'for' parameter nodeport value
9499
9500
Ilya Shipitsin07be66d2023-04-01 12:26:42 +02009501 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, servers are losing some request
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009502 context (request origin: client ip address, protocol used...)
9503
9504 A common way to address this limitation is to use the well known
9505 x-forward-for and x-forward-* friends to expose some of this context to the
9506 underlying servers/applications.
9507 While this use to work and is widely deployed, it is not officially supported
9508 by the IETF and can be the root of some interoperability as well as security
9509 issues.
9510
9511 To solve this, a new HTTP extension has been described by the IETF:
9512 forwarded header (RFC7239).
9513 More information here: https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7239.html
9514
Ilya Shipitsin07be66d2023-04-01 12:26:42 +02009515 The use of this single header allow to convey numerous details
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009516 within the same header, and most importantly, fixes the proxy chaining
9517 issue. (the rfc allows for multiple chained proxies to append their own
9518 values to an already existing header).
9519
9520 This option may be specified in defaults, listen or backend section, but it
9521 will be ignored for frontend sections.
9522
9523 Setting option forwarded without arguments results in using default implicit
9524 behavior.
9525 Default behavior enables proto parameter and injects original client ip.
9526
9527 The equivalent explicit/manual configuration would be:
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01009528 option forwarded proto for
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009529
9530 The keyword 'by' is used to enable 'by' parameter ("nodename") in
9531 forwarded header. It allows to embed request proxy information.
9532 'by' value will be set to proxy ip (destination address)
9533 If not available (ie: UNIX listener), 'by' will be set to
9534 "unknown".
9535
9536 The keyword 'by-expr' is used to enable 'by' parameter ("nodename") in
9537 forwarded header. It allows to embed request proxy information.
9538 'by' value will be set to the result of the sample expression
9539 <by_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be set to "unknown".
9540
9541 The keyword 'for' is used to enable 'for' parameter ("nodename") in
9542 forwarded header. It allows to embed request client information.
9543 'for' value will be set to client ip (source address)
9544 If not available (ie: UNIX listener), 'for' will be set to
9545 "unknown".
9546
9547 The keyword 'for-expr' is used to enable 'for' parameter ("nodename") in
9548 forwarded header. It allows to embed request client information.
9549 'for' value will be set to the result of the sample expression
9550 <for_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be set to "unknown".
9551
9552 The keyword 'by_port' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9553 'by' parameter. 'by_port' requires 'by' or 'by-expr' to be set or
9554 it will be ignored.
9555 "nodeport" will be set to proxy (destination) port if available,
9556 otherwise it will be ignored.
9557
9558 The keyword 'by_port-expr' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9559 'by' parameter. 'by_port-expr' requires 'by' or 'by-expr' to be set or
9560 it will be ignored.
9561 "nodeport" will be set to the result of the sample expression
9562 <by_port_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be ignored.
9563
9564 The keyword 'for_port' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9565 'for' parameter. 'for_port' requires 'for' or 'for-expr' to be set or
9566 it will be ignored.
9567 "nodeport" will be set to client (source) port if available,
9568 otherwise it will be ignored.
9569
9570 The keyword 'for_port-expr' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9571 'for' parameter. 'for_port-expr' requires 'for' or 'for-expr' to be set or
9572 it will be ignored.
9573 "nodeport" will be set to the result of the sample expression
9574 <for_port_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be ignored.
9575
9576 Examples :
9577 # Those servers want the ip address and protocol of the client request
9578 # Resulting header would look like this:
9579 # forwarded: proto=http;for=127.0.0.1
9580 backend www_default
9581 mode http
9582 option forwarded
9583 #equivalent to: option forwarded proto for
9584
9585 # Those servers want the requested host and hashed client ip address
9586 # as well as client source port (you should use seed for xxh32 if ensuring
9587 # ip privacy is a concern)
9588 # Resulting header would look like this:
9589 # forwarded: host="haproxy.org";for="_000000007F2F367E:60138"
9590 backend www_host
9591 mode http
9592 option forwarded host for-expr src,xxh32,hex for_port
9593
9594 # Those servers want custom data in host, for and by parameters
9595 # Resulting header would look like this:
9596 # forwarded: host="host.com";by=_haproxy;for="[::1]:10"
9597 backend www_custom
9598 mode http
9599 option forwarded host-expr str(host.com) by-expr str(_haproxy) for for_port-expr int(10)
9600
9601 # Those servers want random 'for' obfuscated identifiers for request
9602 # tracing purposes while protecting sensitive IP information
9603 # Resulting header would look like this:
9604 # forwarded: for=_000000002B1F4D63
9605 backend www_for_hide
9606 mode http
9607 option forwarded for-expr rand,hex
9608
9609 See also : "option forwardfor", "option originalto"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009610
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009611option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009612 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
9613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9614 yes | yes | yes | yes
9615 Arguments :
9616 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9617 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009618 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009619 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009620
9621 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
9622 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
9623 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
9624 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
9625 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
9626 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
9627 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009628 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
9629 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9630 possible that the client has already brought one.
9631
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009632 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009633 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009634 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009635 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009636 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009637 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009638
9639 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9640 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9641 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
9642 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
9643 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
9644 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01009645 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009646
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009647 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
9648 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009649 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009650 are under the control of the end-user.
9651
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009652 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009653 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9654 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009655 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
9656 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
9657 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009658
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02009659 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009660 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
9661 frontend www
9662 mode http
9663 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
9664
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009665 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
9666 backend www
9667 mode http
9668 option forwardfor header X-Client
9669
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009670 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009671 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009672
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009673
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02009674option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
9675no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
9676 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
9677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9678 yes | yes | yes | no
9679 Arguments : none
9680
9681 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
9682 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
9683 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
9684 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
9685 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
9686 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
9687 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
9688
9689 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
9690 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
9691 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
9692 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
9693 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
9694 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
9695 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
9696 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
9697 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
9698 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
9699
9700 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
9701
9702 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9703 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9704
9705 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
9706 "h1-case-adjust-file".
9707
9708
9709option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
9710no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
9711 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
9712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9713 yes | no | yes | yes
9714 Arguments : none
9715
9716 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
9717 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
9718 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
9719 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
9720 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
9721 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
9722 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
9723
9724 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
9725 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
9726 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
9727 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
9728 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
9729 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
9730 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
9731 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
9732 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
9733 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
9734
9735 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
9736
9737 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9738 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9739
9740 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
9741 "h1-case-adjust-file".
9742
9743
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009744option http-buffer-request
9745no option http-buffer-request
9746 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
9747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9748 yes | yes | yes | yes
9749 Arguments : none
9750
9751 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
9752 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
9753 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
9754 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
9755 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
9756 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01009757 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
9758 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
9759 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
9760 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009761
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02009762 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
9763 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009764
9765
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009766option http-ignore-probes
9767no option http-ignore-probes
9768 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
9769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9770 yes | yes | yes | no
9771 Arguments : none
9772
9773 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
9774 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
9775 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
9776 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
9777 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
9778 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
9779 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
9780 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
9781 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009782 was received over a connection before it was closed;
9783 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009784 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
9785
9786 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
9787 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
9788 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
9789 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
9790 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
9791 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
9792 are often the only way to detect them.
9793
9794 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9795 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9796
9797 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
9798
9799
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009800option http-keep-alive
9801no option http-keep-alive
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009802 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server for HTTP/1.x
9803 connections
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9805 yes | yes | yes | yes
9806 Arguments : none
9807
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009808 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009809 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
9810 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
9811 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
9812 httpclose". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be
9813 useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009814
9815 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
9816 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009817 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
9818 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
9819 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
9820 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
9821 situations where this option may be useful :
9822
9823 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009824 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009825
9826 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
9827 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
9828
9829 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009830
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009831 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
9832 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
9833 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
9834 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
9835 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
9836 not set.
9837
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009838 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009839 http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009840
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009841 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009842 "option prefer-last-server" and "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009843
9844
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009845option http-no-delay
9846no option http-no-delay
9847 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
9848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9849 yes | yes | yes | yes
9850 Arguments : none
9851
9852 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
9853 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
9854 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
9855 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
9856 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
9857 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
9858 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009859 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009860 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
9861 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
9862 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
9863 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
9864 affected.
9865
9866 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
9867 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
9868 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
9869 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
9870 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
9871 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
9872 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
9873 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
9874 latency environments.
9875
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009876 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
9877
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009878
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009879option http-pretend-keepalive
9880no option http-pretend-keepalive
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009881 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive for HTTP/1.x connection to the
9882 server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02009884 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009885 Arguments : none
9886
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009887 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009888 adds a "Connection: close" header to the HTTP/1.x request forwarded to the
9889 server. Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically
9890 refrain from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length,
9891 while this is totally unrelated. The effect is that a client or a cache could
9892 receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and consider the
9893 response complete.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009894
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009895 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009896 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009897 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009898 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009899 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009900 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
9901
9902 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
9903 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
9904 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
9905 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009906 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
9907 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009908 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
9909
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02009910 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
9911 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
9912 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009913 frontend.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009914
9915 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9916 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9917
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009918 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009919 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009920
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +02009921option http-restrict-req-hdr-names { preserve | delete | reject }
9922 Set HAProxy policy about HTTP request header names containing characters
9923 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset
9924 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9925 yes | yes | yes | yes
9926 Arguments :
9927 preserve disable the filtering. It is the default mode for HTTP proxies
9928 with no FastCGI application configured.
9929
9930 delete remove request headers with a name containing a character
9931 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset. It is the default mode for
9932 HTTP backends with a configured FastCGI application.
9933
9934 reject reject the request with a 403-Forbidden response if it contains a
9935 header name with a character outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset.
9936
9937 This option may be used to restrict the request header names to alphanumeric
9938 and hyphen characters ([A-Za-z0-9-]). This may be mandatory to interoperate
9939 with non-HTTP compliant servers that fail to handle some characters in header
9940 names. It may also be mandatory for FastCGI applications because all
9941 non-alphanumeric characters in header names are replaced by an underscore
9942 ('_'). Thus, it is easily possible to mix up header names and bypass some
9943 rules. For instance, "X-Forwarded-For" and "X_Forwarded-For" headers are both
9944 converted to "HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR" in FastCGI.
9945
9946 Note this option is evaluated per proxy and after the http-request rules
9947 evaluation.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009948
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009949option http-server-close
9950no option http-server-close
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009951 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing on the server side
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9953 yes | yes | yes | yes
9954 Arguments : none
9955
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009956 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009957 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
9958 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
9959 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
9960 httpclose". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close
9961 mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive
9962 and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the
9963 client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side
9964 to save server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
9965 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
9966 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
9967 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
9968 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
9969 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009970
9971 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
9972 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
9973 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
9974 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009975 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
9976 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009977
9978 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
9979 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009980 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
9981 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
9982 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009983
9984 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9985 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9986
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009987 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive" and
9988 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009989
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009990option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009991no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009992 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
9993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9994 yes | yes | yes | no
9995 Arguments : none
9996
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00009997 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009998 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
9999 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
10000 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
10001 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
10002 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010003 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010004
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010005 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010006 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +010010007 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
10008 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
10009 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010010
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +010010011 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
10012 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
10013 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
10014 front of an existing proxy.
10015
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010016 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
10017
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +020010018 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010019
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010020option httpchk
10021option httpchk <uri>
10022option httpchk <method> <uri>
10023option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010024 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10026 yes | no | yes | yes
10027 Arguments :
10028 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
10029 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
10030 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
10031 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
10032 ones.
10033
10034 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
10035 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
10036 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
10037
10038 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
10039 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
10040 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +020010041 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010042
10043 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
10044 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
10045 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
10046 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
10047 the lack of any response.
10048
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +020010049 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
10050 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
10051 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
10052 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
10053
10054 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
10055 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
10056 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010057
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +020010058 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
10059 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +020010060 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040010061 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +020010062 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010063
10064 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010065 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
10066 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
10067 backend https_relay
10068 mode tcp
10069 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
10070 http-check send hdr Host www
10071 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010072
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010073 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
10074 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
10075 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010076
10077
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010078option httpclose
10079no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010080 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10082 yes | yes | yes | yes
10083 Arguments : none
10084
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010085 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010086 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
10087 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
10088 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
10089 httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010090
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010091 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close the client or the server
Christopher Fauletd17dd842023-02-20 17:30:06 +010010092 connection, depending where the option is set. The frontend is considered for
10093 client connections while the backend is considered for server ones. If the
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010094 option is set on a listener, it is applied both on client and server
10095 connections. It will check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in
10096 each direction, and will add one if missing.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010097
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +020010098 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010099 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" request header, but will
10100 still cause the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010101
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +020010102 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010103 http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010104
10105 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10106 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10107
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010108 See also : "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010109
10110
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010111option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010112 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
10113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +010010114 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010115 Arguments :
10116 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
10117 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
10118 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010119 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010120 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010121
10122 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
10123 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
10124 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
10125 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
10126 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
10127 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
10128 ports.
10129
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +010010130 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
10131 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010132
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +020010133 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
10134
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010135 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010136
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020010137option httpslog
10138 Enable logging of HTTPS request, session state and timers
10139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10140 yes | yes | yes | no
10141
10142 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
10143 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
10144 "option httpslog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
10145 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
10146 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
10147 frontend, backend and server name, the SSL certificate verification and SSL
10148 handshake statuses, and of course the source address and ports.
10149
10150 "option httpslog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
10151
10152 See also : section 8 about logging.
10153
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010154
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010155option independent-streams
10156no option independent-streams
10157 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +020010158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10159 yes | yes | yes | yes
10160 Arguments : none
10161
10162 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
10163 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
10164 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
10165 receive data or not.
10166
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010167 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +020010168 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
10169 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
10170 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
10171 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
10172 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
10173 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
10174 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
10175 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
10176 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
10177 socket buffers.
10178
10179 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
10180 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
10181 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
10182 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
10183 slow lines, so use it with caution.
10184
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010185 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +020010186
10187
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +020010188option ldap-check
10189 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
10190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10191 yes | no | yes | yes
10192 Arguments : none
10193
10194 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
10195 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
10196 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
10197 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
10198
10199 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
10200 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
10201
10202 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
10203 configure it.
10204
10205 Example :
10206 option ldap-check
10207
10208 See also : "option httpchk"
10209
10210
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010211option external-check
10212 Use external processes for server health checks
10213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10214 yes | no | yes | yes
10215
10216 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
10217 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
10218 command".
10219
10220 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
10221
10222 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
10223
10224
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +010010225option idle-close-on-response
10226no option idle-close-on-response
10227 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
10228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10229 yes | yes | yes | no
10230 Arguments : none
10231
10232 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
10233 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
10234 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
10235 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
10236 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
10237 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
10238 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
10239 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
10240 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
10241
10242 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
10243 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
10244
10245 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
10246 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
10247 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
10248 needed in case of frequent reloads.
10249
10250 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
10251 "hard-stop-after"
10252
10253
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +020010254option log-health-checks
10255no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +020010256 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +020010257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10258 yes | no | yes | yes
10259 Arguments : none
10260
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +020010261 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
10262 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
10263 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +020010264
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +020010265 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
10266 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
10267 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
10268 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
10269 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
10270
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010271 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +020010272 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +020010273
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +020010274 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
10275 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
10276 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +020010277
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010278
10279option log-separate-errors
10280no option log-separate-errors
10281 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
10282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10283 yes | yes | yes | no
10284 Arguments : none
10285
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010286 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010287 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
10288 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
10289 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
10290 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
10291 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
10292 provides very important information.
10293
10294 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
10295 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
10296 error logs.
10297
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010298 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010299 logging.
10300
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010301
10302option logasap
10303no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +020010304 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10306 yes | yes | yes | no
10307 Arguments : none
10308
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +020010309 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
10310 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
10311 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
10312 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
10313
10314 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
10315 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
10316 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
10317 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
10318 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050010319 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +020010320 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
10321 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
10322 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
10323 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050010324 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010325
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010326 Examples :
10327 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
10328 mode http
10329 option httplog
10330 option logasap
10331 log 192.168.2.200 local3
10332
10333 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
10334 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
10335 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
10336 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
10337
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010338 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010339 logging.
10340
10341
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +020010342option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010343 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10345 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010346 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010347 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
10348 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +020010349 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
10350 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010351
10352 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
10353 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010354 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010355 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +100010356 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
10357 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
10358 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010359
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +100010360 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
10361 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
10362 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010363
10364 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010365 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010366 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
10367 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
10368 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
10369 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
10370 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
10371 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
10372 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
10373
10374 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
10375 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010376
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +020010377 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010378
10379 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
10380 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
10381 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
10382 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +020010383 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010384 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010385
10386 See also: "option httpchk"
10387
10388
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010389option nolinger
10390no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010391 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010392 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10393 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010394 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010395
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010396 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010397 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
10398 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
10399 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
10400 connections.
10401
10402 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
10403 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010404 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
10405 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
10406 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
10407 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
10408 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
10409 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
10410 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
10411 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
10412 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
10413 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
10414 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
10415 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
10416 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010417
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010418 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
10419 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
10420 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
10421 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
10422 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010423
10424 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
10425 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010426 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050010427 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010428 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010429
10430 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10431 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10432
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010433 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
10434 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010435
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010436option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
10437 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
10438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10439 yes | yes | yes | yes
10440 Arguments :
10441 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
10442 matching <network>
10443 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
10444 header name.
10445
10446 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
10447 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
10448 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
10449 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
10450 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
10451 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
10452 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
10453 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
10454 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
10455 possible that the client has already brought one.
10456
10457 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
10458 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
10459 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
10460 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
10461 header and requires different one.
10462
10463 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
10464 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
10465 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +010010466 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
10467 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
10468 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
10469 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
10470 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010471
10472 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
10473 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
10474 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
10475 both are defined.
10476
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010477 Examples :
10478 # Original Destination address
10479 frontend www
10480 mode http
10481 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
10482
10483 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
10484 backend www
10485 mode http
10486 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
10487
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +020010488 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010489
10490
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010491option persist
10492no option persist
10493 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
10494 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10495 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010496 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010497
10498 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
10499 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
10500 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
10501 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
10502 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
10503 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
10504 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
10505 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
10506 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
10507 redirected to another valid server.
10508
10509 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10510 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10511
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +010010512 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010513
10514
Christopher Faulet59307b32022-10-03 15:00:59 +020010515option pgsql-check user <username>
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +010010516 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
10517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10518 yes | no | yes | yes
10519 Arguments :
10520 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
10521 PostgreSQL server.
10522
10523 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
10524 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
10525 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
10526 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
10527
10528 See also: "option httpchk"
10529
10530
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010531option prefer-last-server
10532no option prefer-last-server
10533 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
10534 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10535 yes | no | yes | yes
10536 Arguments : none
10537
10538 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010539 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010540 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
10541 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010542 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010543 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010544 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010545 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
10546 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +010010547 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010548 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +020010549 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
10550 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
10551 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +010010552 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
10553 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
10554 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010555
10556 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10557 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10558
10559 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
10560
10561
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010562option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010563option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010564no option redispatch
10565 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
10566 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10567 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010568 Arguments :
10569 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
10570 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
10571 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010572 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010573 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010574 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010575 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
10576 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
10577 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
10578
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010579
10580 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
10581 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
10582 be able to access the service anymore.
10583
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +010010584 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
10585 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010586
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +020010587 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
10588 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
10589 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
10590 following order:
10591
10592 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
10593
10594 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
10595 list, or
10596
10597 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
10598
10599 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
10600 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
10601
10602 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
10603 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
10604 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
10605 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
10606
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010607 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010608 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
10609 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010610
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010611 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10612 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10613
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010614 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010615
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010616
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +020010617option redis-check
10618 Use redis health checks for server testing
10619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10620 yes | no | yes | yes
10621 Arguments : none
10622
10623 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
10624 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
10625 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
10626 find the "+PONG" response message.
10627
10628 Example :
10629 option redis-check
10630
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010631 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +020010632
10633
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010634option smtpchk
10635option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
10636 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
10637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10638 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010639 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010640 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +020010641 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010642 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
10643
10644 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
10645 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
10646 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
10647
10648 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
10649 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
10650 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
10651 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
10652 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
10653 dead server.
10654
10655 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
10656 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010657 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010658 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
10659
10660 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
10661 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
10662 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
10663 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +020010664 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010665
10666 Example :
10667 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
10668
10669 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
10670
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010671
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020010672option socket-stats
10673no option socket-stats
10674
10675 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
10676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10677 yes | yes | yes | no
10678
10679 Arguments : none
10680
10681
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010682option splice-auto
10683no option splice-auto
10684 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
10685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10686 yes | yes | yes | yes
10687 Arguments : none
10688
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010689 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010690 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010691 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010692 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010693 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010694 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
10695 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
10696 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
10697 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10698
10699 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
10700 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
10701 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
10702 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
10703 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
10704 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
10705 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
10706 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
10707 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
10708 keyword.
10709
10710 Example :
10711 option splice-auto
10712
10713 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10714 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10715
10716 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
10717 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10718
10719
10720option splice-request
10721no option splice-request
10722 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
10723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10724 yes | yes | yes | yes
10725 Arguments : none
10726
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010727 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010728 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010729 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
10730 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
10731 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
10732 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10733
10734 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
10735
10736 Example :
10737 option splice-request
10738
10739 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10740 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10741
10742 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
10743 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10744
10745
10746option splice-response
10747no option splice-response
10748 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
10749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10750 yes | yes | yes | yes
10751 Arguments : none
10752
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010753 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010754 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010755 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
10756 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
10757 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
10758 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10759
10760 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
10761
10762 Example :
10763 option splice-response
10764
10765 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10766 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10767
10768 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
10769 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10770
10771
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +010010772option spop-check
10773 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
10774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Aurelien DARRAGONf3a2ae72023-01-12 15:06:11 +010010775 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +010010776 Arguments : none
10777
10778 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
10779 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
10780 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
10781 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
10782
10783 Example :
10784 option spop-check
10785
10786 See also : "option httpchk"
10787
10788
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010789option srvtcpka
10790no option srvtcpka
10791 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
10792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10793 yes | no | yes | yes
10794 Arguments : none
10795
10796 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
10797 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010798 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010799 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
10800
10801 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
10802 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
10803 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
10804 operating system and its tuning parameters.
10805
10806 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
10807 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
10808 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
10809 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
10810 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
10811
10812 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
10813
10814 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
10815 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
10816 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
10817
10818 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10819 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10820
10821 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
10822
10823
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010824option ssl-hello-chk
10825 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
10826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10827 yes | no | yes | yes
10828 Arguments : none
10829
10830 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
10831 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
10832 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
10833 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
10834 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
10835 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
10836 hello message.
10837
10838 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
10839 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
10840 messages, which is appreciable.
10841
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010842 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010843 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
10844 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010845
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010846 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
10847
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010848
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010849option tcp-check
10850 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
10851 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10852 yes | no | yes | yes
10853
10854 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
10855 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
10856
10857 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
10858 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
10859 attempt, which remains the default mode.
10860
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010861 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010862 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
10863 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
10864 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
10865 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
10866 only.
10867
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010868 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010869 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010870 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
10871 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
10872 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
10873
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010874 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010875 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
10876 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010877 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010878 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
10879 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
10880 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
10881 the respective protocols.
10882 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010883 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010884
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010885 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010886
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010887 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
10888 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
10889 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
10890 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010891
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010892 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
10893 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
10894 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010895
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010896
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010897 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010898 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010899 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010900 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010901
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010902 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010903 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010904 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010905
10906 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
10907 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010908 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010909 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010910 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010911 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010912 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010913 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010914 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10915 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010916 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010917 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10918 tcp-check expect string +OK
10919
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010920 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010921 (send many headers before analyzing)
10922 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010923 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010924 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
10925 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
10926 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
10927 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010928 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010929
10930
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010931 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010932
10933
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010934option tcp-smart-accept
10935no option tcp-smart-accept
10936 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
10937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10938 yes | yes | yes | no
10939 Arguments : none
10940
10941 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
10942 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
10943 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
10944 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
10945 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
10946 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
10947
10948 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
10949 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
10950 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
10951 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
10952
10953 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
10954 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
10955 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010956 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010957
10958 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
10959 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
10960 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
10961
10962 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
10963 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
10964 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
10965
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +020010966 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
10967
10968
10969option tcp-smart-connect
10970no option tcp-smart-connect
10971 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
10972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10973 yes | no | yes | yes
10974 Arguments : none
10975
10976 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
10977 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
10978 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
10979 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
10980 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
10981
10982 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
10983 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
10984 complex.
10985
10986 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
10987 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
10988 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
10989
10990 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10991 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10992
10993 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
10994
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010995
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010996option tcpka
10997 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
10998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10999 yes | yes | yes | yes
11000 Arguments : none
11001
11002 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
11003 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011004 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010011005 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
11006
11007 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
11008 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
11009 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
11010 operating system and its tuning parameters.
11011
11012 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
11013 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
11014 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
11015 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
11016 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
11017
11018 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
11019
11020 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
11021 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
11022 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
11023 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
11024 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
11025 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
11026 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
11027 backends.
11028
11029 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
11030
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011031
11032option tcplog
11033 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
11034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +010011035 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011036 Arguments : none
11037
11038 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
11039 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
11040 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
11041 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
11042 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
11043 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
11044 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
11045 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
11046
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +020011047 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
11048
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011049 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011050
11051
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011052option transparent
11053no option transparent
11054 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011056 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011057 Arguments : none
11058
11059 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
11060 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11061 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11062 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11063 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11064 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11065 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11066 appropriate server.
11067
11068 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11069 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11070
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +010011071 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011072 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011073
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010011074
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090011075external-check command <command>
11076 Executable to run when performing an external-check
11077 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11078 yes | no | yes | yes
11079
11080 Arguments :
11081 <command> is the external command to run
11082
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090011083 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
11084
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010011085 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090011086
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010011087 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
11088 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
11089 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
11090 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
11091 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
11092 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090011093
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010011094 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
11095
11096 Environment variables :
11097 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
11098 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
11099
11100 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
11101
11102 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
11103
11104 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
11105 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
11106 for a UNIX socket).
11107
11108 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
11109
11110 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
11111
11112 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
11113
11114 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
11115
11116 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
11117
11118 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
11119 socket).
11120
Willy Tarreau973cf902022-05-13 15:58:35 +020011121 HAPROXY_SERVER_SSL "0" when SSL is not used, "1" when it is used
11122
11123 HAPROXY_SERVER_PROTO The protocol used by this server, which can be one
11124 of "cli" (the haproxy CLI), "syslog" (syslog TCP
11125 server), "peers" (peers TCP server), "h1" (HTTP/1.x
11126 server), "h2" (HTTP/2 server), or "tcp" (any other
11127 TCP server).
11128
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010011129 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
11130 the command may be set using "external-check path".
11131
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +020011132 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
11133
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090011134 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
11135 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
11136 failed.
11137
11138 Example :
11139 external-check command /bin/true
11140
11141 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
11142
11143
11144external-check path <path>
11145 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
11146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11147 yes | no | yes | yes
11148
11149 Arguments :
11150 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
11151
11152 The default path is "".
11153
11154 Example :
11155 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
11156
11157 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
11158 "external-check command"
11159
11160
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011161persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +020011162persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011163 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
11164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11165 yes | no | yes | yes
11166 Arguments :
11167 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020011168 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
11169 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011170
11171 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
11172 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011173 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011174 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
11175 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
11176 forwarded to this server.
11177
11178 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
11179 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
11180 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011181 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011182 a single "listen" section.
11183
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020011184 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
11185 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
11186 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
11187
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011188 Example :
11189 listen tse-farm
11190 bind :3389
11191 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
11192 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11193 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
11194 # apply RDP cookie persistence
11195 persist rdp-cookie
11196 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011197 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011198 balance rdp-cookie
11199 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11200 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
11201
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011202 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011203
11204
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010011205rate-limit sessions <rate>
11206 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
11207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11208 yes | yes | yes | no
11209 Arguments :
11210 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
11211 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
11212
11213 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
11214 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
11215 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011216 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010011217 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
11218 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
11219
11220 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
11221 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
11222 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
11223 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
11224
11225 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
11226 listen smtp
11227 mode tcp
11228 bind :25
11229 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020011230 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010011231
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020011232 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
11233 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
11234 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010011235
11236 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
11237
11238
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011239redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11240redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11241redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011242 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
11243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11244 no | yes | yes | yes
11245
11246 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010011247 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011248
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011249 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011250 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011251 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
11252 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
11253 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011254
11255 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
11256 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
11257 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
11258 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
11259 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011260 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
11261 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
11262 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
11263 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011264
11265 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
11266 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
11267 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
11268 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
11269 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
11270 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011271 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011272 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011273 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
11274 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
11275 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011276
11277 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010011278 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
11279 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
11280 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020011281 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010011282 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
11283 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
11284 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
11285 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011286
11287 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011288 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011289
11290 - "drop-query"
11291 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
11292 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
11293 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
11294 with a location-type redirect.
11295
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010011296 - "append-slash"
11297 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
11298 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
11299 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
11300 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
11301
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020011302 - "ignore-empty"
11303 This keyword only has effect when a location is produced using a log
11304 format expression (i.e. when used in http-request or http-response).
11305 It indicates that if the result of the expression is empty, the rule
11306 should silently be skipped. The main use is to allow mass-redirects
11307 of known paths using a simple map.
11308
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011309 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
11310 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
11311 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
11312 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
11313 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
11314 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
11315 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
11316
11317 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
11318 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
11319 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
11320 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
11321 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
11322 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
11323 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011324
11325 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
11326 acl clear dst_port 80
11327 acl secure dst_port 8080
11328 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011329 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010011330 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011331 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
11332
11333 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010011334 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
11335 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
11336 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011337 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011338
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010011339 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
11340 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
11341 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
11342
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011343 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010011344 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011345
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011346 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020011347 http-request redirect code 301 location \
11348 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
11349 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011350
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020011351 Example: permanently redirect only old URLs to new ones
11352 http-request redirect code 301 location \
11353 %[path,map_str(old-blog-articles.map)] ignore-empty
11354
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011355 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011356
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010011357
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011358retries <value>
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011359 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a failure
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011360 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11361 yes | no | yes | yes
11362 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011363 <value> is the number of times a request or connection attempt should be
11364 retried on a server after a failure.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011365
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011366 By default, retries apply only to new connection attempts. However, when
11367 the "retry-on" directive is used, other conditions might trigger a retry
11368 (e.g. empty response, undesired status code), and each of them will count
11369 one attempt, and when the total number attempts reaches the value here, an
11370 error will be returned.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011371
11372 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070011373 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011374 a retry occurs on the same server.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011375
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011376 When "option redispatch" is set, some retries may be performed on another
11377 server even if a cookie references a different server. By default this will
11378 only be the last retry unless an argument is passed to "option redispatch".
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011379
11380 See also : "option redispatch"
11381
11382
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010011383retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020011384 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
11385 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
11386 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011387 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11388 yes | no | yes | yes
11389 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010011390 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
11391 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
11392 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
11393 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
11394 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011395
11396 none never retry
11397
11398 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
11399 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
11400
11401 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
11402 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
11403 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
11404 request timeout on the server side, poor network
11405 condition, or a server crash or restart while
11406 processing the request.
11407
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020011408 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
11409 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
11410 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
11411 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
11412 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
11413 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
11414 overflow attack for example).
11415
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011416 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
11417 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
11418 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
11419 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
11420 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
11421 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
11422 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
11423 amplify denial of service attacks.
11424
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020011425 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
11426 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
11427 considered to be safe to retry.
11428
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010011429 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
11430 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
11431 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
11432 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
11433 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011434
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020011435 all-retryable-errors
11436 retry request for any error that are considered
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +010011437 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
11438 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
11439 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020011440
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011441 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
11442 not cumulative.
11443
11444 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
11445 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
11446 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
11447 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
11448
11449 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
11450 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
11451 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
11452 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
11453 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
11454 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
11455 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
11456 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
11457 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
11458 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
11459 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
11460 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
11461
11462 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
11463 should not use this directive.
11464
11465 The default is "conn-failure".
11466
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010011467 Example:
11468 retry-on 503 504
11469
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011470 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
11471
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010011472server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011473 Declare a server in a backend
11474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11475 no | no | yes | yes
11476 Arguments :
11477 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011478 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050011479 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011480
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010011481 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
11482 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
11483 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
11484 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020011485 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
11486 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011487 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020011488 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
11489 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011490 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
11491 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
11492 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
11493 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
11494 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
11495 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
11496 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020011497 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020011498 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
11499 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
11500 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
11501 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
11502 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
11503 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020011504 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
11505 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011506 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
11507 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011508
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011509 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011510 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
11511 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
11512 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
11513 adding this value to the client's port.
11514
11515 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
11516 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011517 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011518
11519 Examples :
11520 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
11521 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011522 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020011523 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
11524 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
11525 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011526
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020011527 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
11528 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
11529 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
11530 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
11531 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
11532
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050011533 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
11534 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011535
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011536server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011537 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011538 this backend.
11539 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11540 no | no | yes | yes
11541
11542 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
11543 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
11544 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
11545 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
11546 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011547
11548 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
11549 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
11550
11551 global
11552 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
11553
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010011554 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011555 load-server-state-from-file
11556
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011557 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011558 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011559
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020011560server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
11561 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
11562 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
11563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11564 no | no | yes | yes
11565
11566 Arguments:
11567 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
11568
11569 <num | range>
11570 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
11571 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
11572 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
11573 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
11574
11575 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
11576
11577 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
11578
11579 <params*>
11580 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
11581 keyword.
11582
11583 Examples:
11584 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
11585 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
11586 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
11587
11588 # or
11589 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
11590
11591 # would be equivalent to:
11592 server srv1 google.com:80 check
11593 server srv2 google.com:80 check
11594 server srv3 google.com:80 check
11595
11596
11597
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011598source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011599source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010011600source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011601 Set the source address for outgoing connections
11602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11603 yes | no | yes | yes
11604 Arguments :
11605 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
11606 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011607
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011608 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011609 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
11610 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
11611 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
11612 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
11613 supported prefixes are :
11614 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
11615 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
11616 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020011617 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020011618 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
11619 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011620
11621 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
11622 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011623 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
11624 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
11625 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011626
11627 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
11628 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
11629 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
11630 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
11631 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
11632 <addr>.
11633
11634 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
11635 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
11636 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
11637 port.
11638
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011639 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
11640 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
11641 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
11642 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010011643 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011644 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
11645 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
11646 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
11647 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
11648 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
11649 HTTP header.
11650
11651 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
11652 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011653 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011654 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
11655 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11656 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
11657 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
11658 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
11659 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
11660 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
11661
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010011662 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
11663 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
11664 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
11665 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
11666 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
11667 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
11668
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011669 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
11670 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
11671 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
11672 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
11673
11674 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
11675 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
11676 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
11677 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
11678 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
11679 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
11680
11681 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
11682 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
11683 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
11684 there are two methods :
11685
11686 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
11687 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
11688 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
11689 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
11690 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
11691 of the client ranges may be used.
11692
11693 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
11694 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
11695 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
11696 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
11697 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
11698 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
11699 same session.
11700
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011701 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
11702 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
11703 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011704 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011705
Willy Tarreaua547a212023-08-29 10:24:26 +020011706 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges, or on supported systems,
11707 the "cap_net_raw" capability. See also the "setcap" global directive.
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020011708
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011709 Examples :
11710 backend private
11711 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
11712 source 192.168.1.200
11713
11714 backend transparent_ssl1
11715 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
11716 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
11717
11718 backend transparent_ssl2
11719 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
11720 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
11721 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
11722
11723 backend transparent_ssl3
11724 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
11725 # is more conntrack-friendly.
11726 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
11727
11728 backend transparent_smtp
11729 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
11730 # with Tproxy version 4.
11731 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
11732
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011733 backend transparent_http
11734 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
11735 # proxy.
11736 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
11737
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011738 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011739 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
11740
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011741
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011742srvtcpka-cnt <count>
11743 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
11744 the connection on the server side.
11745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11746 yes | no | yes | yes
11747 Arguments :
11748 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
11749
11750 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
11751 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011752 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11753 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011754
11755 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
11756
11757
11758srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
11759 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
11760 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
11761 server side.
11762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11763 yes | no | yes | yes
11764 Arguments :
11765 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
11766 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
11767 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
11768 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
11769
11770 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
11771 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011772 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11773 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011774
11775 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
11776
11777
11778srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
11779 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
11780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11781 yes | no | yes | yes
11782 Arguments :
11783 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
11784 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
11785 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
11786 document.
11787
11788 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
11789 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011790 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11791 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011792
11793 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
11794
11795
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011796stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
11797 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
11798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011799 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011800
11801 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
11802 matched.
11803
11804 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
11805 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
11806
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010011807 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
11808 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
11809 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
11810 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011811
11812 Example :
11813 # statistics admin level only for localhost
11814 backend stats_localhost
11815 stats enable
11816 stats admin if LOCALHOST
11817
11818 Example :
11819 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
11820 backend stats_auth
11821 stats enable
11822 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
11823 stats admin if TRUE
11824
11825 Example :
11826 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
11827 userlist stats-auth
11828 group admin users admin
11829 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
11830 group readonly users haproxy
11831 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
11832
11833 backend stats_auth
11834 stats enable
11835 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
11836 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
11837 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
11838 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
11839
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011840 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
11841 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011842
11843
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011844stats auth <user>:<passwd>
11845 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
11846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011847 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011848 Arguments :
11849 <user> is a user name to grant access to
11850
11851 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
11852
11853 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
11854 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
11855 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
11856 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
11857 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
11858 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
11859
11860 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
11861 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
11862 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020011863 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011864
11865 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
11866 report using "stats scope".
11867
11868 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11869 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11870 unobvious parameters.
11871
11872 Example :
11873 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11874 backend public_www
11875 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11876 stats enable
11877 stats hide-version
11878 stats scope .
11879 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011880 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011881 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11882 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11883
11884 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11885 backend private_monitoring
11886 stats enable
11887 stats uri /admin?stats
11888 stats refresh 5s
11889
11890 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
11891
11892
11893stats enable
11894 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
11895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011896 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011897 Arguments : none
11898
11899 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
11900 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
11901 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
11902 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
11903 - stats auth : no authentication
11904 - stats scope : no restriction
11905
11906 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11907 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11908 unobvious parameters.
11909
11910 Example :
11911 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11912 backend public_www
11913 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11914 stats enable
11915 stats hide-version
11916 stats scope .
11917 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011918 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011919 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11920 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11921
11922 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11923 backend private_monitoring
11924 stats enable
11925 stats uri /admin?stats
11926 stats refresh 5s
11927
11928 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11929
11930
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011931stats hide-version
11932 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011934 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011935 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011936
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011937 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
11938 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
11939 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
11940 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
11941 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
11942 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011943
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020011944 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11945 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11946 unobvious parameters.
11947
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011948 Example :
11949 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11950 backend public_www
11951 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020011952 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011953 stats hide-version
11954 stats scope .
11955 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011956 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011957 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11958 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011959
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011960 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11961 backend private_monitoring
11962 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011963 stats uri /admin?stats
11964 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010011965
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011966 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011967
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011968
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020011969stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
11970 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
11971 Access control for statistics
11972
11973 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11974 no | no | yes | yes
11975
11976 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
11977 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
11978 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
11979 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
11980 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
11981 should be asked to enter a username and password.
11982
11983 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
11984 instance.
11985
11986 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
11987 about ACL usage.
11988
11989
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011990stats realm <realm>
11991 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
11992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011993 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011994 Arguments :
11995 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
11996 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
11997 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
11998
11999 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
12000 using a backslash ('\').
12001
12002 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
12003 only related to authentication.
12004
12005 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12006 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12007 unobvious parameters.
12008
12009 Example :
12010 # public access (limited to this backend only)
12011 backend public_www
12012 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
12013 stats enable
12014 stats hide-version
12015 stats scope .
12016 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012017 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012018 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
12019 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
12020
12021 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12022 backend private_monitoring
12023 stats enable
12024 stats uri /admin?stats
12025 stats refresh 5s
12026
12027 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
12028
12029
12030stats refresh <delay>
12031 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
12032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012033 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012034 Arguments :
12035 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
12036 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
12037 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
12038 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
12039 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
12040 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
12041
12042 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
12043 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
12044 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050012045 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012046
12047 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12048 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12049 unobvious parameters.
12050
12051 Example :
12052 # public access (limited to this backend only)
12053 backend public_www
12054 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
12055 stats enable
12056 stats hide-version
12057 stats scope .
12058 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012059 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012060 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
12061 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
12062
12063 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12064 backend private_monitoring
12065 stats enable
12066 stats uri /admin?stats
12067 stats refresh 5s
12068
12069 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
12070
12071
12072stats scope { <name> | "." }
12073 Enable statistics and limit access scope
12074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012075 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012076 Arguments :
12077 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
12078 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
12079 section in which the statement appears.
12080
12081 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
12082 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
12083 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
12084 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
12085 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
12086 exists.
12087
12088 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12089 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12090 unobvious parameters.
12091
12092 Example :
12093 # public access (limited to this backend only)
12094 backend public_www
12095 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
12096 stats enable
12097 stats hide-version
12098 stats scope .
12099 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012100 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012101 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
12102 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
12103
12104 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12105 backend private_monitoring
12106 stats enable
12107 stats uri /admin?stats
12108 stats refresh 5s
12109
12110 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
12111
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012112
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012113stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012114 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
12115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012116 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012117
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012118 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012119 description from global section is automatically used instead.
12120
12121 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
12122 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
12123
12124 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12125 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012126 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012127
12128 Example :
12129 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12130 backend private_monitoring
12131 stats enable
12132 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
12133 stats uri /admin?stats
12134 stats refresh 5s
12135
12136 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
12137 global section.
12138
12139
12140stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012141 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
12142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12143 yes | yes | yes | yes
12144 Arguments : none
12145
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012146 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012147 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
12148 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
12149 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
12150 - IP (socket, server)
12151 - cookie (backend, server)
12152
12153 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12154 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012155 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012156
12157 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
12158
12159
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020012160stats show-modules
12161 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
12162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12163 yes | yes | yes | yes
12164 Arguments : none
12165
12166 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
12167 values as a tooltip.
12168
12169 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12170 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12171 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
12172
12173 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
12174
12175
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012176stats show-node [ <name> ]
12177 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
12178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012179 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012180 Arguments:
12181 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
12182 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
12183
12184 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
12185 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012186 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012187
12188 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12189 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12190 unobvious parameters.
12191
12192 Example:
12193 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12194 backend private_monitoring
12195 stats enable
12196 stats show-node Europe-1
12197 stats uri /admin?stats
12198 stats refresh 5s
12199
12200 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
12201 section.
12202
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012203
12204stats uri <prefix>
12205 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
12206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012207 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012208 Arguments :
12209 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
12210 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
12211 query string.
12212
12213 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
12214 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
12215 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
12216 possible to reach it in the application.
12217
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012218 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012219 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012220 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
12221 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
12222 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
12223 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
12224
12225 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
12226 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
12227 an address or a port to statistics only.
12228
12229 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12230 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12231 unobvious parameters.
12232
12233 Example :
12234 # public access (limited to this backend only)
12235 backend public_www
12236 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
12237 stats enable
12238 stats hide-version
12239 stats scope .
12240 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012241 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012242 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
12243 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
12244
12245 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12246 backend private_monitoring
12247 stats enable
12248 stats uri /admin?stats
12249 stats refresh 5s
12250
12251 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
12252
12253
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012254stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
12255 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012257 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012258
12259 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012260 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012261 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012262 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012263 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
12264
12265 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
12266 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
12267 the "stick-table" statement.
12268
12269 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
12270 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
12271 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
12272 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
12273 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
12274
12275 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
12276 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
12277 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
12278 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
12279 transformation rules.
12280
12281 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
12282 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
12283 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
12284 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
12285 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
12286 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
12287 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
12288
12289 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
12290 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
12291 ACL based conditions.
12292
12293 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
12294 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
12295 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
12296 matches can be used as fallbacks.
12297
12298 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
12299 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
12300 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
12301 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
12302
12303 Example :
12304 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
12305 # last 30 minutes
12306 backend pop
12307 mode tcp
12308 balance roundrobin
12309 stick store-request src
12310 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
12311 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
12312 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
12313
12314 backend smtp
12315 mode tcp
12316 balance roundrobin
12317 stick match src table pop
12318 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
12319 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
12320
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020012321 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and samples
12322 fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012323
12324
12325stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
12326 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
12327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12328 no | no | yes | yes
12329
12330 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
12331 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
12332 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
12333 for writing more maintainable configurations.
12334
12335 Examples :
12336 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010012337 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012338
12339 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
12340 stick match src table pop if !localhost
12341 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
12342
12343
12344 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
12345 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
12346 backend http
12347 mode http
12348 balance roundrobin
12349 stick on src table https
12350 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
12351 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
12352 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
12353
12354 backend https
12355 mode tcp
12356 balance roundrobin
12357 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
12358 stick on src
12359 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
12360 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
12361
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020012362 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012363
12364
12365stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
12366 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
12367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12368 no | no | yes | yes
12369
12370 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012371 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012372 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012373 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012374 server is selected.
12375
12376 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
12377 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
12378 the "stick-table" statement.
12379
12380 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
12381 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
12382 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
12383 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
12384 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
12385 address.
12386
12387 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
12388 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
12389 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
12390 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
12391 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
12392 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
12393 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
12394 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
12395 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
12396 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
12397
12398 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
12399 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
12400 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
12401 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
12402 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
12403 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
12404 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
12405
12406 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
12407 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
12408 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
12409 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
12410
12411 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
12412 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
12413 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
12414 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
12415 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
12416 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010012417 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
12418 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
12419 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
12420 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
12421 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
12422 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012423
12424 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
12425 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
12426 the request.
12427
12428 Example :
12429 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
12430 # last 30 minutes
12431 backend pop
12432 mode tcp
12433 balance roundrobin
12434 stick store-request src
12435 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
12436 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
12437 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
12438
12439 backend smtp
12440 mode tcp
12441 balance roundrobin
12442 stick match src table pop
12443 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
12444 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
12445
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020012446 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012447
12448
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012449stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070012450 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020012451 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080012452 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020012454 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012455
12456 Arguments :
12457 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
12458 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
12459 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
12460 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
12461
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010012462 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
12463 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
12464 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
12465 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
12466
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012467 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
12468 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
12469 instance.
12470
12471 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
12472 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
12473 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
12474 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
12475 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
12476 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012477 to 32 characters.
12478
12479 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
12480 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
12481 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012482 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012483 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
12484 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012485
12486 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012487 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
12488 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012489 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
12490 increase.
12491
12492 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012493 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
12494 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
12495 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012496
12497 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012498 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012499 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
12500 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012501 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012502 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
12503 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
12504 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
12505 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
12506 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
12507 parameter (see below).
12508
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020012509 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
12510 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
12511 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
12512 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
12513 soft restart.
12514
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012515 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
Emeric Brun423ed382022-05-30 18:08:28 +020012516 was last created, refreshed using 'track-sc' or matched using
12517 'stick match' or 'stick on' rule. The expiration delay is
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012518 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
12519 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010012520 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012521 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012522 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
12523 if not expiration delay is specified.
Emeric Brun423ed382022-05-30 18:08:28 +020012524 Note: 'table_*' converters performs lookups but won't update touch
12525 expire since they don't require 'track-sc'.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012526
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070012527 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
12528 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
12529 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
12530 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
12531 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
12532 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
12533 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
12534 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
12535 token.
12536
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020012537 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
12538 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
12539 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
12540 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012541 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
12542 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
12543 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
12544 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
12545 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
12546 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
12547 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
12548 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
12549 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
12550 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
12551 types and their arguments.
12552
12553 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
12554 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
12555 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
12556 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
12557
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012558 - gpc(<nb>) : General Purpose Counters Array of <nb> elements. This is an
12559 array of positive 32-bit integers which may be used to count anything.
12560 Most of the time they will be used as a incremental counters on some
12561 entries, for instance to note that a limit is reached and trigger some
12562 actions. This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements:
12563 gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
12564 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
12565 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
12566 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
12567 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020012568 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types 'gpc0'
12569 and 'gpc1' on the same table. Using the 'gpc' array data_type, all 'gpc0'
12570 and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions will apply to the two first
12571 elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012572
12573 - gpc_rate(<nb>,<period>) : Array of increment rates of General Purpose
12574 Counters over a period. Those elements are positive 32-bit integers which
12575 may be used for anything. Just like <gpc>, the count events, but instead
12576 of keeping a cumulative number, they maintain the rate at which the
12577 counter is incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the
12578 frequency of occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific
Emeric Brun5e349e72022-03-25 14:13:23 +010012579 URL). This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements: gpt(100)
12580 allowing the storage of gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer
12581 update message can fit into the buffer.
12582 The array cannot contain less than 1 element: use gpc(1) if you want to
12583 store only the counter gpc0.
12584 Users should take in consideration that a large amount of
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012585 counters will increase the data size and the traffic load using peers
12586 protocol since all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is
12587 updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020012588 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types
12589 'gpc0_rate' and 'gpc1_rate' on the same table. Using the 'gpc_rate'
12590 array data_type, all 'gpc0' and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions
12591 will apply to the two first elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012592
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012593 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12594 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12595 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012596 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012597
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012598 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
12599 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
12600 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012601 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012602 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012603 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012604
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012605 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12606 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12607 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
12608 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
12609
12610 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
12611 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
12612 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
12613 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
12614 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
12615 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
12616
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012617 - gpt(<nb>) : General Purpose Tags Array of <nb> elements. This is an array
12618 of positive 32-bit integers which may be used for anything.
12619 Most of the time they will be used to put a special tags on some entries,
12620 for instance to note that a specific behavior was detected and must be
12621 known for future matches. This array is limited to a maximum of 100
Emeric Brun5e349e72022-03-25 14:13:23 +010012622 elements: gpt(100) allowing the storage of gpt0 to gpt99, to ensure that
12623 the build of a peer update message can fit into the buffer.
12624 The array cannot contain less than 1 element: use gpt(1) if you want to
12625 to store only the tag gpt0.
12626 Users should take in consideration that a large amount of counters will
12627 increase the data size and the traffic load using peers protocol since
12628 all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brunf7ab0bf2021-06-30 18:58:22 +020012629 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_type 'gpt0'
12630 on the same table. Using the 'gpt' array data_type, all 'gpt0' related
12631 fetches and actions will apply to the first element of this array.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012632
Emeric Brun1a6b7252021-07-01 18:34:48 +020012633 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12634 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12635 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
12636 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
12637
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012638 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
12639 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
12640 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
12641 they were received.
12642
12643 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12644 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
12645 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
12646 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
12647 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
12648
12649 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12650 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12651 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12652 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
12653 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12654
12655 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
12656 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
12657 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
12658
12659 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12660 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12661 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12662 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
12663 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12664
12665 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12666 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
12667 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
12668 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
12669 the client side.
12670
12671 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12672 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12673 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12674 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
12675 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
12676 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
12677 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
12678
12679 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12680 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
12681 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
12682 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
12683 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
12684 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012685 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012686
12687 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12688 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12689 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12690 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
12691 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
12692 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12693
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010012694 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12695 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
12696 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
12697 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
12698 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
12699
12700 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
12701 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12702 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12703 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
12704 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
12705 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12706
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012707 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012708 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012709 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
12710 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
12711
12712 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12713 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12714 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12715 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
12716 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
12717 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
12718 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
12719 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
12720 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
12721 recommended for better fairness.
12722
12723 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012724 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012725 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
12726 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
12727
12728 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
12729 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12730 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12731 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
12732 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
12733 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
12734 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
12735 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
12736 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
12737 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020012738
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020012739 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
12740 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012741 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
12742 reference it.
12743
12744 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
12745 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010012746 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
12747 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
12748 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012749
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012750 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
12751 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
12752 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
12753 something that can be ignored.
12754
12755 Example:
12756 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
12757 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
12758 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
12759 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
12760
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010012761 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010012762 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012763
12764
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012765stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010012766 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12768 no | no | yes | yes
12769
12770 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012771 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012772 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012773 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012774 server is selected.
12775
12776 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
12777 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
12778 the "stick-table" statement.
12779
12780 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
12781 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
12782 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
12783 when the response is a SSL server hello.
12784
12785 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
12786 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
12787 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
12788 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
12789 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
12790 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012791 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012792 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
12793 rules.
12794
12795 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
12796 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
12797 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
12798 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
12799 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
12800 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
12801 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
12802
12803 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
12804 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
12805 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
12806 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
12807
12808 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
12809 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
12810 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
12811 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
12812 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
12813 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010012814 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
12815 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
12816 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
12817 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
12818 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
12819 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
12820 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
12821 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
12822 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012823
12824 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
12825
12826 Example :
12827 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
12828 backend https
12829 mode tcp
12830 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012831 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012832 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012833
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012834 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
William Lallemand8244cb72023-12-07 15:00:58 +010012835 acl serverhello res.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012836
12837 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
12838 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12839 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
12840
12841 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
12842 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012843
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012844 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
12845 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
12846 # at offset 44.
12847
12848 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012849 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012850
12851 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012852 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012853
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012854 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
12855 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
12856
12857 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
12858 extraction.
12859
12860
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012861tcp-check comment <string>
12862 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
12863 it fails.
12864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12865 yes | no | yes | yes
12866
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012867 Arguments :
12868 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
12869 rule fails.
12870
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012871 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
12872 user-friendly error reporting.
12873
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012874 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
12875 "tcp-check expect".
12876
12877
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012878tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
12879 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012880 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012881 Opens a new connection
12882 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012883 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012884
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012885 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012886 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12887
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020012888 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040012889 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020012890
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020012891 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012892 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
12893 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020012894 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012895
12896 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012897
12898 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
12899
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020012900 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
12901
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012902 ssl opens a ciphered connection
12903
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020012904 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
12905
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020012906 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
12907 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
12908 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
12909 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12910
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012911 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
12912 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
12913 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
12914 haproxy -vv.
12915
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012916 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012917
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012918 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
12919 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
12920 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
12921
12922 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
12923 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
12924 of the sequence.
12925
12926 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
12927 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
12928 do.
12929
12930 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
12931 unset-var or comment rules.
12932
12933 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012934 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
12935 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
12936 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
12937 option tcp-check
12938 tcp-check connect
12939 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
12940 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
12941 tcp-check send \r\n
12942 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
12943 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
12944 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
12945 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
12946 tcp-check send \r\n
12947 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
12948 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
12949
12950 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
12951 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012952 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012953 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
12954 tcp-check connect port 143
12955 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
12956 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
12957
12958 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
12959
12960
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012961tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012962 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020012963 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012964 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012965 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012966 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012967 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012968
12969 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012970 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12971
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012972 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
12973 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
12974 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
12975 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
12976 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
12977 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
12978 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
12979 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
12980 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
12981 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
12982
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012983 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012984 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
12985 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012986 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
12987 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
12988 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
12989
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012990 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
12991 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
12992 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012993 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
12994 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010012995 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
12996 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012997 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
12998 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012999 By default "L7OK" is used.
13000
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020013001 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
13002 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010013003 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
13004 supported :
13005 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
13006 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020013007 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
13008 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
13009 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
13010 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
13011 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020013012
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020013013 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020013014 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020013015 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
13016 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
13017 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
13018 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020013019 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
13020
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020013021 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
13022 informational message reported in logs if the expect
13023 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
13024 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
13025
13026 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
13027 informational message reported in logs if an error
13028 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
13029 log-format string.
13030
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020013031 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
13032 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
13033 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
13034 followed by some converters.
13035
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013036 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
13037 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
13038 with the usual backslash ('\').
13039 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013040 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013041 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
13042 used upper or lower case.
13043
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013044 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
13045
13046 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
13047 A health check response will be considered valid if the
13048 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
13049 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
13050 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
13051 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
13052 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
13053 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
13054
13055 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
13056 A health check response will be considered valid if the
13057 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
13058 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
13059 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
13060 expression.
13061
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020013062 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
13063 A health check response will be considered valid if the
13064 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
13065 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
13066 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
13067 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
13068
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013069 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
13070 in the response buffer. A health check response will
13071 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
13072 this exact hexadecimal string.
13073 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
13074
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010013075 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
13076 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
13077 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
13078 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
13079 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
13080 size of the original response. As such, the expected
13081 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
13082 size.
13083
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020013084 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
13085 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
13086 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
13087 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
13088 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
13089 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
13090 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
13091 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
13092 in a binary string before matching the response's
13093 buffer.
13094
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013095 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010013096 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013097 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
13098 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
13099 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
13100 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
13101 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
13102 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
13103 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
13104 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
13105 the null character.
13106
13107 Examples :
13108 # perform a POP check
13109 option tcp-check
13110 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
13111
13112 # perform an IMAP check
13113 option tcp-check
13114 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
13115
13116 # look for the redis master server
13117 option tcp-check
13118 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020013119 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013120 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
13121 tcp-check expect string role:master
13122 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
13123 tcp-check expect string +OK
13124
13125
13126 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010013127 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013128
13129
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013130tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
13131tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
13132 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
13133 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013134 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020013135 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013136
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020013137 Arguments :
13138 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
13139
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013140 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
13141 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020013142
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013143 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
13144 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013145
13146 Examples :
13147 # look for the redis master server
13148 option tcp-check
13149 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
13150 tcp-check expect string role:master
13151
13152 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010013153 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013154
13155
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013156tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
13157tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
13158 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
13159 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013160 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020013161 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013162
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020013163 Arguments :
13164 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013165
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013166 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
13167 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020013168
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013169 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
13170 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
13171 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013172
13173 Examples :
13174 # redis check in binary
13175 option tcp-check
13176 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
13177 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
13178
13179
13180 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010013181 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013182
13183
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013184tcp-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
13185tcp-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013186 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013187 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020013188 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013189
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013190 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013191 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13192 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
13193 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
13194 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
13195 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
13196 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
13197 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
13198 and '-'.
13199
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013200 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
13201 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +050013202 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013203 conditions.
13204
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013205 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
13206
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013207 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
13208 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
13209
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013210 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013211 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013212 tcp-check set-var-fmt(check.name) "%H"
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013213
13214
13215tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013216 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013217 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020013218 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013219
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013220 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013221 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13222 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
13223 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
13224 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
13225 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
13226 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
13227 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
13228 and '-'.
13229
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013230 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013231 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
13232
13233
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013234tcp-request connection <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013235 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020013236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013237 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013238 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020013239 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13240 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020013241
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013242 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013243
13244 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
13245 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013246 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
13247 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
13248 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
13249 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
13250 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
13251 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013252
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013253 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
13254 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
13255 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013256 rules which may be inserted. Any rule may optionally be followed by an
13257 ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition
13258 is true.
13259
13260 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13261 supported:
13262 - accept
13263 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4
13264 - expect-proxy layer4
13265 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013266 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013267 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
13268 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
13269 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
13270 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13271 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13272 - set-dst <expr>
13273 - set-dst-port <expr>
13274 - set-mark <mark>
13275 - set-src <expr>
13276 - set-src-port <expr>
13277 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013278 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
13279 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013280 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013281 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
13282 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
13283 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010013284 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013285
13286 The supported actions are described below.
13287
13288 There is no limit to the number of "tcp-request connection" statements per
13289 instance.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013290
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013291 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13292 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13293 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13294 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13295 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13296 a defaults section defining such rules.
13297
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013298 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
13299 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13300 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013301
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013302 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
13303 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
13304 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013305
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013306 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13307 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
13308 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020013309
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013310 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
13311 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
13312 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020013313
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013314 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13315 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
13316 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020013317
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013318 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020013319
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013320 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020013321
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013322 See section 7 about ACL usage.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020013323
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013324 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020013325
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013326tcp-request connection accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020013327
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013328 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
13329 rules are evaluated.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013330
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013331tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip layer4
13332 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013333
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013334 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client IP
13335 insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket. This is
13336 equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the "bind" line,
13337 except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only
13338 for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple
13339 layers of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
13340 hosts.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013341
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013342tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013343
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013344 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
13345 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to having
13346 the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule
13347 allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges
13348 using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are
13349 passed through by traffic coming from public hosts.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020013350
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013351tcp-request connection reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013352
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013353 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
13354 rules are evaluated. Rejected connections do not even become a session, which
13355 is why they are accounted separately for in the stats, as "denied
13356 connections". They are not considered for the session rate-limit and are not
13357 logged either. The reason is that these rules should only be used to filter
13358 extremely high connection rates such as the ones encountered during a massive
13359 DDoS attack. Under these extreme conditions, the simple action of logging
13360 each event would make the system collapse and would considerably lower the
13361 filtering capacity. If logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request
13362 content" rules should be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will
13363 not log either.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013364
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013365tcp-request connection sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13366 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13367
13368 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
13369 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
13370 a complete description.
13371
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013372tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13373tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13374tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013375
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013376 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13377 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13378 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13379 description.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013380
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013381tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13382 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13383tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13384 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013385
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013386 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13387 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +020013388 sc-set-gpt" and "http-request sc-set-gpt0" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020013389
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013390tcp-request connection set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13391tcp-request connection set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013392
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013393 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
13394 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
13395 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013396
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013397tcp-request connection set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020013398
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013399 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13400 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13401 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013402
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013403tcp-request connection set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13404tcp-request connection set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013405
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013406 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13407 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13408 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013409
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013410tcp-request connection set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013411
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013412 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13413 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13414 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013415
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013416tcp-request connection set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13417tcp-request connection set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010013418
13419 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13420 inline. "tcp-request connection" can set variables in the "proc" and "sess"
13421 scopes. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13422 for a complete description.
13423
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013424tcp-request connection silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013425
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013426 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13427 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13428 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13429 complete description.
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013430
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013431tcp-request connection track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13432tcp-request connection track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13433tcp-request connection track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013434
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013435 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13436 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13437 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013438
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010013439tcp-request connection unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13440
13441 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13442 details about variables.
13443
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013444
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013445tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13446 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013448 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013449 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020013450 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13451 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013452
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013453 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013454
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013455 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013456 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
13457 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013458 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
13459 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013460
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013461 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
13462 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
13463 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
13464 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013465 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013466 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013467 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
13468 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
13469 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
13470 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013471 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013472 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013473
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013474 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
13475 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
13476 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
13477 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013478
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013479 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13480 supported:
13481 - accept
13482 - capture <sample> len <length>
13483 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
13484 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013485 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020013486 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020013487 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013488 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020013489 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010013490 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013491 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010013492 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020013493 - set-dst <expr>
13494 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020013495 - set-log-level <level>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013496 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020013497 - set-nice <nice>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013498 - set-priority-class <expr>
13499 - set-priority-offset <expr>
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020013500 - set-src <expr>
13501 - set-src-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013502 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013503 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
13504 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013505 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013506 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013507 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
13508 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
13509 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013510 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013511 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013512
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013513 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013514
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013515 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
13516 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
13517 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
13518 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
13519 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
13520 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013521
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013522 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13523 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13524 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13525 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13526 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13527 a defaults section defining such rules.
13528
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013529 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013530 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13531 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013532
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020013533 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
13534 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
13535 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
13536 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
13537 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
13538 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
13539
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013540 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020013541 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
13542 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
13543 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
13544 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
13545 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
13546 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
13547 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
13548 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
13549 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
13550 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013551
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013552 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013553 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
13554 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
13555 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013556
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013557 Example:
Aurelien DARRAGONd49b5592022-10-05 18:09:33 +020013558 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013559
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013560 Example:
13561
13562 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013563 tcp-request content set-var-fmt(sess.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013564 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013565
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013566 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013567 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013568 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013569 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
13570 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020013571 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013572 tcp-request content reject
13573
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013574 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
13575 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
13576 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
13577 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13578 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
13579 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
13580 ...
13581 http-request reject unless is_host_com
13582
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013583 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013584 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
13585 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010013586 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013587 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013588
13589 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
13590 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010013591 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013592 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013593 tcp-request content reject
13594
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013595 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013596 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013597 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013598 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013599 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
13600 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013601
13602 Example:
13603 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
13604 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013605 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013606
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013607 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013608 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013609
13610 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013611 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013612 # protecting all our sites
13613 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013614 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
13615 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013616 ...
13617 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
13618
13619 backend http_dynamic
13620 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013621 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013622 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013623 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013624 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013625 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013626 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013627
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013628 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013629
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030013630 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
13631 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013632
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013633tcp-request content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13634
13635 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +010013636 rules are evaluated for the current section.
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013637
13638tcp-request content capture <sample> len <length>
13639 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13640
13641 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
13642 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
13643 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
13644 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
13645 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
13646 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
13647 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life. Please
13648 check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for more
13649 information.
13650
13651tcp-request content do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
13652
13653 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores the
13654 result in the variable <var>. Please refer to "http-request do-resolve" for a
13655 complete description.
13656
13657tcp-request content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13658
13659 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request content" rules
13660 are evaluated.
13661
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013662tcp-request content sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13663 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13664
13665 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
13666 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
13667 a complete description.
13668
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013669tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13670tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13671tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13672
13673 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13674 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13675 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13676 description.
13677
13678tcp-request content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13679 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13680tcp-request content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13681 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13682
13683 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13684 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +020013685 sc-set-gpt" and "http-request sc-set-gpt0" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013686
13687tcp-request content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
13688 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13689
Willy Tarreau707742f2023-11-30 09:27:51 +010013690 This action is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013691 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
13692
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010013693tcp-request content set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
13694 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020013695
13696 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
13697 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
13698 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
13699
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013700tcp-request content set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13701tcp-request content set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13702
13703 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
13704 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
13705 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
13706
13707tcp-request content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13708
13709 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
13710 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
13711
13712tcp-request content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13713
13714 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13715 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13716 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
13717
13718tcp-request content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13719
13720 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
13721 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
13722
13723tcp-request content set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13724
13725 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request. Please
13726 refer to "http-request set-priority-class" for a complete description.
13727
13728tcp-request content set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13729
13730 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
13731 request. Please refer to "http-request set-priority-offset" for a complete
13732 description.
13733
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020013734tcp-request content set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13735tcp-request content set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13736
13737 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13738 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13739 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
13740
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013741tcp-request content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13742
13743 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13744 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13745 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
13746
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013747tcp-request content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13748tcp-request content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013749
13750 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13751 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13752 for a complete description.
13753
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013754tcp-request content silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013755
13756 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13757 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13758 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13759 complete description.
13760
13761tcp-request content switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
13762 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13763
13764 This action is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP upgrades are
13765 supported for now. The protocol may optionally be specified. This action is
13766 only available for a proxy with the frontend capability. The connection
13767 upgrade is immediately performed, following "tcp-request content" rules are
13768 not evaluated. This upgrade method should be preferred to the implicit one
13769 consisting to rely on the backend mode. When used, it is possible to set HTTP
13770 directives in a frontend without any warning. These directives will be
13771 conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade is performed. However, an HTTP
13772 backend must still be selected. It remains unsupported to route an HTTP
13773 connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
13774
13775 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
13776
13777tcp-request content track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13778tcp-request content track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13779tcp-request content track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13780
13781 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13782 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13783 track-sc2" for a complete description.
13784
13785tcp-request content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13786
13787 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13788 details about variables.
13789
Aleksandar Lazic332258a2022-03-30 00:11:40 +020013790tcp-request content use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013791
13792 This action is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the request
13793 and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to reply by
13794 sending any valid response or it may immediately close the connection without
13795 sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible to write your own
13796 services in Lua. No further "tcp-request content" rules are evaluated.
13797
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013798
13799tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
13800 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
13801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013802 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013803 Arguments :
13804 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13805 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13806 as explained at the top of this document.
13807
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013808 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013809 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
13810 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
13811 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
13812 data for at most the specified amount of time.
13813
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020013814 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
13815 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
13816 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
13817 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
13818
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013819 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013820 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013821 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013822 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013823 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010013824 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
13825 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
13826 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013827
Christopher Faulet43525ab2023-05-16 08:15:12 +020013828 Note the inspection delay is shortened if an connection error or shutdown is
13829 experienced or if the request buffer appears as full.
13830
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013831 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
13832 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
13833 it pass through unaffected.
13834
13835 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
13836 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
13837 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013838 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013839 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
13840 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020013841 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
13842 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
13843 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013844
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013845 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13846 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
13847
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013848 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013849 "timeout client".
13850
13851
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013852tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13853 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
13854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013855 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013856 Arguments :
13857 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13858 below.
13859
13860 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
13861
13862 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
13863 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
13864 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
13865 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
Anubhave09efaa2021-10-14 22:28:25 +053013866 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case is to copy some
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013867 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
13868 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
13869 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
13870 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
13871 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
13872 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
13873 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
13874 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
13875 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
13876 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
13877 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
13878 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
13879 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
13880 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
13881 instead.
13882
13883 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
13884 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
13885 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
13886 rules which may be inserted.
13887
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013888 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13889 supported:
13890 - accept
13891 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013892 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013893 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
13894 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
13895 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
13896 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13897 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013898 - set-dst <expr>
13899 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013900 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013901 - set-src <expr>
13902 - set-src-port <expr>
13903 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013904 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
13905 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013906 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013907 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
13908 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
13909 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
13910 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013911
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013912 The supported actions are described below.
13913
13914 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13915 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13916 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13917 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13918 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13919 a defaults section defining such rules.
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013920
13921 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
13922 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13923 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
13924
13925 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
13926 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
13927 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
13928 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
13929 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
13930
13931 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
13932 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13933
13934 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
13935 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
13936 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
13937
13938 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13939 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
13940 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13941
13942 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
13943 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
13944 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
13945
13946 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13947 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13948 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
13949
13950 See section 7 about ACL usage.
13951
13952 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
13953
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013954tcp-request session accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13955
13956 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request session"
13957 rules are evaluated.
13958
13959tcp-request session reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13960
13961 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request session" rules
13962 are evaluated.
13963
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013964tcp-request session sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13965 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13966
13967 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
13968 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
13969 a complete description.
13970
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013971tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13972tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13973tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13974
13975 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13976 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13977 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13978 description.
13979
13980tcp-request session sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13981 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13982tcp-request session sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13983 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13984
13985 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13986 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "tcp-request connection
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +020013987 sc-set-gpt" and "tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt0" for a complete
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013988 description.
13989
13990tcp-request session set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13991tcp-request session set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13992
13993 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
13994 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
13995 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
13996
13997tcp-request session set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13998
13999 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
14000 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
14001 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
14002
14003tcp-request session set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14004tcp-request session set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14005
14006 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
14007 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
14008 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
14009
14010tcp-request session set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14011
14012 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
14013 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
14014 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
14015
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010014016tcp-request session set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14017tcp-request session set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014018
14019 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
14020 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
14021 for a complete description.
14022
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010014023tcp-request session silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014024
14025 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
14026 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
14027 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
14028 complete description.
14029
14030tcp-request session track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14031tcp-request session track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14032tcp-request session track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14033
14034 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
14035 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
14036 track-sc2" for a complete description.
14037
14038tcp-request session unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14039
14040 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
14041 details about variables.
14042
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020014043
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014044tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
14045 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
14046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020014047 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014048 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020014049 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
14050 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014051
14052 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
14053
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014054 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014055 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
14056 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020014057 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
14058 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014059
14060 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
14061
14062 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
14063 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
14064 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
14065 inserted.
14066
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014067 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
14068 supported:
14069 - accept
14070 - close
14071 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010014072 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014073 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
14074 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
14075 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
14076 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14077 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14078 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010014079 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014080 - set-log-level <level>
14081 - set-mark <mark>
14082 - set-nice <nice>
14083 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010014084 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
14085 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010014086 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014087 - unset-var(<var-name>)
14088
14089 The supported actions are described below.
14090
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020014091 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
14092 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
14093 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
14094 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
14095 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
14096 a defaults section defining such rules.
14097
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014098 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
14099 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
14100 for changing the default action to a reject.
14101
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014102 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014103
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014104 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
14105 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
14106 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
14107 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
14108 period.
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020014109
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014110 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014111
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014112 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020014113
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014114tcp-response content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020014115
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014116 This is used to accept the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
14117 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020014118
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014119tcp-response content close [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020014120
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014121 This is used to immediately closes the connection with the server. No further
14122 "tcp-response content" rules are evaluated. The main purpose of this action
14123 is to force a connection to be finished between a client and a server after
14124 an exchange when the application protocol expects some long time outs to
14125 elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle connections which take
14126 significant resources on servers with certain protocols.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014127
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014128tcp-response content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020014129
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014130 This is used to reject the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
14131 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014132
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010014133tcp-response content sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14134 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14135
14136 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
14137 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
14138 a complete description.
14139
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014140tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14141tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14142tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020014143
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014144 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
14145 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
14146 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
14147 description.
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020014148
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014149tcp-response content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14150 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14151tcp-resposne content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14152 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014153
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014154 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
14155 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +020014156 sc-set-gpt" and "http-request sc-set-gpt0" for a complete description.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020014157
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014158tcp-response content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
14159 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014160
Willy Tarreau707742f2023-11-30 09:27:51 +010014161 This action is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014162 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020014163
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020014164
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010014165tcp-response content set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
14166 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020014167
14168 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
14169 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
14170 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
14171
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014172tcp-response content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020014173
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014174 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
14175 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014176
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014177tcp-response content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014178
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014179 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
14180 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
14181 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014182
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014183tcp-response content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014184
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014185 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
14186 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014187
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014188tcp-response content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020014189
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014190 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
14191 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
14192 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014193
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010014194tcp-response content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14195tcp-response content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020014196
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014197 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
14198 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
14199 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020014200
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010014201tcp-response content silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020014202
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014203 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
14204 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
14205 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
14206 complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014207
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014208tcp-response content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014209
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014210 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
14211 details about variables.
14212
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014213
14214tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
14215 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
14216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020014217 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014218 Arguments :
14219 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14220 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14221 as explained at the top of this document.
14222
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014223 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
14224 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020014225
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014226 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
14227
14228
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014229timeout check <timeout>
14230 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
14231 established.
14232
14233 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14234 yes | no | yes | yes
14235 Arguments:
14236 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14237 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14238 as explained at the top of this document.
14239
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014240 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014241 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014242 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014243 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010014244 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
14245 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
14246 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014247
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014248 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014249 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
14250
14251 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
14252 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010014253 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014254
14255 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14256 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14257 forget about it.
14258
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010014259 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
14260 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014261
14262
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014263timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014264 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
14265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14266 yes | yes | yes | no
14267 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014268 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014269 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14270 as explained at the top of this document.
14271
14272 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
14273 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
14274 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010014275 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
14276 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
14277 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
14278 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014279 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
14280 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
14281 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014282 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014283 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014284 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
14285 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014286 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
14287 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014288
14289 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
14290 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14291 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
14292 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014293 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014294 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
14295
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014296 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014297
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014298
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014299timeout client-fin <timeout>
14300 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
14301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14302 yes | yes | yes | no
14303 Arguments :
14304 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14305 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14306 as explained at the top of this document.
14307
14308 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
14309 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
14310 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
14311 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
14312 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
14313 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
14314 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010014315 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
14316 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
14317 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014318
14319 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
14320 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
14321 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
14322
14323 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
14324
14325
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014326timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014327 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
14328 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14329 yes | no | yes | yes
14330 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014331 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014332 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14333 as explained at the top of this document.
14334
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014335 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014336 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014337 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014338 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014339 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
14340 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014341
14342 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14343 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14344 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
14345 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014346 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014347 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
14348
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014349 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014350
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014351
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014352timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
14353 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
14354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14355 yes | yes | yes | yes
14356 Arguments :
14357 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14358 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14359 as explained at the top of this document.
14360
14361 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
14362 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
14363 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
14364 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
14365 once the request has started to present itself.
14366
14367 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
14368 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
14369 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
14370 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
14371 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
14372
14373 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
14374 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
14375 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
14376 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
14377
14378 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
14379 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014380 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014381 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
14382 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020014383 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014384
14385 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
14386 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
14387 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
14388 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
14389
14390 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
14391
14392
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014393timeout http-request <timeout>
14394 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
14395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020014396 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014397 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014398 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014399 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14400 as explained at the top of this document.
14401
14402 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
14403 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
14404 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
14405 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
14406 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
14407 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
14408 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020014409 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
14410 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
14411 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
14412 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014413 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014414 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
14415 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014416
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010014417 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
14418 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
14419 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
14420 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
14421 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014422 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014423
14424 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
14425 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014426 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014427 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
14428 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
14429
14430 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020014431 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
14432 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
14433 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014434
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014435 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010014436 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014437
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014438
14439timeout queue <timeout>
14440 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
14441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14442 yes | no | yes | yes
14443 Arguments :
14444 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14445 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14446 as explained at the top of this document.
14447
14448 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
14449 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
14450 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
14451 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
14452 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
14453
14454 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
14455 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
14456 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
14457 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
14458
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014459 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014460
14461
14462timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014463 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
14464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14465 yes | no | yes | yes
14466 Arguments :
14467 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14468 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14469 as explained at the top of this document.
14470
14471 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
14472 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
14473 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
14474 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
14475 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
14476 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
14477 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
14478
14479 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14480 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14481 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
14482 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
14483 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014484 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014485 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014486 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
14487 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014488 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
14489 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014490
14491 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14492 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14493 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
14494 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014495 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014496 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
14497
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014498 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014499
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014500
14501timeout server-fin <timeout>
14502 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
14503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14504 yes | no | yes | yes
14505 Arguments :
14506 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14507 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14508 as explained at the top of this document.
14509
14510 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
14511 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
14512 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
14513 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
14514 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
14515 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
14516 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
14517 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
14518 situations, it should not be needed.
14519
14520 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14521 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
14522 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
14523
14524 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
14525
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014526
14527timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010014528 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14530 yes | yes | yes | yes
14531 Arguments :
14532 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
14533 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14534 as explained at the top of this document.
14535
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014536 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
14537 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
14538 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014539
14540 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14541 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14542 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
14543 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010014544 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014545
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014546 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014547
14548
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014549timeout tunnel <timeout>
14550 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
14551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14552 yes | no | yes | yes
14553 Arguments :
14554 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14555 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14556 as explained at the top of this document.
14557
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014558 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014559 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
14560 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
14561 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014562 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
14563 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014564 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
14565 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
14566 specified.
14567
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014568 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
14569 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
14570 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
14571 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
14572 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
14573 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
14574 state.
14575
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014576 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14577 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14578 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
14579 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014580 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014581
14582 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14583 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14584 forget about it.
14585
14586 Example :
14587 defaults http
14588 option http-server-close
14589 timeout connect 5s
14590 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014591 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014592 timeout server 30s
14593 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
14594
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014595 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014596
14597
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014598transparent (deprecated)
14599 Enable client-side transparent proxying
14600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010014601 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014602 Arguments : none
14603
14604 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
14605 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
14606 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
14607 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
14608 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
14609 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
14610 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
14611 appropriate server.
14612
14613 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
14614
14615 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
14616 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
14617
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014618 See also: "option transparent"
14619
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014620unique-id-format <string>
14621 Generate a unique ID for each request.
14622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14623 yes | yes | yes | no
14624 Arguments :
14625 <string> is a log-format string.
14626
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014627 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
14628 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
14629 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
14630 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014631
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014632 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014633 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014634 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
14635 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
14636 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
14637 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
14638 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
14639 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014640
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014641 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
14642 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014643
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014644 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014645
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050014646 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014647
14648 will generate:
14649
14650 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
14651
14652 See also: "unique-id-header"
14653
14654unique-id-header <name>
14655 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
14656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14657 yes | yes | yes | no
14658 Arguments :
14659 <name> is the name of the header.
14660
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014661 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
14662 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014663
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014664 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014665
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050014666 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014667 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
14668
14669 will generate:
14670
14671 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
14672
14673 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014674
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020014675use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014676 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14678 no | yes | yes | no
14679 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014680 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
14681 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014682
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020014683 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
14684 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014685
14686 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
14687 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
14688 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014689 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014690 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014691 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
14692 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014693
14694 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
14695 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
14696 assign the backend.
14697
14698 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
14699 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
14700 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
14701 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
14702 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
14703 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
14704
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020014705 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014706 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020014707 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
14708 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
14709 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
14710
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014711 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
14712 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
14713 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
14714 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
14715 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
14716 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
14717 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
14718 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
14719 cannot be forced from the request.
14720
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014721 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014722 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
14723 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
14724
14725 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
14726 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014727
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020014728use-fcgi-app <name>
14729 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
14730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14731 no | no | yes | yes
14732 Arguments :
14733 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
14734
14735 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014736
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014737use-server <server> if <condition>
14738use-server <server> unless <condition>
14739 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
14740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14741 no | no | yes | yes
14742 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014743 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
14744 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014745
14746 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
14747
14748 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
14749 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
14750 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
14751
14752 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
14753 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
14754 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
14755 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
14756 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
14757 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
14758 matches will assign the server.
14759
14760 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
14761 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
14762 with the next rules until one matches.
14763
14764 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
14765 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
14766 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
14767 according to other persistence mechanisms.
14768
14769 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
14770 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
14771 stripped.
14772
14773 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
14774 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014775 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014776 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014777 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014778
14779 Example :
14780 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014781 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014782 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014783 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014784 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014785 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000014786 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014787 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
14788 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
14789
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014790 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
14791 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
14792 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
14793 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050014794 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014795 and we fall back to load balancing.
14796
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014797 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014798
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014799
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100148005. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014801--------------------------
14802
14803The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
14804depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
14805settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
14806written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
14807described in this section.
14808
14809
148105.1. Bind options
14811-----------------
14812
14813The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
14814as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
14815no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
14816parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
14817while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
14818provided immediately after the setting name.
14819
14820The currently supported settings are the following ones.
14821
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014822accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
14823 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
14824 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
14825 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
14826 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
14827 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
14828 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
14829 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
14830 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
14831 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010014832 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
14833 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
14834 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014835
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014836accept-proxy
14837 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020014838 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
14839 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014840 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
14841 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
14842 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
14843 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014844 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014845 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
14846 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020014847 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
14848 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014849
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020014850allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010014851 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010014852 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014853 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010014854 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
14855 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020014856
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014857alpn <protocols>
14858 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14859 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14860 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014861 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014862 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +020014863 initial NPN extension. At the protocol layer, ALPN is required to enable
14864 HTTP/2 on an HTTPS frontend and HTTP/3 on a QUIC frontend. However, when such
14865 frontends have none of "npn", "alpn" and "no-alpn" set, a default value of
14866 "h2,http/1.1" will be used for a regular HTTPS frontend, and "h3" for a QUIC
14867 frontend. Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only
14868 supposed the now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most
14869 browsers still support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may
14870 still work for a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. Protocols
14871 not advertised are not negotiated. For example it is possible to only accept
14872 HTTP/2 connections with this:
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010014873
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +020014874 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2 # explicitly disable HTTP/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014875
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +020014876 QUIC supports only h3 and hq-interop as ALPN. h3 is for HTTP/3 and hq-interop
14877 is used for http/0.9 and QUIC interop runner (see https://interop.seemann.io).
Willy Tarreau74d7cc02023-04-19 09:10:47 +020014878 Each "alpn" statement will replace a previous one. In order to remove them,
14879 use "no-alpn".
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +020014880
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +020014881 Note that some old browsers such as Firefox 88 used to experience issues with
14882 WebSocket over H2, and in case such a setup is encountered, it may be needed
14883 to either explicitly disable HTTP/2 in the "alpn" string by forcing it to
14884 "http/1.1" or "no-alpn", or to enable "h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients"
14885 globally.
14886
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014887backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010014888 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014889 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
14890
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010014891curves <curves>
14892 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
14893 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
14894 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
14895 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
14896 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
14897 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
14898
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020014899ecdhe <named curve>
14900 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010014901 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
14902 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020014903
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014904ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014905 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14906 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020014907 client's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
14908 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020014909 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014910
William Lallemand1639d6c2022-05-26 00:18:46 +020014911 Warning: The "@system-ca" parameter could be used in place of the cafile
14912 in order to use the trusted CAs of your system, like its done with the server
14913 directive. But you mustn't use it unless you know what you are doing.
14914 Configuring it this way basically mean that the bind will accept any client
14915 certificate generated from one of the CA present on your system, which is
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +050014916 extremely insecure.
William Lallemand1639d6c2022-05-26 00:18:46 +020014917
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014918ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
14919 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14920 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
William Lallemand960fb742022-11-03 16:31:50 +010014921 It could be a numerical ID, or the constant name (X509_V_ERR) which is
14922 available in the OpenSSL documentation:
14923 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
14924 It is recommended to use the constant name as the numerical value can change
14925 in new version of OpenSSL.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014926 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
14927 error is ignored.
14928
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014929ca-sign-file <cafile>
14930 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14931 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
14932 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
14933 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
14934 'generate-certificates' for details.
14935
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000014936ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014937 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
14938 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
14939 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
14940 'generate-certificates' for details.
14941
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010014942ca-verify-file <cafile>
14943 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
14944 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
14945 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
14946 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
14947 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
14948
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014949ciphers <ciphers>
14950 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
14951 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000014952 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014953 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014954 information and recommendations see e.g.
14955 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14956 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14957 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
14958
14959ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14960 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14961 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
14962 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
14963 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014964 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
14965 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014966
William Lallemandb6ae2aa2023-05-05 00:05:46 +020014967client-sigalgs <sigalgs>
14968 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
14969 the string describing the list of signature algorithms related to client
14970 authentication that are negotiated . The format of the string is defined in
14971 "man 3 SSL_CTX_set1_client_sigalgs" from the OpenSSL man pages. It is not
14972 recommended to use this setting if no specific usecase was identified.
14973
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014974crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014975 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14976 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020014977 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
14978 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014979
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014980crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014981 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14982 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
14983 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
14984 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
14985 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010014986 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
14987 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014988
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010014989 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
14990 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
14991
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014992 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
14993 are loaded.
14994
14995 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010014996 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
William Lallemand589570d2022-05-09 10:30:51 +020014997 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). Files
14998 starting with a dot are also ignored. This directive may be specified multiple
14999 times in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
15000 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
15001 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
15002 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
15003 hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
William Lallemand5c099352023-04-04 16:28:58 +020015004 www.sub.example.org). If an empty directory is used, HAProxy will not start
15005 unless the "strict-sni" keyword is used.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015006
15007 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
15008 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
15009 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
15010 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010015011 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
15012 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015013
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020015014 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015015
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015016 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015017 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015018 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
15019 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015020 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
15021 clients).
15022
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015023 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020015024 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
15025 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
15026 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
15027 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
15028 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
15029 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
15030 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
15031 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
15032 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
15033 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
15034 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
15035 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
15036
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015037 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010015038 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
15039 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
15040 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
15041 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
15042
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050015043 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
15044 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
15045 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
15046 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050015047
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020015048 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
15049 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
15050 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050015051
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020015052crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015053 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
William Lallemand960fb742022-11-03 16:31:50 +010015054 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0.
15055 It could be a numerical ID, or the constant name (X509_V_ERR) which is
15056 available in the OpenSSL documentation:
15057 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
15058 It is recommended to use the constant name as the numerical value can change
15059 in new version of OpenSSL.
15060 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
15061 error is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020015062
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010015063crt-list <file>
15064 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010015065 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
15066 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010015067
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010015068 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
15069
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020015070 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
15071 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
15072 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
15073 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
15074 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010015075
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020015076 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030015077 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
15078 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
15079 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
15080 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
15081 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020015082 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
15083 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
15084 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010015085
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020015086 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
15087 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
15088 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050015089
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020015090 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
15091
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030015092 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015093 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030015094 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
15095 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
15096 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
15097 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
15098 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
15099 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030015100
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +020015101 When no ALPN is set, the "bind" line's default one is used. If a "bind" line
15102 has no "no-alpn", "alpn" nor "npn" set, a default value will be used
15103 depending on the protocol (see "alpn" above). However if the "bind" line has
15104 a different default, or explicitly disables ALPN using "no-alpn", it is
15105 possible to force a specific value for a certificate.
15106
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010015107 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030015108 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020015109 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010015110 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010015111 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010015112 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010015113
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015114defer-accept
15115 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
15116 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
15117 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015118 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015119 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
15120 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
15121 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
15122 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
15123 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
15124 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
15125 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
15126
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020015127expose-fd listeners
15128 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
15129 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemand2be557f2021-11-24 18:45:37 +010015130 In master-worker mode, this is not required anymore, the listeners will be
15131 passed using the internal socketpairs between the master and the workers.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015132 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020015133
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015134force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015135 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015136 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015137 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015138 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015139
15140force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015141 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015142 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015143 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015144
15145force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015146 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015147 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015148 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015149
15150force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015151 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015152 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015153 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015154
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015155force-tlsv13
15156 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
15157 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015158 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015159
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020015160generate-certificates
15161 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15162 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
15163 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
15164 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
15165 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
15166 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
15167 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
15168 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
15169 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
15170 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
15171 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
15172
15173 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
15174 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015175 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020015176 certificate is used many times.
15177
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015178gid <gid>
15179 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
15180 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
15181 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
15182 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
15183 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15184
15185group <group>
15186 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
15187 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
15188 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
15189 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
15190 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15191
15192id <id>
15193 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
15194 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
15195 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
15196 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
15197
15198interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010015199 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
15200 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
15201 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
15202 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
15203 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
15204 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010015205 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
15206 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
15207 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
15208 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
15209 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
15210 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015211
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020015212level <level>
15213 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
15214 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
15215 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015216 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020015217 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
15218 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
15219 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015220 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020015221 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015222 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020015223 all counters).
15224
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020015225severity-output <format>
15226 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
15227 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
15228 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
15229 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
15230 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
15231 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
15232 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
15233 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
15234 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
15235 rfc5424 convention.
15236
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015237maxconn <maxconn>
15238 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
15239 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
15240 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
15241 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
15242 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
15243 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
15244 eat all memory.
15245
15246mode <mode>
15247 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
15248 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
15249 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
15250 UNIX sockets.
15251
15252mss <maxseg>
15253 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
15254 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
15255 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
15256 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
15257 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
15258 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
15259 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
15260 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
15261 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
15262 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
15263 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
15264
15265name <name>
15266 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
15267 page.
15268
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020015269namespace <name>
15270 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
15271 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
15272 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
15273 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
15274
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015275nice <nice>
15276 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
15277 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
15278 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
15279 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
15280 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
15281 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
15282 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
15283 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
15284 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
15285 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
15286 one for an RDP socket.
15287
Willy Tarreau74d7cc02023-04-19 09:10:47 +020015288no-alpn
15289 Disables ALPN processing (technically speaking this sets the ALPN string to
15290 an empty string that will not be advertised). It permits to cancel a previous
15291 occurrence of an "alpn" setting and to disable application protocol
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +020015292 negotiation. It may also be used to prevent a listener from negotiating ALPN
15293 with a client on an HTTPS or QUIC listener; by default, HTTPS listeners will
15294 advertise "h2,http/1.1" and QUIC listeners will advertise "h3". See also
15295 "alpn" bove. Note that when using "crt-list", a certificate may override the
15296 "alpn" setting and re-enable its processing.
Willy Tarreau74d7cc02023-04-19 09:10:47 +020015297
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020015298no-ca-names
15299 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15300 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010015301 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020015302
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015303no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015304 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015305 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015306 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015307 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015308 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
15309 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015310
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020015311no-tls-tickets
15312 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15313 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
15314 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015315 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
15316 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015317 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15318 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15319 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020015320
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015321no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015322 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015323 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015324 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015325 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015326 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
15327 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015328
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015329no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015330 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015331 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015332 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015333 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015334 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
15335 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015336
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015337no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015338 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015339 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015340 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015341 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015342 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
15343 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015344
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015345no-tlsv13
15346 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15347 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
15348 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
15349 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015350 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
15351 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015352
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020015353npn <protocols>
15354 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
15355 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
15356 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015357 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015358 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010015359 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
15360 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
15361 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
15362 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
15363 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020015364
Remi Tricot-Le Breton44f9bf52023-06-23 17:01:09 +020015365ocsp-update [ off | on ] (crt-list only)
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond5d77962022-12-20 11:11:15 +010015366 Enable automatic OCSP response update when set to 'on', disable it otherwise.
15367 Its value defaults to 'off'.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton44f9bf52023-06-23 17:01:09 +020015368 Please note that for now, this option can only be used in a crt-list line, it
15369 cannot be used directly on a bind line. It lies in this "Bind options"
15370 section because it is still a frontend option. This limitation was set so
15371 that the option applies to only one certificate at a time.
15372 If a given certificate is used in multiple crt-lists with different values of
15373 the 'ocsp-update' set, an error will be raised. Here is an example
15374 configuration enabling it:
15375
15376 haproxy.cfg:
15377 frontend fe
15378 bind :443 ssl crt-list haproxy.list
15379
15380 haproxy.list:
15381 server_cert.pem [ocsp-update on] foo.bar
15382
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond5d77962022-12-20 11:11:15 +010015383 When the option is set to 'on', we will try to get an ocsp response whenever
15384 an ocsp uri is found in the frontend's certificate. The only limitation of
15385 this mode is that the certificate's issuer will have to be known in order for
15386 the OCSP certid to be built.
15387 Each OCSP response will be updated at least once an hour, and even more
15388 frequently if a given OCSP response has an expire date earlier than this one
15389 hour limit. A minimum update interval of 5 minutes will still exist in order
15390 to avoid updating too often responses that have a really short expire time or
15391 even no 'Next Update' at all. Because of this hard limit, please note that
15392 when auto update is set to 'on' or 'auto', any OCSP response loaded during
15393 init will not be updated until at least 5 minutes, even if its expire time
15394 ends before now+5m. This should not be too much of a hassle since an OCSP
15395 response must be valid when it gets loaded during init (its expire time must
15396 be in the future) so it is unlikely that this response expires in such a
15397 short time after init.
15398 On the other hand, if a certificate has an OCSP uri specified and no OCSP
15399 response, setting this option to 'on' for the given certificate will ensure
Remi Tricot-Le Breton44f9bf52023-06-23 17:01:09 +020015400 that the OCSP response gets fetched automatically right after init.
15401 The default minimum and maximum delays (5 minutes and 1 hour respectively)
15402 can be configured by the "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay" and
Remi Tricot-Le Breton58432372023-02-28 17:46:29 +010015403 "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay" global options.
15404
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonc9bfe322023-03-13 15:56:31 +010015405 Whenever an OCSP response is updated by the auto update task or following a
15406 call to the "update ssl ocsp-response" CLI command, a dedicated log line is
15407 emitted. It follows a dedicated log-format that contains the following header
15408 "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft" and is followed by specific OCSP-related information:
15409 - the path of the corresponding frontend certificate
15410 - a numerical update status
15411 - a textual update status
15412 - the number of update failures for the given response
15413 - the number of update successes for the givan response
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb33fe2f2023-02-28 17:46:25 +010015414 See "show ssl ocsp-updates" CLI command for a full list of error codes and
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonc9bfe322023-03-13 15:56:31 +010015415 error messages. This line is emitted regardless of the success or failure of
15416 the concerned OCSP response update.
15417 The OCSP request/response is sent and received through an http_client
15418 instance that has the dontlog-normal option set and that uses the regular
15419 HTTP log format in case of error (unreachable OCSP responder for instance).
15420 If such an error occurs, another log line that contains HTTP-related
15421 information will then be emitted alongside the "regular" OCSP one (which will
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5c24f902023-06-23 17:01:08 +020015422 likely have "HTTP error" as text status). But if a purely HTTP error happens
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonc9bfe322023-03-13 15:56:31 +010015423 (unreachable OCSP responder for instance), an extra log line that follows the
15424 regular HTTP log-format will be emitted.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5c24f902023-06-23 17:01:08 +020015425 Here are two examples of such log lines, with a successful OCSP update log
15426 line first and then an example of an HTTP error with the two different lines
15427 (lines were spit and the URL was shortened for readability):
15428 <134>Mar 6 11:16:53 haproxy[14872]: -:- [06/Mar/2023:11:16:52.808] \
15429 <OCSP-UPDATE> /path_to_cert/foo.pem 1 "Update successful" 0 1
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonc9bfe322023-03-13 15:56:31 +010015430
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5c24f902023-06-23 17:01:08 +020015431 <134>Mar 6 11:18:55 haproxy[14872]: -:- [06/Mar/2023:11:18:54.207] \
15432 <OCSP-UPDATE> /path_to_cert/bar.pem 2 "HTTP error" 1 0
15433 <134>Mar 6 11:18:55 haproxy[14872]: -:- [06/Mar/2023:11:18:52.200] \
15434 <OCSP-UPDATE> -/- 2/0/-1/-1/3009 503 217 - - SC-- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0 {} \
15435 "GET http://127.0.0.1:12345/MEMwQT HTTP/1.1"
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond5d77962022-12-20 11:11:15 +010015436
Remi Tricot-Le Breton44f9bf52023-06-23 17:01:09 +020015437 Troubleshooting:
15438 A common error that can happen with let's encrypt certificates is if the DNS
15439 resolution provides an IPv6 address and your system does not have a valid
15440 outgoing IPv6 route. In such a case, you can either create the appropriate
15441 route or set the "httpclient.resolvers.prefer ipv4" option in the global
15442 section.
15443 In case of "OCSP response check failure" error, you might want to check that
15444 the issuer certificate that you provided is valid.
15445
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000015446prefer-client-ciphers
15447 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
15448 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
15449 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020015450 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
15451 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
15452 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000015453
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020015454proto <name>
15455 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
15456 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
15457 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015458 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
15459 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
15460
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015461 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
15462 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
15463 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015464
15465 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
15466 a bind line :
15467
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015468 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015469 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
15470 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
15471
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015472 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020015473 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080015474 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020015475 h2" on the bind line.
15476
Frédéric Lécaille7e491d62023-11-13 18:11:11 +010015477quic-cc-algo { cubic | newreno }
Frédéric Lécaille43910a92022-07-11 10:24:21 +020015478 This is a QUIC specific setting to select the congestion control algorithm
15479 for any connection attempts to the configured QUIC listeners. They are similar
15480 to those used by TCP.
15481
15482 Default value: cubic
15483
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020015484quic-force-retry
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020015485 This is a QUIC specific setting which forces the use of the QUIC Retry feature
15486 for all the connection attempts to the configured QUIC listeners. It consists
15487 in veryfying the peers are able to receive packets at the transport address
15488 they used to initiate a new connection, sending them a Retry packet which
15489 contains a token. This token must be sent back to the Retry packet sender,
15490 this latter being the only one to be able to validate the token. Note that QUIC
15491 Retry will always be used even if a Retry threshold was set (see
Amaury Denoyelle996ca7d2022-11-14 16:17:13 +010015492 "tune.quic.retry-threshold" setting).
15493
15494 This setting requires the cluster secret to be set or else an error will be
15495 reported on startup (see "cluster-secret").
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020015496
15497 See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9000.html#section-8.1.2 for more
15498 information about QUIC retry.
15499
Willy Tarreaua07635e2023-04-13 17:25:43 +020015500shards <number> | by-thread | by-group
Willy Tarreau6dfbef42021-10-12 15:23:03 +020015501 In multi-threaded mode, on operating systems supporting multiple listeners on
15502 the same IP:port, this will automatically create this number of multiple
15503 identical listeners for the same line, all bound to a fair share of the number
15504 of the threads attached to this listener. This can sometimes be useful when
15505 using very large thread counts where the in-kernel locking on a single socket
15506 starts to cause a significant overhead. In this case the incoming traffic is
15507 distributed over multiple sockets and the contention is reduced. Note that
15508 doing this can easily increase the CPU usage by making more threads work a
15509 little bit.
15510
15511 If the number of shards is higher than the number of available threads, it
15512 will automatically be trimmed to the number of threads (i.e. one shard per
15513 thread). The special "by-thread" value also creates as many shards as there
15514 are threads on the "bind" line. Since the system will evenly distribute the
15515 incoming traffic between all these shards, it is important that this number
Willy Tarreaua07635e2023-04-13 17:25:43 +020015516 is an integral divisor of the number of threads. Alternately, the other
15517 special value "by-group" will create one shard per thread group. This can
15518 be useful when dealing with many threads and not wanting to create too many
15519 sockets. The load distribution will be a bit less optimal but the contention
15520 (especially in the system) will still be lower than with a single socket.
Willy Tarreau6dfbef42021-10-12 15:23:03 +020015521
Willy Tarreauc1fbdd62023-04-22 11:38:55 +020015522 On operating systems that do not support multiple sockets bound to the same
15523 address, "by-thread" and "by-group" will automatically fall back to a single
15524 shard. For "by-group" this is done without any warning since it doesn't
15525 change anything for a single group, and will result in sockets being
15526 duplicated for each group anyway. However, for "by-thread", a diagnostic
15527 warning will be emitted if this happens since the resulting number of
15528 listeners will not be the expected one.
15529
William Lallemand1d3c8222023-05-04 15:33:55 +020015530sigalgs <sigalgs>
15531 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
15532 the string describing the list of signature algorithms that are negotiated
15533 during the TLSv1.2 and TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined
15534 in "man 3 SSL_CTX_set1_sigalgs" from the OpenSSL man pages. It is not
15535 recommended to use this setting unless compatibility with a middlebox is
15536 required.
15537
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015538ssl
15539 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015540 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015541 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
15542 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020015543 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
15544 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015545
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015546ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15547 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020015548 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
15549 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
15550 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015551 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15552
15553ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020015554 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
15555 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
15556 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
15557 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015558
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010015559strict-sni
15560 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
15561 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
William Lallemand5c099352023-04-04 16:28:58 +020015562 a certificate. The default certificate is not used. This option also allows
15563 to start without any certificate on a bind line, so an empty directory could
15564 be used and filled later from the stats socket.
15565 See the "crt" option for more information. See "add ssl crt-list" command in
15566 the management guide.
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010015567
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015568tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015569 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015570 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015571 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015572 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015573 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
15574 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
15575 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
15576 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
15577 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
15578 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
15579 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15580
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015581tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010015582 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015583 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
15584 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
15585 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
15586 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
15587 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
15588 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
15589 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020015590 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
15591 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
15592 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015593
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015594thread [<thread-group>/]<thread-set>[,...]
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015595 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
15596 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. It
15597 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020015598
15599 There are two numbering schemes. By default, thread numbers are absolute in
15600 the process, comprised between 1 and the value specified in global.nbthread.
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015601 It is also possible to designate a thread number using its relative number
15602 inside its thread group, by specifying the thread group number first, then a
15603 slash ('/') and the relative thread number(s). In this case thread numbers
15604 also start at 1 and end at 32 or 64 depending on the platform. When absolute
15605 thread numbers are specified, they will be automatically translated to
15606 relative numbers once thread groups are known. Usually, absolute numbers are
15607 preferred for simple configurations, and relative ones are preferred for
15608 complex configurations where CPU arrangement matters for performance.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020015609
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015610 After the optional thread group number, the "thread-set" specification must
15611 use the following format:
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015612
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015613 "all" | "odd" | "even" | [number][-[number]]
15614
15615 As their names imply, "all" validates all threads within the set (either all
15616 of the group's when a group is specified, or all of the process' threads),
15617 "odd" validates all odd-numberred threads (every other thread starting at 1)
15618 either for the process or the group, and "even" validates all even-numberred
15619 threads (every other thread starting at 2). If instead thread number ranges
15620 are used, then all threads included in the range from the first to the last
15621 thread number are validated. The numbers are either relative to the group
Willy Tarreau7fd87562023-02-28 08:19:37 +010015622 or absolute depending on the presence of a thread group number. If the first
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015623 thread number is omitted, "1" is used, representing either the first thread
15624 of the group or the first thread of the process. If the last thread number is
15625 omitted, either the last thread number of the group (32 or 64) is used, or
15626 the last thread number of the process (global.nbthread).
15627
15628 These ranges may be repeated and delimited by a comma, so that non-contiguous
15629 thread sets can be specified, and the group, if present, must be specified
15630 again for each new range. Note that it is not permitted to mix group-relative
15631 and absolute specifications because the whole "bind" line must use either
15632 an absolute notation or a relative one, as those not set will be resolved at
15633 the end of the parsing.
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015634
Willy Tarreau09b52d12023-02-27 16:42:32 +010015635 It is important to know that each listener described by a "bind" line creates
15636 at least one socket represented by at least one file descriptor. Since file
15637 descriptors cannot span multiple thread groups, if a "bind" line specifies a
15638 thread range that covers more than one group, several file descriptors will
15639 automatically be created so that there is at least one per group. Technically
15640 speaking they all refer to the same socket in the kernel, but they will get a
15641 distinct identifier in haproxy and will even have a dedicated stats entry if
15642 "option socket-stats" is used.
15643
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015644 The main purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but
15645 not the same thread in a listener, so that the system can distribute the
15646 incoming connections into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue
15647 load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
Willy Tarreau09b52d12023-02-27 16:42:32 +010015648 See also the "shards" keyword above that automates duplication of "bind"
15649 lines and their assignment to multiple groups of threads.
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015650
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010015651tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
15652 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010015653 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
15654 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
15655 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
15656 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
15657 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
15658 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
15659 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
15660 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
15661 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
15662 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010015663 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
15664 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
15665
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015666transparent
15667 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
15668 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
15669 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
15670 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
15671 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
15672 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
15673 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
15674 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
15675 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
15676 so check for support with your vendor.
15677
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010015678v4v6
15679 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
15680 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
15681 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
15682 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015683 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010015684
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010015685v6only
15686 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
15687 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
15688 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010015689 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
15690 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010015691
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015692uid <uid>
15693 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
15694 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
15695 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
15696 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
15697 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15698
15699user <user>
15700 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
15701 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
15702 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
15703 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
15704 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15705
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020015706verify [none|optional|required]
15707 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
15708 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
15709 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
15710 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
15711 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020015712 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
15713 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
15714 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
15715 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020015716
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200157175.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010015718------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015719
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010015720The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
15721which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
15722arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
15723settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
15724after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
15725Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
15726address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015727
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015728 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010015729 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015730
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015731Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
15732keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
15733
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015734The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015735
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015736addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015737 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010015738 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
15739 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
15740 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
15741 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
15742 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015743
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015744agent-check
15745 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015746 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010015747 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
15748 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
15749 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015750
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015751 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015752 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015753 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020015754 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
15755 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015756
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015757 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
15758 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
15759 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
15760 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
15761 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020015762
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015763 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015764 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015765
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015766 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
15767 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
15768 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015769
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015770 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
15771 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
15772 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015773
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020015774 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015775 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
15776 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
15777 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
15778 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015779 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015780 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015781
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015782 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
15783 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015784
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015785 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
15786 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
15787 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
15788 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
15789 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
15790 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
15791 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
15792 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
15793 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015794
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090015795 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
15796 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015797 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
15798 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
15799 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010015800 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090015801
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015802 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015803 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015804
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070015805agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015806 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070015807 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
15808 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
15809 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
15810 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
15811
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015812agent-inter <delay>
15813 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
15814 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
15815
15816 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
15817 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
15818 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
15819 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
15820 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
15821 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
15822 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
15823 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
15824 of backends use the same servers.
15825
15826 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
15827
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010015828agent-addr <addr>
15829 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
15830
15831 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015832 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010015833 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
15834 hostname, it will be resolved.
15835
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015836agent-port <port>
15837 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
15838
15839 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
15840
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020015841allow-0rtt
15842 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020015843 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
15844 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020015845
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015846alpn <protocols>
15847 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
15848 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
15849 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015850 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015851 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
15852 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
15853 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
15854 now obsolete NPN extension.
15855 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
15856 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
15857
15858 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
15859
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015860 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
15861
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015862backup
15863 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
15864 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
15865 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
15866 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015867 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
15868 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015869
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015870ca-file <cafile>
15871 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15872 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020015873 server's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
15874 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020015875 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020015876
15877 In order to use the trusted CAs of your system, the "@system-ca" parameter
15878 could be used in place of the cafile. The location of this directory could be
15879 overwritten by setting the SSL_CERT_DIR environment variable.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015880
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015881check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015882 This option enables health checks on a server:
15883 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
15884 considered available.
15885 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
15886 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
15887 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
15888 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
15889 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010015890 set. This behavior is slightly different for dynamic servers, read the
15891 following paragraphs for more details.
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015892 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
15893 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
15894 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
15895 exchanges succeed.
15896
15897 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
15898 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
15899 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
15900 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
15901 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050015902 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015903 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
15904
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010015905 Note that the implicit configuration of ssl and PROXY protocol is not
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +020015906 performed for dynamic servers. In this case, it is required to explicitly
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010015907 use "check-ssl" and "check-send-proxy" when wanted, even if the check port is
15908 not overridden.
15909
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015910 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
15911 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
15912
15913 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
15914 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
15915
15916 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
15917 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
15918 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
15919 available.
15920
15921 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
15922 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
15923 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
15924
15925 Example:
15926 # simple tcp check
15927 backend foo
15928 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
15929 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
15930 backend foo
15931 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
15932 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
15933 backend foo
15934 option tcp-check
15935 tcp-check connect
15936 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015937
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020015938check-send-proxy
15939 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
15940 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
15941 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
15942 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
15943 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
15944 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
15945 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
15946
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010015947check-alpn <protocols>
15948 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
15949 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
15950 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
15951
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020015952check-proto <name>
15953 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
15954 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
15955 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015956 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
15957 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
15958
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015959 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
15960 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
15961 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015962
15963 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
15964 directive on a server line:
15965
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015966 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015967 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
15968 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
15969 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
15970
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015971 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020015972 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
15973 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
15974
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010015975check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020015976 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010015977 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
15978 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020015979
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015980check-ssl
15981 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
15982 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
15983 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
15984 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015985 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015986 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
15987 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015988 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015989 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
15990 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015991
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015992check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015993 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015994 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
15995 for normal traffic.
15996
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015997ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020015998 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
15999 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
16000 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000016001 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
16002 information and recommendations see e.g.
16003 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
16004 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
16005 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016006
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020016007ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
16008 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
16009 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
16010 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
16011 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000016012 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
16013 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
16014 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020016015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016016cookie <value>
16017 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
16018 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
16019 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
16020 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
16021 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
16022 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
16023 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
16024
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020016025crl-file <crlfile>
16026 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
16027 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
16028 to verify server's certificate.
16029
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020016030crt <cert>
16031 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
16032 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
16033 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
16034 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
16035 certificate request.
16036
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020016037 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
16038 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
16039 option is set accordingly).
16040
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020016041disabled
16042 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
16043 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
16044 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
16045 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
16046 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016047 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020016048
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016049enabled
16050 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
16051 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
16052 default value.
16053 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
16054 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020016055
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016056error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010016057 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
16058 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
16059 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016060
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016061 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016062
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016063fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016064 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
16065 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
16066 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
16067
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016068force-sslv3
16069 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
16070 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016071 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016072 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016073
16074force-tlsv10
16075 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016076 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016077 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016078
16079force-tlsv11
16080 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016081 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016082 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016083
16084force-tlsv12
16085 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016086 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016087 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016088
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020016089force-tlsv13
16090 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
16091 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016092 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020016093
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016094id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020016095 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
16096 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
16097 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016098
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010016099init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
16100 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
16101 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016102 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010016103 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
16104 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
16105 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
16106 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
16107 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
16108 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
16109 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
16110 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
16111 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016112 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010016113 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
16114 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
16115 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
16116 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
16117 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
16118 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016119 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010016120
16121 Example:
16122 defaults
16123 # never fail on address resolution
16124 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
16125
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016126inter <delay>
16127fastinter <delay>
16128downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016129 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
16130 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
16131 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
16132 between checks depending on the server state :
16133
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020016134 Server state | Interval used
16135 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
16136 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
16137 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
16138 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
16139 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
16140 or yet unchecked. |
16141 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
16142 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
16143 | "inter" otherwise.
16144 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016145
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016146 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
16147 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
16148 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
16149 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090016150 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
16151 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
16152 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
16153 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
16154 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016155
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020016156log-proto <logproto>
16157 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
16158 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
16159 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
16160 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
16161
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016162maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016163 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
16164 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010016165 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
16166 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016167 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
16168 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
16169 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
16170 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
16171
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010016172 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
16173 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
16174 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
16175 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
16176 than 50 concurrent requests.
16177
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016178maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016179 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
16180 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
16181 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
16182 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020016183 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
16184 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
16185 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
16186 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
16187 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
16188 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
16189 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016190
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010016191max-reuse <count>
16192 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
16193 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
16194 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
16195 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
16196 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
16197 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
16198 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
16199 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
16200
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016201minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016202 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
16203 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
16204 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
16205 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
16206 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
16207 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016208 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016209 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016210
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020016211namespace <name>
16212 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
16213 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
16214 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
16215 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
16216
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016217no-agent-check
16218 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
16219 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16220 default value.
16221 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16222 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
16223
16224no-backup
16225 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
16226 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16227 default value.
16228 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16229 "default-server" "backup" setting.
16230
16231no-check
16232 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
16233 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16234 default value.
16235 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16236 "default-server" "check" setting.
16237
16238no-check-ssl
16239 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
16240 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16241 default value.
16242 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16243 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
16244
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016245no-send-proxy
16246 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
16247 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16248 default value.
16249 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16250 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
16251
16252no-send-proxy-v2
16253 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
16254 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16255 default value.
16256 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16257 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
16258
16259no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
16260 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
16261 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16262 default value.
16263 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16264 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
16265
16266no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
16267 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
16268 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16269 default value.
16270 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16271 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
16272
16273no-ssl
16274 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
16275 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16276 default value.
16277 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16278 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
16279
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010016280 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
16281 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
16282 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
16283
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010016284no-ssl-reuse
16285 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
16286 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
16287 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
16288 and for paranoid users.
16289
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020016290no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016291 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
16292 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016293 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016294
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020016295 Supported in default-server: No
16296
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020016297no-tls-tickets
16298 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
16299 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
16300 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016301 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
16302 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010016303 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
16304 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
16305 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016306 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020016307
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020016308no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016309 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020016310 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
16311 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016312 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
16313 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016314 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016315
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020016316 Supported in default-server: No
16317
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020016318no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016319 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020016320 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
16321 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016322 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
16323 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016324 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016325
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020016326 Supported in default-server: No
16327
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020016328no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016329 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016330 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
16331 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016332 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
16333 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016334 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020016335
16336 Supported in default-server: No
16337
16338no-tlsv13
16339 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
16340 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
16341 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
16342 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
16343 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016344 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016345
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020016346 Supported in default-server: No
16347
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016348no-verifyhost
16349 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
16350 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16351 default value.
16352 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16353 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016354
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020016355no-tfo
16356 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
16357 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16358 default value.
16359 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16360 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
16361
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090016362non-stick
16363 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
16364 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
16365 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
16366
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010016367npn <protocols>
16368 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
16369 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
16370 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016371 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010016372 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
16373 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
16374 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
16375
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016376observe <mode>
16377 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
16378 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
16379 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
16380 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
16381 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
16382 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010016383 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016384
16385 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
16386
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016387on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016388 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
16389 Currently, four modes are available:
16390 - fastinter: force fastinter
16391 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
16392 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
16393 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
16394 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
16395
16396 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
16397
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090016398on-marked-down <action>
16399 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
16400 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016401 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
16402 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
16403 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
16404 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
16405 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
16406 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
16407 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
16408 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090016409
16410 Actions are disabled by default
16411
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016412on-marked-up <action>
16413 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
16414 Currently one action is available:
16415 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
16416 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
16417 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
16418 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016419 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
16420 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016421 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
16422 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
16423
16424 Actions are disabled by default
16425
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020016426pool-low-conn <max>
16427 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
16428 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
16429 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
16430 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
16431 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
16432 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
16433 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
16434 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
16435 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
16436 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010016437 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
16438 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
16439 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
16440 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020016441
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010016442pool-max-conn <max>
16443 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
16444 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
16445 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
16446 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
16447 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
16448 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
16449
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010016450pool-purge-delay <delay>
16451 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010016452 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020016453 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010016454
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016455port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016456 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010016457 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
16458 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
16459 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
16460 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
16461 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016462
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020016463proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020016464 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
16465 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
16466 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016467 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
16468 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
16469
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020016470 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
16471 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
16472 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016473
16474 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
16475 a server line :
16476
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020016477 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016478 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
16479 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
16480 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
16481
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016482 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020016483 protocol for all connections established to this server.
16484
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020016485 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
16486
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016487redir <prefix>
16488 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
16489 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
16490 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
16491 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
16492 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
16493 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
16494 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
16495 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016496 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016497 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016498 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
16499 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
16500 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
16501 loop between the client and HAProxy!
16502
16503 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
16504
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016505rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016506 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
16507 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
16508 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
16509
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020016510resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
16511 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
16512 server.
16513
16514 Available options:
16515
16516 * allow-dup-ip
16517 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
16518 resolution at runtime is in operation.
16519 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
16520 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
16521 For such case, simply enable this option.
16522 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
16523
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050016524 * ignore-weight
16525 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
16526 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
16527 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
16528
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020016529 * prevent-dup-ip
16530 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
16531 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
16532 same fqdn.
16533 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
16534
16535 Example:
16536 backend b_myapp
16537 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
16538 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
16539 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
16540
16541 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
16542 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
16543 it
16544 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
16545 different address
16546
16547 Default value: not set
16548
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016549resolve-prefer <family>
16550 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
16551 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
16552 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
16553 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
16554
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020016555 Default value: ipv6
16556
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016557 Example:
16558
16559 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016560
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016561resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016562 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016563 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016564 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016565 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
16566 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016567 configured network, another address is selected.
16568
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016569 Example:
16570
16571 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016572
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016573resolvers <id>
16574 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
16575 hostname.
16576
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016577 Example:
16578
16579 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016580
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016581 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016582
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010016583send-proxy
16584 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
16585 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
16586 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
16587 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016588 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
16589 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
16590 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
16591 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016592 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016593 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
16594 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
16595 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
16596 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
16597 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016598 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
16599 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010016600
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016601send-proxy-v2
16602 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
16603 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16604 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16605 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020016606 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
16607 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
16608 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
16609 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016610
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010016611proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010016612 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
16613 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
16614
16615 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
16616 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
16617 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
16618 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
16619 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
16620 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
16621 connection is supported).
16622 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
16623 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
16624 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
16625 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
16626 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
16627 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
16628 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010016629
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016630send-proxy-v2-ssl
16631 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
16632 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16633 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16634 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
16635 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
16636 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
16637 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016638 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
16639 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016640
16641send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
16642 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
16643 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16644 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16645 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
16646 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
16647 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
16648 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
16649 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016650 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
16651 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016652
Frédéric Lécaille36d15652022-10-17 14:58:19 +020016653shard <shard>
16654 This parameter in used only in the context of stick-tables synchronisation
16655 with peers protocol. The "shard" parameter identifies the peers which will
16656 receive all the stick-table updates for keys with this shard as distribution
16657 hash. The accepted values are 0 up to "shards" parameter value specified in
16658 the "peers" section. 0 value is the default value meaning that the peer will
16659 receive all the key updates. Greater values than "shards" will be ignored.
16660 This is also the case for any value provided to the local peer.
16661
16662 Example :
16663
16664 peers mypeers
16665 shards 3
16666 peer A 127.0.0.1:40001 # local peer without shard value (0 internally)
16667 peer B 127.0.0.1:40002 shard 1
16668 peer C 127.0.0.1:40003 shard 2
16669 peer D 127.0.0.1:40004 shard 3
16670
16671
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016672slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016673 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
16674 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
16675 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
16676 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
16677 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
16678 parameters :
16679
16680 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
16681 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
16682
16683 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
16684 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
16685 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
16686 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
16687
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016688 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016689 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
16690 seen as failed.
16691
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020016692sni <expression>
16693 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
16694 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
16695 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
Willy Tarreaud26fb572022-11-25 10:12:12 +010016696 a bridged TCP/SSL scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
16697 expression. THIS MUST NOT BE USED FOR HTTPS, where req.hdr(host) should be
16698 used instead, since SNI in HTTPS must always match the Host field and clients
16699 are allowed to use different host names over the same connection). If
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020016700 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016701 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010016702 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
16703 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020016704
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016705source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020016706source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016707source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016708 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
16709 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
16710 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
16711 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
16712
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016713 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
16714 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
16715 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
16716 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
16717 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
16718 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
16719 server.
16720
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000016721 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
16722 specifying the source address without port(s).
16723
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016724ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020016725 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
16726 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
16727 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
16728 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
16729 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
16730 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016731 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
16732 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016733
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016734ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
16735 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
16736 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
16737 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
16738
16739ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
16740 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
16741 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
16742 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
16743
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016744ssl-reuse
16745 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
16746 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16747 default value.
16748 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16749 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
16750
16751stick
16752 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
16753 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16754 default value.
16755 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16756 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016757
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080016758socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016759 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080016760 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
16761 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
16762
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016763tcp-ut <delay>
16764 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016765 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016766 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016767 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016768 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
16769 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
16770 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
16771 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
16772 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
16773 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
16774 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
16775 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
16776 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
16777
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010016778tfo
16779 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
16780 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
16781 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
16782 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016783 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020016784 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010016785
Willy Tarreaue54afdc2023-11-10 16:26:32 +010016786track [<backend>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020016787 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
16788 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
16789 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
Willy Tarreaue54afdc2023-11-10 16:26:32 +010016790 enabled. If <backend> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016791 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
16792
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016793tls-tickets
16794 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
16795 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16796 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010016797 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
16798 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
16799 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016800 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010016801 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016802
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020016803verify [none|required]
16804 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010016805 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016806 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
16807 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016808 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016809 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
16810 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
16811 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
16812 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
16813 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
16814 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
16815 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
16816 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020016817
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070016818verifyhost <hostname>
16819 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016820 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
16821 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
16822 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
16823 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
16824 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
16825 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
16826 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
16827 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070016828
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016829weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016830 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
16831 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
16832 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020016833 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
16834 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
16835 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
16836 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
16837 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
16838 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016839
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020016840ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
16841 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
16842 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
16843 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
16844
16845 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
16846 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
16847 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
16848 server ALPN contains it.
16849
16850 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
16851 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
16852 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
16853 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
16854
16855 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
16856 favor of the ALPN extension.
16857
16858 See also "alpn" and "proto".
16859
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016860
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200168615.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
16862-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016863
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016864HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
16865using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070016866configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016867This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
16868can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
16869workload.
16870This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
16871resolution at run time.
16872Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
16873carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
16874
16875
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200168765.3.1. Global overview
16877----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016878
16879As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
16880different steps of the process life:
16881
16882 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
16883 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
16884 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
16885
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016886 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
16887 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016888
16889A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
16890 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
16891 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
16892 resolution to know this new IP.
16893
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016894When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016895HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016896SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
16897from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016898will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016899will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020016900
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016901A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016902 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016903 first valid response.
16904
16905 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
16906 servers return an error.
16907
16908
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200169095.3.2. The resolvers section
16910----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016911
16912This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016913HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
16914contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016915
William Lallemandc33df2e2022-05-06 17:14:00 +020016916At startup, HAProxy tries to generate a resolvers section named "default", if
16917no section was named this way in the configuration. This section is used by
16918default by the httpclient and uses the parse-resolv-conf keyword. If HAProxy
16919failed to generate automatically this section, no error or warning are emitted.
16920
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016921When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
16922uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
16923is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
16924answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
16925
16926When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016927used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016928
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016929 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
16930 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
16931 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016932
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016933 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
16934 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016935
Thierry Fournier55c40ea2021-12-15 19:03:52 +010016936 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016937 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
16938 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016939
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016940For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
16941following scenarios are possible:
16942
16943 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
16944 ignored
16945
16946 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
16947 applied
16948
16949 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
16950 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
16951
16952 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
16953 retries the query with a new type
16954
16955 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
16956 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016957
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016958As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020016959a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016960<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020016961
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016962
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016963resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016964 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016965
16966A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
16967
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020016968accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016969 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016970 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020016971 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
16972 by RFC 6891)
16973
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010016974 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
16975 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
16976 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
16977 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
16978 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
16979 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020016980
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020016981nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
16982 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
16983 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
16984 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
16985 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
16986 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
16987 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
16988 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
16989 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
16990 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010016991 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
16992
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060016993parse-resolv-conf
16994 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
16995 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
16996 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
16997
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016998hold <status> <period>
Christopher Faulet24b319b2023-02-27 17:53:31 +010016999 Upon receiving the DNS response <status>, determines whether a server's state
17000 should change from UP to DOWN. To make that determination, it checks whether
17001 any valid status has been received during the past <period> in order to
17002 counteract the just received invalid status.
17003
17004 <status> : last name resolution status.
17005 nx After receiving an NXDOMAIN status, check for any valid
17006 status during the concluding period.
17007
17008 refused After receiving a REFUSED status, check for any valid
17009 status during the concluding period.
17010
17011 timeout After the "timeout retry" has struck, check for any
17012 valid status during the concluding period.
17013
17014 other After receiving any other invalid status, check for any
17015 valid status during the concluding period.
17016
17017 valid Applies only to "http-request do-resolve" and
17018 "tcp-request content do-resolve" actions. It defines the
17019 period for which the server will maintain a valid response
17020 before triggering another resolution. It does not affect
17021 dynamic resolution of servers.
17022
17023 obsolete Defines how long to wait before removing obsolete DNS
17024 records after an updated answer record is received. It
17025 applies to SRV records.
17026
17027 <period> : Amount of time into the past during which a valid response must
17028 have been received. It follows the HAProxy time format and is in
17029 milliseconds by default.
17030
17031 For a server that relies on dynamic DNS resolution to determine its IP
17032 address, receiving an invalid DNS response, such as NXDOMAIN, will lead to
17033 changing the server's state from UP to DOWN. The hold directives define how
17034 far into the past to look for a valid response. If a valid response has been
17035 received within <period>, the just received invalid status will be ignored.
17036
17037 Unless a valid response has been receiving during the concluding period, the
17038 server will be marked as DOWN. For example, if "hold nx 30s" is set and the
17039 last received DNS response was NXDOMAIN, the server will be marked DOWN
17040 unless a valid response has been received during the last 30 seconds.
17041
17042 A server in the DOWN state will be marked UP immediately upon receiving a
17043 valid status from the DNS server.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017044
Christopher Faulet24b319b2023-02-27 17:53:31 +010017045 A separate behavior exists for "hold valid" and "hold obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017046
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017047resolve_retries <nb>
17048 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
17049 giving up.
17050 Default value: 3
17051
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020017052 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
17053 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
17054 type.
17055
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017056timeout <event> <time>
17057 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
17058 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
17059 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017060 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
17061 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017062 Default value: 1s
17063 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017064 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017065 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017066 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
17067 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
17068
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020017069 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017070
17071 resolvers mydns
17072 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
17073 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020017074 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060017075 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017076 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017077 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017078 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010017079 hold other 30s
17080 hold refused 30s
17081 hold nx 30s
17082 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017083 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020017084 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017085
17086
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200170876. Cache
17088---------
17089
17090HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
17091(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
17092RAM.
17093
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020017094The cache is based on a memory area shared between all threads, and split in 1kB
17095blocks.
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017096
17097If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
17098independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
17099when we try to allocate a new one.
17100
17101The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
17102
17103It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
17104"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
17105for more details.
17106
17107When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
17108replaced by "<CACHE>".
17109
17110
171116.1. Limitation
17112----------------
17113
17114The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
17115
17116- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010017117- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
17118 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
17119 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017120- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
17121- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010017122- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
17123 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
17124 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010017125- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
17126 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010017127- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
17128 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
17129 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017130
17131- If the request is not a GET
17132- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
17133- If the request contains an Authorization header
17134
17135
171366.2. Setup
17137-----------
17138
17139To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
17140the corresponding http-request and response actions.
17141
17142
171436.2.1. Cache section
17144---------------------
17145
17146cache <name>
17147 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
17148 size of cache is mandatory.
17149
17150total-max-size <megabytes>
17151 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
17152 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
17153
17154max-object-size <bytes>
17155 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
17156 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
17157 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
17158
17159max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010017160 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017161 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
17162 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
17163 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
17164 default.
17165
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010017166process-vary <on/off>
17167 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010017168 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
17169 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
17170 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010017171 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010017172
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010017173max-secondary-entries <number>
17174 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
17175 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
17176 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
17177
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017178
171796.2.2. Proxy section
17180---------------------
17181
17182http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
17183 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
17184 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
17185 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
17186 after this one.
17187
17188http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
17189 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
17190 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
17191 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
17192 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
17193
17194
17195Example:
17196
17197 backend bck1
17198 mode http
17199
17200 http-request cache-use foobar
17201 http-response cache-store foobar
17202 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
17203
17204 cache foobar
17205 total-max-size 4
17206 max-age 240
17207
17208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200172097. Using ACLs and fetching samples
17210----------------------------------
17211
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017212HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017213client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
17214The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
17215these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
17216but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
17217data called patterns.
17218
17219
172207.1. ACL basics
17221---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017222
17223The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
17224content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
17225from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
17226simple :
17227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017228 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017229 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017230 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
17231 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017233The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
17234adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017235
17236In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
17237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017238 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017239
17240This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
17241Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
17242and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017243an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
17244conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
17245as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
17246are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017247
17248ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
17249'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
17250which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
17251
17252There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
17253performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
17254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017255The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
17256specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
17257this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017258methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
17259ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017260
17261Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
17262 - boolean
17263 - integer (signed or unsigned)
17264 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
17265 - string
17266 - data block
17267
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017268Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
17269converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
17270would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
17271The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
17272which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
17273
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017274Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
17275keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
17276fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
17277which are summarized in the table below :
17278
17279 +---------------------+-----------------+
17280 | Sample or converter | Default |
17281 | output type | matching method |
17282 +---------------------+-----------------+
17283 | boolean | bool |
17284 +---------------------+-----------------+
17285 | integer | int |
17286 +---------------------+-----------------+
17287 | ip | ip |
17288 +---------------------+-----------------+
17289 | string | str |
17290 +---------------------+-----------------+
17291 | binary | none, use "-m" |
17292 +---------------------+-----------------+
17293
17294Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
17295matching method, see below.
17296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017297The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
17298 - boolean
17299 - integer or integer range
17300 - IP address / network
17301 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
17302 - regular expression
17303 - hex block
17304
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017305The following ACL flags are currently supported :
17306
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017307 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
17308 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017309 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010017310 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010017311 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010017312 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017313 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
17314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017315The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
17316read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
17317if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
17318lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
17319will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
17320beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017321a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017322lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
17323exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
17324
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010017325The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
17326parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
17327ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
17328a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
17329check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
17330
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010017331The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
17332socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
17333file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
17334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017335Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
17336loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
17337
17338 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
17339
17340In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
17341the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
17342case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
17343as well.
17344
17345The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
17346sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
17347do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
17348methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
17349is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017350obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017351followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
17352default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
17353that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
17354string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
17355
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010017356The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
17357By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
17358string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
17359resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017360server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017361waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010017362flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
17363function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
17364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017365There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
17366sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
17367be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017368
17369 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
17370 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017371 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
17372 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
17373 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
17374 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017375
17376 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
17377 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017378 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017379
17380 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017381 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017382
17383 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017384 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017385
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017386 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017387 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
17388
17389 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
17390 binary or string samples.
17391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017392 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
17393 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017395 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
17396 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
17397 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017399 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
17400 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017402 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
17403 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017405 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
17406 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017408 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
17409 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017410 This may be used with binary or string samples.
17411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017412 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
17413 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
17414 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017415
17416For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
17417request, it is possible to do :
17418
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017419 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017420
17421In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
17422buffer, one would use the following acl :
17423
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017424 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017425
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017426On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
17427possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
17428
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017429 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017431All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
17432criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
17433method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
Willy Tarreau4f4fea42022-11-25 10:49:41 +010017434to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. This matching method is only
17435usable when the keyword is used alone, without any converter. In case any such
17436converter were to be applied after such an ACL keyword, the default matching
17437method from the ACL keyword is simply ignored since what will matter for the
17438matching is the output type of the last converter. Since all ACL-specific
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017439criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
17440the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017442If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017443the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
17444For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017446 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
17447 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
17448 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
17449 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017450
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017451
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017452The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
17453types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
17454combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
17455brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
17456default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017458 +-------------------------------------------------+
17459 | Input sample type |
17460 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017461 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017462 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
17463 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
17464 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017465 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017466 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017467 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017468 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017469 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017470 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017471 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017472 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017473 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017474 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017475 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017476 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017477 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017478 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017479 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017480 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017481 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017482 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017483 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017484 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017485 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017486 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
17487 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
17488 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017489
17490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200174917.1.1. Matching booleans
17492------------------------
17493
17494In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
17495Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
17496When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
17497that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
17498
17499Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
17500return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
17501"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
17502
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200175047.1.2. Matching integers
17505------------------------
17506
17507Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
17508enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
17509to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
17510
17511Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
17512matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
17513lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017514
17515For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
17516unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
17517representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
17518
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017519As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
17520two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
17521instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
17522ranges and operators.
17523
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017524For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017525operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
17526Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
17527of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017528
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017529Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017530
17531 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
17532 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
17533 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
17534 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
17535 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
17536
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017537For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017538
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017539 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017540
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017541This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
17542
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017543 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017544
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200175467.1.3. Matching strings
17547-----------------------
17548
17549String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
17550different forms :
17551
17552 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017553 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017554
17555 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017556 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017557
17558 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
17559 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
17560
17561 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
17562 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
17563
Willy Tarreauf386a2d2022-11-25 12:02:25 +010017564 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
17565 extracted string, delimited with slashes ("/"), the beginning or the end
17566 of the string. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, the string
17567 "/images/png/logo/32x32.png", would match "/images", "/images/png",
17568 "images/png", "/png/logo", "logo/32x32.png" or "32x32.png" but not "png"
17569 nor "32x32".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017570
Willy Tarreauf386a2d2022-11-25 12:02:25 +010017571 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
17572 extracted string, delimited with dots ("."), colons (":"), slashes ("/"),
17573 question marks ("?"), the beginning or the end of the string. This is made
17574 to be used with URLs. Leading and trailing delimiters in the pattern are
17575 ignored. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, in the example
17576 string "http://www1.dc-eu.example.com:80/blah", the patterns "http",
17577 "www1", ".www1", "dc-eu", "example", "com", "80", "dc-eu.example",
17578 "blah", ":www1:", "dc-eu.example:80" would match, but not "eu" nor "dc".
17579 Using it to match domain suffixes for filtering or routing is generally
17580 not a good idea, as the routing could easily be fooled by prepending the
17581 matching prefix in front of another domain for example.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017582
17583String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
17584exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
17585characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
17586string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
17587to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017588before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017589
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010017590Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
17591(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
17592Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
17593
17594Example:
17595 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
17596 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
17597
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200175997.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
17600---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017601
17602Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
17603they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
17604possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
17605passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
17606the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017607the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
17608match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017609
17610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200176117.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
17612-------------------------------------
17613
17614It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
17615not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
17616a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
17617to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
17618digits may be used upper or lower case.
17619
17620Example :
17621 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017622 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017623
17624
176257.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
17626---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017627
17628IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
17629netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
17630within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010017631host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017632difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
17633at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
17634does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
17635parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017636
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020017637The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
17638abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
17639
17640 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17641 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
17642 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17643 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
17644 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
17645 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
17646 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
17647 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17648
17649Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
17650192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
17651
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020017652IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
17653Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
17654trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
17655IPv6 patterns.
17656
17657HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
17658following situations :
17659 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
17660 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
17661 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
17662 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
17663 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
17664 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
17665 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
17666 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
17667 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
17668 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
17669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017670
176717.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
17672----------------------------------
17673
17674Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
17675combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
17676
17677 - AND (implicit)
17678 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
17679 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017681A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017683 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020017684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017685Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
17686indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020017687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017688For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
17689"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
17690requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
17691is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
17692
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017693 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017694 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
17695 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
17696 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017697
17698To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
17699and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
17700
17701 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
17702 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
17703 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
17704 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
17705
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017706 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017707 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
17708 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
17709 use_backend www if host_www
17710
17711It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
17712expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
17713be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
17714the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
17715
17716 The following rule :
17717
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017718 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017719 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017720
17721 Can also be written that way :
17722
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017723 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017724
17725It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
17726to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
17727simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
17728sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
17729good use is the following :
17730
17731 With named ACLs :
17732
17733 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
17734 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
17735 monitor fail if site_dead
17736
17737 With anonymous ACLs :
17738
17739 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
17740
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017741See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
17742keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017743
17744
177457.3. Fetching samples
17746---------------------
17747
17748Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
17749against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
17750sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
17751ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
17752of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
17753available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
17754
17755This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
17756Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
17757compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
17758deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
17759
17760The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
17761matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
17762method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
17763indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
17764
17765As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
17766when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
17767mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
17768the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
17769ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
17770
17771Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
17772multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
17773when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017774incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
17775are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017776is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
17777all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
17778
17779Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
17780 - name
17781 - name(arg1)
17782 - name(arg1,arg2)
17783
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017784
177857.3.1. Converters
17786-----------------
17787
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017788Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
17789of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
17790is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
17791was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017792has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017793unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
17794
17795These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
17796sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
17797the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017798support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017799
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017800A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
17801support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
17802supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
17803(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
17804bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
17805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017806The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017807
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001780851d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
17809 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
17810 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
17811 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
17812 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
17813 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
17814
17815 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017816 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
17817 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000017818 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
17819 frontend http-in
17820 bind *:8081
17821 default_backend servers
17822 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
17823 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
17824
Aurelien DARRAGON5c6f86f2022-12-30 16:23:08 +010017825rfc7239_is_valid
17826 Returns true if input header is RFC 7239 compliant header value and false
17827 otherwise.
17828
17829 Example:
17830 acl valid req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_is_valid
17831 #input: "for=127.0.0.1;proto=http"
17832 # output: TRUE
17833 #input: "proto=custom"
17834 # output: FALSE
17835
Aurelien DARRAGON6fb58b82022-12-30 16:37:03 +010017836rfc7239_field(<field>)
17837 Extracts a single field/parameter from RFC 7239 compliant header value input.
17838
17839 Supported fields are:
17840 - proto: either 'http' or 'https'
17841 - host: http compliant host
17842 - for: RFC7239 node
17843 - by: RFC7239 node
17844
17845 More info here:
17846 https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7239.html#section-6
17847
17848 Example:
17849 # extract host field from forwarded header and store it in req.fhost var
17850 http-request set-var(req.fhost) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(host)
17851 #input: "proto=https;host=\"haproxy.org:80\""
17852 # output: "haproxy.org:80"
17853
17854 # extract for field from forwarded header and store it in req.ffor var
17855 http-request set-var(req.ffor) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(for)
17856 #input: "proto=https;host=\"haproxy.org:80\";for=\"127.0.0.1:9999\""
17857 # output: "127.0.0.1:9999"
17858
Aurelien DARRAGON07d67532022-12-30 16:45:42 +010017859rfc7239_n2nn
17860 Converts RFC7239 node (provided by 'for' or 'by' 7239 header fields)
17861 into its corresponding nodename final form:
17862 - ipv4 address
17863 - ipv6 address
17864 - 'unknown'
17865 - '_obfs' identifier
17866
17867 Example:
17868 # extract 'for' field from forwarded header, extract nodename from
17869 # resulting node identifier and store the result in req.fnn
17870 http-request set-var(req.fnn) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(for),rfc7239_n2nn
Aurelien DARRAGONac456ab2023-05-30 09:47:53 +020017871 #input: "127.0.0.1:9999"
17872 # output: 127.0.0.1 (ipv4)
17873 #input: "[ab:cd:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff]:9998"
17874 # output: ab:cd:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff (ipv6)
17875 #input: "_name:_port"
17876 # output: "_name" (string)
Aurelien DARRAGON07d67532022-12-30 16:45:42 +010017877
Aurelien DARRAGON9a273b42022-12-30 16:56:08 +010017878rfc7239_n2np
17879 Converts RFC7239 node (provided by 'for' or 'by' 7239 header fields)
17880 into its corresponding nodeport final form:
17881 - unsigned integer
17882 - '_obfs' identifier
17883
17884 Example:
17885 # extract 'by' field from forwarded header, extract node port from
17886 # resulting node identifier and store the result in req.fnp
17887 http-request set-var(req.fnp) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(by),rfc7239_n2np
Aurelien DARRAGON06d8aad2023-06-02 15:29:17 +020017888 #input: "127.0.0.1:9999"
Aurelien DARRAGONac456ab2023-05-30 09:47:53 +020017889 # output: 9999 (integer)
17890 #input: "[ab:cd:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff]:9998"
17891 # output: 9998 (integer)
17892 #input: "_name:_port"
17893 # output: "_port" (string)
Aurelien DARRAGON9a273b42022-12-30 16:56:08 +010017894
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017895add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017896 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017897 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017898 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
17899 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017900 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017901 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17902 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17903 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17904 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017905 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017906 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017907
Nikola Sale0dbf0382022-04-03 18:11:53 +020017908add_item(<delim>,[<var>][,<suff>]])
17909 Concatenates a minimum of 2 and up to 3 fields after the current sample which
17910 is then turned into a string. The first one, <delim>, is a constant string,
17911 that will be appended immediately after the existing sample if an existing
17912 sample is not empty and either the <var> or the <suff> is not empty. The
17913 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
17914 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after
17915 the <delim> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It is
17916 optional and may optionally be followed by a constant string <suff>, however
17917 if <var> is omitted, then <suff> is mandatory. This converter is similar to
17918 the concat converter and can be used to build new variables made of a
17919 succession of other variables but the main difference is that it does the
17920 checks if adding a delimiter makes sense as wouldn't be the case if e.g. the
17921 current sample is empty. That situation would require 2 separate rules using
17922 concat converter where the first rule would have to check if the current
17923 sample string is empty before adding a delimiter. If commas or closing
17924 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
17925 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreaub143d112022-11-25 09:27:15 +010017926 level parser (please see section 2.2 for quoting and escaping). See examples
17927 below.
Nikola Sale0dbf0382022-04-03 18:11:53 +020017928
17929 Example:
17930 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1,"(site1)") if src,in_table(site1)'
17931 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score2,"(site2)") if src,in_table(site2)'
17932 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score3,"(site3)") if src,in_table(site3)'
17933 http-request set-header x-tagged %[var(req.tagged)]
17934
17935 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1),add_item(",",req.score2)'
17936 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",,(site1))' if src,in_table(site1)
17937
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010017938aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
17939 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
17940 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
17941 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
17942 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
17943 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
17944 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
17945
17946 Example:
17947 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
17948 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
17949
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017950and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017951 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017952 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017953 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
17954 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017955 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017956 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17957 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17958 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17959 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017960 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017961 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017962
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020017963b64dec
17964 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
17965 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017966 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
17967 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020017968
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020017969base64
17970 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017971 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017972 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
17973 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020017974
Marcin Deranek40ca09c2021-07-13 14:05:24 +020017975be2dec(<separator>,<chunk_size>,[<truncate>])
17976 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a string containing an unsigned
17977 integer number per <chunk_size> input bytes. <separator> is put every
17978 <chunk_size> binary input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates
17979 whatever binary input is truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries. <chunk_size>
17980 maximum value is limited by the size of long long int (8 bytes).
17981
17982 Example:
17983 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(:,2) # 258:772:1286:7
17984 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(-,2,1) # 258-772-1286
17985 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(,2,1) # 2587721286
17986 bin(7f000001),be2dec(.,1) # 127.0.0.1
17987
Marcin Deranekda0264a2021-07-13 14:08:56 +020017988be2hex([<separator>],[<chunk_size>],[<truncate>])
17989 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex
17990 digits per input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some
17991 binary input data in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID
17992 can be copied in a header). <separator> is put every <chunk_size> binary
17993 input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates whatever binary input is
17994 truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries.
17995
17996 Example:
17997 bin(01020304050607),be2hex # 01020304050607
17998 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(:,2) # 0102:0304:0506:07
17999 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(--,2,1) # 0102--0304--0506
18000 bin(0102030405060708),be2hex(,3,1) # 010203040506
18001
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018002bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018003 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018004 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018005 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018006 presence of a flag).
18007
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010018008bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
18009 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
18010 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018011 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010018012
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010018013concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
18014 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
18015 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
18016 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
18017 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
18018 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
18019 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
18020 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
18021 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
18022 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
18023 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018024 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040018025 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018026 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020018027 level parser. This is often used to build composite variables from other
18028 ones, but sometimes using a format string with multiple fields may be more
18029 convenient. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010018030
18031 Example:
18032 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
18033 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
18034 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018035 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020018036 tcp-request session set-var-fmt(txn.ipport) "addr=(%[sess.ip],%[sess.port])" ## does the same
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010018037 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
18038
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018039cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018040 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
18041 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018042
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010018043crc32([<avalanche>])
18044 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
18045 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18046 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18047 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
18048 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
18049 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
18050 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
18051 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
18052 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
18053 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010018054 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
18055
18056crc32c([<avalanche>])
18057 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
18058 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18059 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18060 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
18061 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
18062 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
18063 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
18064 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010018065
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020018066cut_crlf
18067 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
18068 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
18069 updated.
18070
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010018071da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020018072 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
18073 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
18074 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
18075 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018076 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020018077 configuration language.
18078
18079 Example:
18080 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020018081 bind *:8881
18082 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000018083 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020018084
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010018085debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
18086 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
18087 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
18088 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
18089 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
18090 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
18091 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
18092 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
18093 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
18094 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
18095 printable sample types.
18096
18097 Example:
18098 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020018099
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020018100digest(<algorithm>)
18101 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
18102 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
18103
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018104 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020018105 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18106
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018107div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018108 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
18109 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018110 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018111 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
18112 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018113 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018114 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18115 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18116 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18117 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018118 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018119 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018120
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018121djb2([<avalanche>])
18122 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
18123 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18124 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18125 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
18126 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
18127 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
18128 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010018129 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
18130 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018131
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018132even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018133 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018134 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
18135
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020018136field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
18137 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
18138 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
18139 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
18140 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
18141 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
18142 fields.
18143
18144 Example :
Tim Duesterhus2a450f02023-11-30 16:41:18 +010018145 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(4,_) # <empty>
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020018146 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
18147 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
18148 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
18149 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
18150 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010018151
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020018152fix_is_valid
18153 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
18154 Information eXchange):
18155
18156 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
18157 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018158 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020018159 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010018160 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020018161 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
18162 checksum
18163
18164 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18165 the server can be parsed.
18166
18167 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
18168 message, false if not.
18169
18170 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
18171
18172 Example:
18173 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18174 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
18175
18176fix_tag_value(<tag>)
18177 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
18178 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
18179 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
18180 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050018181 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020018182 added.
18183
18184 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18185 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
18186 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
18187 fix_is_valid converter.
18188
18189 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
18190
18191 Example:
18192 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18193 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
18194 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
18195 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
18196 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
18197
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018198hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018199 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018200 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018201 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018202 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010018203
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020018204hex2i
18205 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018206 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020018207
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020018208htonl
18209 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
18210 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
18211 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
18212 unsigned 32-bit integer.
18213
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010018214hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020018215 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
18216 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
18217 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
18218 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
18219
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018220 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020018221 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18222
William Lallemanddd754cb2022-08-26 16:21:28 +020018223host_only
18224 Converts a string which contains a Host header value and removes its port.
18225 The input must respect the format of the host header value
18226 (rfc9110#section-7.2). It will support that kind of input: hostname,
18227 hostname:80, 127.0.0.1, 127.0.0.1:80, [::1], [::1]:80.
18228
18229 This converter also sets the string in lowercase.
18230
18231 See also: "port_only" converter which will return the port.
18232
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010018233http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018234 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
18235 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000018236 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
18237 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
18238 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
18239 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
18240 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
18241 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
18242 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
18243 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018244
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020018245iif(<true>,<false>)
18246 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
18247 string otherwise.
18248
18249 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020018250 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020018251
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018252in_table(<table>)
18253 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18254 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
18255 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018256 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018257 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
18258
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010018259ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010018260 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020018261 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010018262 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
18263 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
18264 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
18265 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
18266 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020018267
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018268json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018269 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018270 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020018271 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018272 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
18273 of errors:
18274 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
18275 bytes, ...)
18276 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
18277 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
18278
18279 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
18280 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
18281 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
18282 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
18283 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
18284 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018285 - "ascii" : never fails;
18286 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
18287 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018288 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018289 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018290 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
18291 characters corresponding to the other errors.
18292
18293 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018294 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018295
18296 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018297 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020018298 capture request header user-agent len 150
18299 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018300
18301 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
18302 GET / HTTP/1.0
18303 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
18304
18305 Output log:
18306 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
18307
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020018308json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
18309 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
18310 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
18311 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
18312 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
18313
18314 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
18315 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
18316
18317 Example:
18318 # get a integer value from the request body
18319 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
18320 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
18321
18322 # get a key with '.' in the name
18323 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
18324 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
18325
18326 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
18327 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
18328
18329 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
18330 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
18331
Remi Tricot-Le Breton0a72f5e2021-10-01 15:36:57 +020018332jwt_header_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
18333 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded header
18334 part of the token (the first base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if no
18335 parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded header part of
18336 the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
18337 json_path and output_type parameters.
18338
18339 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
18340 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18341
18342jwt_payload_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
18343 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded
18344 payload part of the token (the second base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if
18345 no parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded payload part
18346 of the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
18347 json_path and output_type parameters.
18348
18349 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
18350 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18351
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018352jwt_verify(<alg>,<key>)
18353 Performs a signature verification for the JSON Web Token (JWT) given in input
18354 by using the <alg> algorithm and the <key> parameter, which should either
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020018355 hold a secret or a path to a public certificate. Returns 1 in case of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020018356 verification success, 0 in case of verification error and a strictly negative
18357 value for any other error. Because of all those non-null error return values,
18358 the result of this converter should never be converted to a boolean. See
18359 below for a full list of the possible return values.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020018360
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018361 For now, only JWS tokens using the Compact Serialization format can be
Remi Tricot-Le Breton447a38f2023-03-07 17:43:57 +010018362 processed (three dot-separated base64-url encoded strings). All the
Remi Tricot-Le Bretoncca939e2023-08-10 16:11:27 +020018363 algorithms mentioned in section 3.1 of RFC7518 are managed (HS, ES, RS and PS
18364 with the 256, 384 or 512 key sizes, as well as the special "none" case).
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020018365
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018366 If the used algorithm is of the HMAC family, <key> should be the secret used
18367 in the HMAC signature calculation. Otherwise, <key> should be the path to the
18368 public certificate that can be used to validate the token's signature. All
18369 the certificates that might be used to verify JWTs must be known during init
18370 in order to be added into a dedicated certificate cache so that no disk
18371 access is required during runtime. For this reason, any used certificate must
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050018372 be mentioned explicitly at least once in a jwt_verify call. Passing an
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018373 intermediate variable as second parameter is then not advised.
18374
18375 This converter only verifies the signature of the token and does not perform
18376 a full JWT validation as specified in section 7.2 of RFC7519. We do not
18377 ensure that the header and payload contents are fully valid JSON's once
18378 decoded for instance, and no checks are performed regarding their respective
18379 contents.
18380
18381 The possible return values are the following :
18382
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020018383 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
18384 | ID | message |
18385 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020018386 | 0 | "Verification failure" |
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050018387 | 1 | "Verification success" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020018388 | -1 | "Unknown algorithm (not mentioned in RFC7518)" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton447a38f2023-03-07 17:43:57 +010018389 | -2 | "Unmanaged algorithm" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020018390 | -3 | "Invalid token" |
18391 | -4 | "Out of memory" |
18392 | -5 | "Unknown certificate" |
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020018393 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018394
18395 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
18396 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18397
18398 Example:
18399 # Get a JWT from the authorization header, extract the "alg" field of its
18400 # JOSE header and use a public certificate to verify a signature
18401 http-request set-var(txn.bearer) http_auth_bearer
18402 http-request set-var(txn.jwt_alg) var(txn.bearer),jwt_header_query('$.alg')
Aurelien DARRAGON4761b0d2023-05-26 14:29:58 +020018403 http-request deny unless { var(txn.jwt_alg) -m str "RS256" }
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018404 http-request deny unless { var(txn.bearer),jwt_verify(txn.jwt_alg,"/path/to/crt.pem") 1 }
18405
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018406language(<value>[,<default>])
18407 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
18408 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
18409 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
18410 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
18411 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
18412 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
18413 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
18414 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
18415 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018416 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018417 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
18418 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020018419
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018420 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020018421
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018422 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
18423 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020018424
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018425 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
18426 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
18427 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
18428 use_backend spanish if es
18429 use_backend french if fr
18430 use_backend english if en
18431 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020018432
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010018433length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010018434 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
18435 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
18436 type. The result is of type integer.
18437
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020018438lower
18439 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
18440 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
18441 type. The result is of type string.
18442
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020018443ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
18444 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
18445 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
18446 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
18447 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
18448 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
18449 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
18450
18451 Example :
18452
18453 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018454 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020018455 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
18456
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020018457ltrim(<chars>)
18458 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
18459 representation of the input sample.
18460
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018461map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
18462map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
18463map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
18464 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
18465 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
18466 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
18467 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
18468 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
18469 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
18470 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
18471 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018472
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018473 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
18474 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
18475 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018476
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018477 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018478 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018479
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018480 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
18481 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18482 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
18483 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020018484 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
18485 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018486 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
18487 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18488 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
18489 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18490 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
18491 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18492 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
18493 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080018494 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
18495 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18496 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018497 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18498 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
18499 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18500 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
18501 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018502
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010018503 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
18504 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
18505 the corresponding match text.
18506
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018507 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
18508 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
18509 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
18510 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
18511 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018512
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018513 Example :
18514
18515 # this is a comment and is ignored
18516 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
18517 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
18518 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
18519 | | | `---------- value
18520 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
18521 | `---------------------------- key
18522 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
18523
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018524mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018525 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
18526 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018527 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018528 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018529 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018530 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18531 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18532 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18533 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018534 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018535 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018536
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020018537mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010018538 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
18539 <packettype>.
18540 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
18541 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
18542 from.
18543 Supported string and integers can be found here:
18544 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
18545 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
18546
18547 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
18548 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
18549 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
18550 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
18551
18552 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
18553 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
18554 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
18555 packets only):
18556 17: Session Expiry Interval
18557 33: Receive Maximum
18558 39: Maximum Packet Size
18559 34: Topic Alias Maximum
18560 25: Request Response Information
18561 23: Request Problem Information
18562 21: Authentication Method
18563 22: Authentication Data
18564 18: Will Delay Interval
18565 1: Payload Format Indicator
18566 2: Message Expiry Interval
18567 3: Content Type
18568 8: Response Topic
18569 9: Correlation Data
18570 Not supported yet:
18571 38: User Property
18572
18573 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
18574 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
18575 packets only):
18576 17: Session Expiry Interval
18577 33: Receive Maximum
18578 36: Maximum QoS
18579 37: Retain Available
18580 39: Maximum Packet Size
18581 18: Assigned Client Identifier
18582 34: Topic Alias Maximum
18583 31: Reason String
18584 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
18585 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
18586 42: Shared Subscription Available
18587 19: Server Keep Alive
18588 26: Response Information
18589 28: Server Reference
18590 21: Authentication Method
18591 22: Authentication Data
18592 Not supported yet:
18593 38: User Property
18594
18595 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18596 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
18597 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
18598 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
18599
18600 Example:
18601
18602 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
18603 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
18604 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
18605 if data_in_buffer
18606 # do the same as above
18607 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
18608 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
18609 if data_in_buffer
18610
18611mqtt_is_valid
18612 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
18613
18614 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18615 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
18616 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
18617 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
18618
Christopher Faulet140a3572022-03-22 09:41:11 +010018619 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
18620
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010018621 Example:
18622
18623 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040018624 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010018625
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018626mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018627 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020018628 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
18629 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018630 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018631 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018632 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018633 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18634 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18635 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18636 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018637 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018638 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018639
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010018640nbsrv
18641 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
18642 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
18643 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
18644 map lookup.
18645
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018646neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018647 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
18648 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
18649 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
18650 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018651
18652not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018653 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018654 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018655 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018656 absence of a flag).
18657
18658odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018659 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018660 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
18661
18662or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018663 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018664 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018665 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
18666 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018667 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018668 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18669 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18670 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18671 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018672 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018673 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018674
Thayne McCombs02cf4ec2022-12-14 00:19:59 -070018675param(<name>,[<delim>])
18676 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the input string
18677 where parameters are delimited by <delim>, which defaults to "&", and the name
18678 and value of the parameter are separated by a "=". If there is no "=" and
18679 value before the end of the parameter segment, it is treated as equivalent to
18680 a value of an empty string.
18681
18682 This can be useful for extracting parameters from a query string, or possibly
18683 a x-www-form-urlencoded body. In particular, `query,param(<name>)` can be used
18684 as an alternative to `urlp(<name>)` which only uses "&" as a delimiter,
18685 whereas "urlp" also uses "?" and ";".
18686
18687 Note that this converter doesn't do anything special with url encoded
18688 characters. If you want to decode the value, you can use the url_dec converter
18689 on the output. If the name of the parameter in the input might contain encoded
18690 characters, you'll probably want do normalize the input before calling
18691 "param". This can be done using "http-request normalize-uri", in particular
18692 the percent-decode-unreserved and percent-to-uppercase options.
18693
18694 Example :
18695 str(a=b&c=d&a=r),param(a) # b
18696 str(a&b=c),param(a) # ""
18697 str(a=&b&c=a),param(b) # ""
18698 str(a=1;b=2;c=4),param(b,;) # 2
18699 query,param(redirect_uri),urldec()
18700
William Lallemanddd754cb2022-08-26 16:21:28 +020018701port_only
18702 Converts a string which contains a Host header value into an integer by
18703 returning its port.
18704 The input must respect the format of the host header value
18705 (rfc9110#section-7.2). It will support that kind of input: hostname,
18706 hostname:80, 127.0.0.1, 127.0.0.1:80, [::1], [::1]:80.
18707
18708 If no port were provided in the input, it will return 0.
18709
18710 See also: "host_only" converter which will return the host.
18711
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010018712protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
18713 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
18714 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
18715 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
18716 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
18717 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
18718 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
18719 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
18720 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
18721 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
18722 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
18723 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
18724
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010018725regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018726 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
18727 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
18728 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
18729 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
18730 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
18731 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
18732 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
18733 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
18734 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018735 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
18736 of characters with other ones.
18737
18738 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
18739 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
18740 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
18741 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
18742 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
18743 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018744
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010018745 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018746
18747 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
18748 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
18749 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018750 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018751
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010018752 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
18753 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
18754
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010018755 # capture groups and backreferences
18756 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020018757 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010018758 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
18759
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018760capture-req(<id>)
18761 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
18762 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
18763
18764 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020018765 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
18766 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018767
18768capture-res(<id>)
18769 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
18770 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
18771
18772 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020018773 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
18774 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018775
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020018776rtrim(<chars>)
18777 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
18778 of the input sample.
18779
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018780sdbm([<avalanche>])
18781 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
18782 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18783 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18784 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
18785 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
18786 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
18787 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010018788 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
18789 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018790
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018791secure_memcmp(<var>)
18792 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
18793 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
18794 match.
18795
18796 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
18797 performed in constant time.
18798
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018799 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018800 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18801
18802 Example :
18803
18804 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
18805 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
18806 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
18807 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
18808
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010018809set-var(<var>[,<cond>...])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018810 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010018811 as-is if all of the specified conditions are true (see below for a list of
18812 possible conditions). The variable keeps the value and the associated input
18813 type. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
18814 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018815 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018816 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18817 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018818 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018819 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18820 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018821 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018822 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018823
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010018824 You can pass at most four conditions to the converter among the following
18825 possible conditions :
18826 - "ifexists"/"ifnotexists":
18827 Checks if the variable already existed before the current set-var call.
18828 A variable is usually created through a successful set-var call.
18829 Note that variables of scope "proc" are created during configuration
18830 parsing so the "ifexists" condition will always be true for them.
18831 - "ifempty"/"ifnotempty":
18832 Checks if the input is empty or not.
18833 Scalar types are never empty so the ifempty condition will be false for
18834 them regardless of the input's contents (integers, booleans, IPs ...).
18835 - "ifset"/"ifnotset":
18836 Checks if the variable was previously set or not, or if unset-var was
18837 called on the variable.
18838 A variable that does not exist yet is considered as not set. A "proc"
18839 variable can exist while not being set since they are created during
18840 configuration parsing.
18841 - "ifgt"/"iflt":
18842 Checks if the content of the variable is "greater than" or "less than"
18843 the input. This check can only be performed if both the input and
18844 the variable are of type integer. Otherwise, the check is considered as
18845 true by default.
18846
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020018847sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018848 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020018849 sample with length of 20 bytes.
18850
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018851sha2([<bits>])
18852 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
18853 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
18854
18855 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
18856 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
18857
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018858 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018859 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18860
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020018861srv_queue
18862 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
18863 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
18864 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
18865 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
18866 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
18867
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020018868strcmp(<var>)
18869 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
18870 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
18871 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
18872 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
18873 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
18874 shorter).
18875
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018876 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
18877 strings in constant time.
18878
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020018879 Example :
18880
18881 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
18882 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
18883 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
18884
18885
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018886sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018887 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
18888 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018889 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018890 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
18891 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018892 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018893 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18894 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018895 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018896 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18897 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018898 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018899 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018900
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018901table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
18902 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18903 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18904 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
18905 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
18906 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
18907 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
18908
18909
18910table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
18911 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18912 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18913 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
18914 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
18915 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
18916 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
18917
18918table_conn_cnt(<table>)
18919 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18920 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018921 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018922 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
18923 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
18924
18925table_conn_cur(<table>)
18926 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18927 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18928 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
18929 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
18930 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
18931
18932table_conn_rate(<table>)
18933 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18934 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18935 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
18936 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
18937 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
18938
Frédéric Lécaillebbeec372022-08-16 18:11:25 +020018939table_expire(<table>[,<default_value>])
18940 Uses the input sample to perform a look up in the specified table. If the key
18941 is not found in the table, the converter fails except if <default_value> is
18942 set: this makes the converter succeed and return <default_value>. If the key
18943 is found the converter returns the key expiration delay associated with the
18944 input sample in the designated table.
18945 See also the table_idle sample fetch keyword.
18946
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018947table_gpt(<idx>,<table>)
18948 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
18949 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
18950 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the general
18951 purpose tag at the index <idx> of the array associated to the input sample
18952 in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18953 If there is no GPT stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
18954 This applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on the legacy 'gpt0'
18955 data-type).
18956 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
18957
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018958table_gpt0(<table>)
18959 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18960 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
18961 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
18962 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
18963 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
18964
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018965table_gpc(<idx>,<table>)
18966 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
18967 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18968 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the
18969 General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array associated
18970 to the input sample in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer
18971 between 0 and 99.
18972 If there is no GPC stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
18973 This applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18974 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18975 See also the sc_get_gpc sample fetch keyword.
18976
18977table_gpc_rate(<idx>,<table>)
18978 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
18979 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18980 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the Global
18981 Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array (associated to the input sample
18982 in the designated stick-table <table>) was incremented over the
18983 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18984 If there is no gpc_rate stored at this index, it also returns the boolean
18985 value 0.
18986 This applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to the
18987 legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18988 See also the sc_gpc_rate sample fetch keyword.
18989
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018990table_gpc0(<table>)
18991 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18992 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18993 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
18994 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
18995 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
18996
18997table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
18998 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18999 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19000 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
19001 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
19002 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
19003 sample fetch keyword.
19004
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019005table_gpc1(<table>)
19006 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19007 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19008 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
19009 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
19010 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
19011
19012table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
19013 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19014 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19015 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
19016 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
19017 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
19018 sample fetch keyword.
19019
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019020table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
19021 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19022 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019023 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019024 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
19025 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
19026
19027table_http_err_rate(<table>)
19028 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19029 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19030 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
19031 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
19032 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
19033 keyword.
19034
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010019035table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
19036 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19037 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19038 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
19039 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
19040 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
19041
19042table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
19043 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19044 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19045 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
19046 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
19047 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
19048 keyword.
19049
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019050table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
19051 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19052 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019053 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019054 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
19055 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
19056
19057table_http_req_rate(<table>)
19058 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19059 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19060 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
19061 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
19062 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
19063 keyword.
19064
Aurelien DARRAGONfd766dd2022-11-23 14:35:06 +010019065table_idle(<table>[,<default_value>])
Frédéric Lécaillebbeec372022-08-16 18:11:25 +020019066 Uses the input sample to perform a look up in the specified table. If the key
19067 is not found in the table, the converter fails except if <default_value> is
19068 set: this makes the converter succeed and return <default_value>. If the key
19069 is found the converter returns the time the key entry associated with the
19070 input sample in the designated table remained idle since the last time it was
19071 updated.
19072 See also the table_expire sample fetch keyword.
19073
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019074table_kbytes_in(<table>)
19075 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19076 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019077 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019078 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
19079 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
19080 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
19081 keyword.
19082
19083table_kbytes_out(<table>)
19084 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19085 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019086 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019087 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
19088 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
19089 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
19090 keyword.
19091
19092table_server_id(<table>)
19093 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19094 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19095 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
19096 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
19097 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
19098 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
19099
19100table_sess_cnt(<table>)
19101 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19102 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019103 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019104 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
19105 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
19106 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
19107 keyword.
19108
19109table_sess_rate(<table>)
19110 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19111 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19112 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
19113 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
19114 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
19115 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
19116 keyword.
19117
19118table_trackers(<table>)
19119 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19120 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19121 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
19122 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
19123 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
19124 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
19125 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
19126 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
19127 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
19128 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
19129
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020019130ub64dec
19131 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
19132 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
19133 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
19134
19135 Example:
19136 # Decoding a JWT payload:
19137 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
19138
19139ub64enc
19140 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
19141
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020019142upper
19143 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
19144 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
19145 type. The result is of type string.
19146
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020019147url_dec([<in_form>])
19148 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
19149 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
19150 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
19151 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
19152 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
19153 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020019154
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010019155url_enc([<enc_type>])
19156 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
19157 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
19158 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
19159 optional argument is here for future changes.
19160
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019161ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010019162 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010019163 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
19164 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
19165 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019166 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
19167 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
19168 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
19169 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010019170 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019171 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
19172 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010019173
19174 Example:
19175 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
19176 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
19177
19178 message Point {
19179 int32 latitude = 1;
19180 int32 longitude = 2;
19181 }
19182
19183 message PPoint {
19184 Point point = 59;
19185 }
19186
19187 message Rectangle {
19188 // One corner of the rectangle.
19189 PPoint lo = 48;
19190 // The other corner of the rectangle.
19191 PPoint hi = 49;
19192 }
19193
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020019194 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
19195 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
19196 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010019197
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019198 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
19199 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019200 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019201 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
19202
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020019203 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019204
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010019205 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019206
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020019207 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
19208 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
19209 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010019210
19211 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
19212 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
19213 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
19214
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020019215 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
19216 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
19217 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010019218
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010019219
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010019220unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010019221 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
19222 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
19223 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
19224 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
19225 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
19226 response),
19227 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
19228 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
19229 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
19230 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
19231
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020019232utime(<format>[,<offset>])
19233 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
19234 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
19235 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
19236 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
19237 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
19238 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
19239
19240 Example :
19241
19242 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019243 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020019244 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
19245
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020019246word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
19247 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
19248 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
19249 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Tim Duesterhus2a450f02023-11-30 16:41:18 +010019250 Empty words are skipped. This means that delimiters at the start or end of
19251 the input string are ignored and consecutive delimiters within the input
19252 string are considered to be a single delimiter.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020019253 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
19254 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
19255
19256 Example :
19257 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
Tim Duesterhus2a450f02023-11-30 16:41:18 +010019258 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(5,_) # <not found>
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020019259 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
19260 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
19261 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
19262 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010019263 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Tim Duesterhus2a450f02023-11-30 16:41:18 +010019264 str(/f1////f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010019265
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019266wt6([<avalanche>])
19267 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
19268 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
19269 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
19270 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
19271 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
19272 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
19273 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010019274 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
19275 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019276
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010019277xor(<value>)
19278 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020019279 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020019280 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019281 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010019282 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019283 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
19284 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020019285 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019286 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
19287 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020019288 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010019289 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010019290
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010019291xxh3([<seed>])
19292 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
19293 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
19294 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
19295 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
19296 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
19297 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
19298 considered as cryptographically secure.
19299
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010019300xxh32([<seed>])
19301 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
19302 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
19303 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
19304 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
19305 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
19306 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
19307 as cryptographically secure.
19308
19309xxh64([<seed>])
19310 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
19311 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
19312 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
19313 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
19314 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
19315 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
19316 as cryptographically secure.
19317
William Lallemand9fbc84e2022-11-03 18:56:37 +010019318x509_v_err_str
19319 Convert a numerical value to its corresponding X509_V_ERR constant name. It
19320 is useful in ACL in order to have a configuration which works with multiple
19321 version of OpenSSL since some codes might change when changing version.
19322
William Lallemand117c7fd2023-05-03 15:13:10 +020019323 When the corresponding constant name was not found, outputs the numerical
19324 value as a string.
19325
William Lallemand9fbc84e2022-11-03 18:56:37 +010019326 The list of constant provided by OpenSSL can be found at
19327 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
19328 Be careful to read the page for the right version of OpenSSL.
19329
19330 Example:
19331
19332 bind :443 ssl crt common.pem ca-file ca-auth.crt verify optional crt-ignore-err X509_V_ERR_CERT_REVOKED,X509_V_ERR_CERT_HAS_EXPIRED
19333
19334 acl cert_expired ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_ERR_CERT_HAS_EXPIRED
19335 acl cert_revoked ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_ERR_CERT_REVOKED
19336 acl cert_ok ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_OK
19337
19338 http-response add-header X-SSL Ok if cert_ok
19339 http-response add-header X-SSL Expired if cert_expired
19340 http-response add-header X-SSL Revoked if cert_revoked
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010019341
William Lallemand117c7fd2023-05-03 15:13:10 +020019342 http-response add-header X-SSL-verify %[ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str]
19343
19344
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200193457.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019346--------------------------------------------
19347
19348A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
19349not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
Aurelien DARRAGON4bd597b2023-11-30 11:11:43 +010019350"monitor fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019351The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
19352
19353always_false : boolean
19354 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
19355 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
19356
19357always_true : boolean
19358 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
19359 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
19360
19361avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019362 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019363 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
19364 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
19365 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
19366 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
19367 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
19368 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
19369 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
19370 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
19371 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
19372 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
19373 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
19374 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
19375 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010019376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019377be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020019378 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
19379 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
19380 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
19381 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040019382 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
19383
19384be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
19385 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
19386 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
19387 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
19388 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
19389 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040019390 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
19391 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040019392
19393 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
19394 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
19395 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019397be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
19398 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
19399 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
19400 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019401 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019402 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
19403 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019404
19405 Example :
19406 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
19407 backend dynamic
19408 mode http
19409 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
19410 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019411
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019412bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019413 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
19414 of the string.
19415
19416bool(<bool>) : bool
19417 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
19418 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
19419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019420connslots([<backend>]) : integer
19421 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019422 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019423 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
19424 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050019425
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019426 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019427 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019428 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
19429
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019430 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
19431 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019432
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020019433 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019434 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019435 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019436 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019437 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019438 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020019439 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019440
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019441 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
19442 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019443 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019444 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019445
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019446cpu_calls : integer
19447 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
19448 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
19449 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
19450 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
19451 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
19452 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
19453
19454cpu_ns_avg : integer
19455 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
19456 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
19457 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
19458 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
19459 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
19460 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
19461 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
19462 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
19463 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
19464 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
19465 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
19466
19467cpu_ns_tot : integer
19468 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
19469 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
19470 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
19471 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
19472 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
19473 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
19474 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
19475 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
19476 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
19477 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
19478 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
19479 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
19480 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
19481
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010019482date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020019483 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000019484
19485 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
19486 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
19487 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020019488 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
19489
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000019490 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
19491 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
19492 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
19493 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
19494 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
19495
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020019496 Example :
19497
19498 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
19499 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020019500
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000019501 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
19502 # millisecond granularity
19503 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
19504
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010019505date_us : integer
19506 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
19507 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
19508 from the same timeval structure.
19509
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020019510env(<name>) : string
19511 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
19512 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
19513 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
19514 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
19515 certain way.
19516
19517 Examples :
19518 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
19519 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
19520
19521 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019522 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020019523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019524fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
19525 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019526 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
19527 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019528 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
19529 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019530 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019531 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
19532 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020019533
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020019534fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
19535 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
19536 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
19537 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
19538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019539fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
19540 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
19541 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
19542 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
19543 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
19544 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
19545 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
19546 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
19547 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010019548
19549 Example :
19550 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
19551 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
19552 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
19553 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
19554 frontend mail
19555 bind :25
19556 mode tcp
19557 maxconn 100
19558 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
19559 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
19560 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
19561 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019562
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010019563hostname : string
19564 Returns the system hostname.
19565
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020019566int(<integer>) : signed integer
19567 Returns a signed integer.
19568
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019569ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
19570 Returns an ipv4.
19571
19572ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
19573 Returns an ipv6.
19574
Tim Duesterhus46419372022-05-27 23:20:36 +020019575last_rule_file : string
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010019576 This returns the name of the configuration file containing the last final
19577 rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one that
19578 terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
19579 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
19580 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
19581 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
19582 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
19583 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
19584 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
19585 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
19586 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
19587 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_line".
19588
Tim Duesterhus46419372022-05-27 23:20:36 +020019589last_rule_line : integer
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010019590 This returns the line number in the configuration file where is located the
19591 last final rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one
19592 that terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
19593 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
19594 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
19595 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
19596 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
19597 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
19598 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
19599 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
19600 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
19601 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_file".
19602
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019603lat_ns_avg : integer
19604 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
19605 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
19606 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
19607 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
19608 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
19609 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
19610 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
19611 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
19612 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020019613 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
19614 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
19615 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
19616 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
19617 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
19618 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019619
19620lat_ns_tot : integer
19621 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
19622 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
19623 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
19624 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
19625 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
19626 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
19627 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
19628 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
19629 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020019630 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
19631 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
19632 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
19633 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
19634 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019635 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
19636 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
19637 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
19638 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
19639 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
19640 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
19641
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019642meth(<method>) : method
19643 Returns a method.
19644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019645nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
19646 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
19647 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
19648 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019649 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
19650 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
19651 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010019652
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040019653prio_class : integer
19654 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
19655 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
19656 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
19657
19658prio_offset : integer
19659 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
19660 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
19661 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
19662 set-priority-offset".
19663
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019664proc : integer
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +020019665 Always returns value 1 (historically it would return the calling process
19666 number).
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019668queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019669 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
19670 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
19671 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019672 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
19673 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
19674 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
19675 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
19676 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
19677
Frédéric Lécaille33d11c42023-01-12 17:55:45 +010019678quic_enabled : boolean
Frédéric Lécaille33d11c42023-01-12 17:55:45 +010019679 Return true when the support for QUIC transport protocol was compiled and
19680 if this procotol was not disabled by "no-quic" global option. See also "no-quic"
19681 global option.
19682
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010019683rand([<range>]) : integer
19684 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
19685 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
19686 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
19687 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
19688 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
19689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019690srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19691 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
19692 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
19693 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
19694 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
19695 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040019696 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
19697 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
19698
19699srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19700 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
19701 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
19702 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
19703 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
19704 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
19705 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
19706 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
19707
19708 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
19709 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019710
19711srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
19712 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
19713 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
19714 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019715 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019716 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
19717 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
19718 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
19719
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020019720srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19721 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
19722 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
19723 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
19724 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
19725 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
19726 fetch methods.
19727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019728srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19729 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
19730 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019731 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019732 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
19733 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019734 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019735 overloading servers).
19736
19737 Example :
19738 # Redirect to a separate back
19739 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
19740 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
19741 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
19742
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019743srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019744 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
19745 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
19746 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
19747
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019748srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019749 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
19750 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
19751 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
19752
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019753srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019754 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
19755 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
19756 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
19757
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019758stopping : boolean
19759 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
19760 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
19761 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
19762
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019763str(<string>) : string
19764 Returns a string.
19765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019766table_avl([<table>]) : integer
19767 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
19768 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
19769
19770table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19771 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
19772 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
19773 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
19774
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010019775thread : integer
19776 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
19777 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
19778 and debugging purposes.
19779
Alexandar Lazic528adc32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020019780uuid([<version>]) : string
19781 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
19782 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
19783 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
19784
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020019785var(<var-name>[,<default>]) : undefined
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019786 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020019787 sample fetch fails, unless a default value is provided, in which case it will
19788 return it as a string. Empty strings are permitted. The name of the variable
19789 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010019790 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019791 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
19792 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019793 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019794 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
19795 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019796 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010019797 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019798
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200197997.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019800----------------------------------
19801
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019802The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019803closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
19804methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
19805sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
19806TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019807the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
19808counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020019809"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +010019810used if the global "tune.stick-counters" value does not exceed 3, otherwise the
19811counter number can be specified as the first integer argument when using the
19812"sc_" prefix starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (tune.stick-counters-1).
19813An optional table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the
19814currently tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of
19815the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019816
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019817bc_dst : ip
19818 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
19819 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
19820 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
19821 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
19822
19823bc_dst_port : integer
19824 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019825 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019826
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010019827bc_err : integer
19828 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current backend
19829 connection. See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes
19830 and their corresponding error message.
19831
19832bc_err_str : string
19833 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
19834 backend connection, resulting in a connection failure. See the
19835 "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes and their
19836 corresponding error message.
19837
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010019838bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010019839 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
19840 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
19841 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
19842
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019843bc_src : ip
19844 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019845 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019846 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
19847 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
19848
19849bc_src_port : integer
19850 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019851 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019853be_id : integer
19854 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019855 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
19856 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019857
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010019858be_name : string
19859 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019860 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
19861 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010019862
Aleksandar Lazic5529c992023-04-28 11:39:12 +020019863bc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
19864 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the backend
19865 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
19866 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
19867 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
19868 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
19869 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19870
19871bc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
19872 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
19873 backend connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
19874 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
19875 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
19876 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
19877 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19878
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010019879be_server_timeout : integer
19880 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
19881 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
19882 also the "cur_server_timeout".
19883
19884be_tunnel_timeout : integer
19885 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
19886 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
19887 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
19888
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010019889cur_server_timeout : integer
19890 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
19891 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
19892 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
19893
19894cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
19895 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
19896 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
19897 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
19898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019899dst : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019900 This is the destination IP address of the connection on the client side,
19901 which is the address the client connected to. Any tcp/http rules may alter
19902 this address. It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
19903 type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address
19904 is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. When the incoming
19905 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
19906 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
19907 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
19908 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
19909 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
19910 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019911
19912dst_conn : integer
19913 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
19914 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
19915 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
19916 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
19917 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
19918 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
19919 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
19920 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019921
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020019922dst_is_local : boolean
19923 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
19924 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
19925 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
19926 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019927 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020019928 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
19929 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
19930 it only once per connection.
19931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019932dst_port : integer
19933 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
19934 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019935 Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. This might be used when running in
19936 transparent mode, when assigning dynamic ports to some clients for a whole
19937 application session, to stick all users to a same server, or to pass the
19938 destination port information to a server using an HTTP header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019939
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010019940fc_dst : ip
19941 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
19942 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "dst"
19943 for details.
19944
19945fc_dst_is_local : boolean
19946 Returns true if the original destination address of the incoming connection
19947 is local to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the
19948 system. See "dst_is_local" for details.
19949
19950fc_dst_port : integer
19951 Returns an integer value corresponding to the original destination TCP port
19952 of the connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may
19953 alter this address. See "dst-port" for details.
19954
19955fc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019956 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current
19957 connection. Any strictly positive value of this fetch indicates that the
19958 connection did not succeed and would result in an error log being output (as
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010019959 described in section 8.2.6). See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019960 error codes and their corresponding error message.
19961
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010019962fc_err_str : string
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050019963 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019964 connection, resulting in a connection failure. This string corresponds to the
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010019965 "message" part of the error log format (see section 8.2.6). See below for a
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019966 full list of error codes and their corresponding error messages :
19967
19968 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
19969 | ID | message |
19970 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
19971 | 0 | "Success" |
19972 | 1 | "Reached configured maxconn value" |
19973 | 2 | "Too many sockets on the process" |
19974 | 3 | "Too many sockets on the system" |
19975 | 4 | "Out of system buffers" |
19976 | 5 | "Protocol or address family not supported" |
19977 | 6 | "General socket error" |
19978 | 7 | "Source port range exhausted" |
19979 | 8 | "Can't bind to source address" |
19980 | 9 | "Out of local source ports on the system" |
19981 | 10 | "Local source address already in use" |
19982 | 11 | "Connection closed while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
19983 | 12 | "Connection error while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
19984 | 13 | "Timeout while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
19985 | 14 | "Truncated PROXY protocol header received" |
19986 | 15 | "Received something which does not look like a PROXY protocol header" |
19987 | 16 | "Received an invalid PROXY protocol header" |
19988 | 17 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the PROXY protocol header" |
19989 | 18 | "Connection closed while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
19990 | 19 | "Connection error while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
19991 | 20 | "Timeout while waiting for a NetScaler Client IP header" |
19992 | 21 | "Truncated NetScaler Client IP header received" |
19993 | 22 | "Received an invalid NetScaler Client IP magic number" |
19994 | 23 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the NetScaler Client IP header" |
19995 | 24 | "Connection closed during SSL handshake" |
19996 | 25 | "Connection error during SSL handshake" |
19997 | 26 | "Timeout during SSL handshake" |
19998 | 27 | "Too many SSL connections" |
19999 | 28 | "Out of memory when initializing an SSL connection" |
20000 | 29 | "Rejected a client-initiated SSL renegotiation attempt" |
20001 | 30 | "SSL client CA chain cannot be verified" |
20002 | 31 | "SSL client certificate not trusted" |
20003 | 32 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the configured one" |
20004 | 33 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the expected one" |
20005 | 34 | "SSL handshake failure" |
20006 | 35 | "SSL handshake failure after heartbeat" |
20007 | 36 | "Stopped a TLSv1 heartbeat attack (CVE-2014-0160)" |
20008 | 37 | "Attempt to use SSL on an unknown target (internal error)" |
20009 | 38 | "Server refused early data" |
20010 | 39 | "SOCKS4 Proxy write error during handshake" |
20011 | 40 | "SOCKS4 Proxy read error during handshake" |
20012 | 41 | "SOCKS4 Proxy deny the request" |
20013 | 42 | "SOCKS4 Proxy handshake aborted by server" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton61944f72021-09-29 18:56:51 +020020014 | 43 | "SSL fatal error" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020020015 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
20016
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020020017fc_fackets : integer
20018 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
20019 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
20020 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
20021 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20022
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020020023fc_http_major : integer
20024 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
20025 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
20026 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
20027
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020020028fc_lost : integer
20029 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
20030 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
20031 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
20032 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20033
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020020034fc_pp_authority : string
20035 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
20036 if any.
20037
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010020038fc_pp_unique_id : string
20039 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
20040 if any.
20041
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010020042fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
20043 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
20044 header.
20045
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020020046fc_reordering : integer
20047 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
20048 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
20049 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
20050 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20051
20052fc_retrans : integer
20053 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
20054 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
20055 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
20056 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20057
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020020058fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
20059 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
20060 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
20061 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
20062 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
20063 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
20064 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20065
20066fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
20067 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
20068 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
20069 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
20070 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
20071 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
20072 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20073
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020020074fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070020075 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
20076 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
20077 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
20078 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20079
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020080fc_src : ip
Christopher Faulet18b63f42023-07-17 07:56:55 +020020081 This is the original source IP address of the connection on the client side
20082 Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "src" for
20083 details.
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020084
20085fc_src_is_local : boolean
20086 Returns true if the source address of incoming connection is local to the
20087 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system. See
20088 "src_is_local" for details.
20089
20090fc_src_port : integer
20091
20092 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
20093 connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter
20094 this address. See "src-port" for details.
20095
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070020096
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020020097fc_unacked : integer
20098 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
20099 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
20100 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
20101 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070020102
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020020103fe_defbe : string
20104 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
20105 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
20106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020107fe_id : integer
20108 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010020109 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020110 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
20111
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010020112fe_name : string
20113 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
20114 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
20115 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
20116
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010020117fe_client_timeout : integer
20118 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
20119 current frontend.
20120
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020121sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020122sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
20123sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
20124sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020125 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
20126 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
20127 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
20128
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020129sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020130sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
20131sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
20132sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020133 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
20134 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
20135 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
20136
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020137sc_clr_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20138 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
20139 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
20140 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
20141 returns its previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
20142 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
20143 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
20144 will always return zero.
20145 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20146 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20147
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020148sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020149sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20150sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20151sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020152 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
20153 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010020154 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
20155 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
20156 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020157
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020158 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020159 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
20160 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020161 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
20162 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
20163 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020164 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
20165 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
20166
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020167sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20168sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20169sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20170sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20171 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
20172 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
20173 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
20174 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
20175 when a first ACL was verified.
20176
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020177sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020178sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20179sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20180sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020181 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020182 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
20183
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020184sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020185sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
20186sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
20187sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020188 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
20189 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
20190 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
20191
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020192sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020193sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
20194sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
20195sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020196 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
20197 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
20198 See also src_conn_rate.
20199
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020200sc_get_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20201 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
20202 in the GPC array and associated to the currently tracked counter of
20203 ID <ctr> from the current proxy's stick-table or from the designated
20204 stick-table <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
20205 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2. If there is not gpc stored at this
20206 index, zero is returned.
20207 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20208 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types). See also src_get_gpc and sc_inc_gpc.
20209
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020210sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020211sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20212sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20213sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020214 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020215 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020216
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020217sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20218sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20219sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20220sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20221 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
20222 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
20223
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020020224sc_get_gpt(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20225 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
20226 the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> and from the
20227 current proxy's sitck-table or the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
20228 is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
20229 If there is no GPT stored at this index, zero is returned.
20230 This fetch applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on
20231 the legacy 'gpt0' data-type). See also src_get_gpt.
20232
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020020233sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20234sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
20235sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
20236sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
20237 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
20238 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
20239
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020240sc_gpc_rate(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20241 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
20242 index <idx> of the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> from
20243 the current proxy's table or from the designated stick-table <table>.
20244 It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was incremented over the
20245 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer
20246 between 0 and 2.
20247 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter array must be stored in the stick-table
20248 for a value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
20249 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
20250 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
20251 See also src_gpc_rate, sc_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
20252
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020253sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020254sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
20255sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
20256sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020257 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
20258 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
20259 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020260 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
20261 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
20262 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020263
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020264sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20265sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
20266sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
20267sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
20268 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
20269 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
20270 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
20271 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
20272 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
20273 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
20274
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020275sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020276sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20277sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20278sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020279 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020280 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
20281 See also src_http_err_cnt.
20282
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020283sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020284sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
20285sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
20286sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020287 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
20288 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
20289 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
20290 src_http_err_rate.
20291
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010020292sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20293sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20294sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20295sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20296 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
20297 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
20298 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
20299
20300sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20301sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
20302sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
20303sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
20304 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
20305 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
20306 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
20307 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
20308
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020309sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020310sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20311sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20312sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020313 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020314 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
20315 src_http_req_cnt.
20316
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020317sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020318sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
20319sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
20320sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020321 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
20322 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
20323 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
20324 src_http_req_rate.
20325
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020326sc_inc_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20327 Increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
20328 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
20329 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
20330 returns its new value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
20331 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
20332 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
20333 will increase it to 1 and will return 1.
20334 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20335 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20336
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020337sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020338sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20339sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20340sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020341 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010020342 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
20343 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
20344 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
20345 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020346
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020347 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020348 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
20349 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020350 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
20351
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020352sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20353sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20354sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20355sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20356 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
20357 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
20358 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
20359 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
20360 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
20361
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020362sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020363sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
20364sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
20365sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020366 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
20367 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
20368 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020369
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020370sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020371sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
20372sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
20373sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020374 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
20375 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
20376 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020377
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020378sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020379sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20380sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20381sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020382 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020383 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
20384 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
20385 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020386 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020387 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
20388
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020389sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020390sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
20391sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
20392sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020393 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
20394 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
20395 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
20396 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
20397 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020398 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020399
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020400sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020401sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
20402sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
20403sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020020404 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
20405 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
20406 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
20407
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020408sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020409sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
20410sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
20411sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010020412 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
20413 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020414 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010020415 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
20416 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020417 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
20418 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
20419 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010020420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020421so_id : integer
20422 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
20423 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
20424 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020425
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010020426so_name : string
20427 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
20428 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
20429 strings instead of integers.
20430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020431src : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020432 This is the source IP address of the client of the session. Any tcp/http
20433 rules may alter this address. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and
20434 IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
20435 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the TCP-level source
20436 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a
20437 proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind directive
20438 is used, it can be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol
20439 compatible component for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which
20440 sees the real address. When the incoming connection passed through address
20441 translation or redirection involving connection tracking, the original
20442 destination address before the redirection will be reported. On Linux
20443 systems, the source and destination may seldom appear reversed if the
20444 nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late response may reopen a
20445 timed out connection and switch what is believed to be the source and the
20446 destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020447
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010020448 Example:
20449 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
20450 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
20451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020452src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
20453 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
20454 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
20455 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020456 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020458src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
20459 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
20460 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020461 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020462 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020463
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020464src_clr_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
20465 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
20466 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20467 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its
20468 previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20469 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 0 is returned.
20470 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20471 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20472 See also sc_clr_gpc.
20473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020474src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20475 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20476 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20477 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
20478 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
20479 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
20480 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020481
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020482 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020483 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
20484 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
20485 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
20486 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010020487 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020488 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
20489 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
20490
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020491src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20492 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20493 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20494 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
20495 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
20496 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
20497 was verified.
20498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020499src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020500 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020501 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020502 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020503 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020505src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020506 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020507 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20508 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020509 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020511src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
20512 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
20513 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20514 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020515 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020516
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020517src_get_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
20518 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
20519 array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
20520 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
20521 is an integer between 0 and 99.
20522 If the address is not found or there is no gpc stored at this index, zero
20523 is returned.
20524 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not on the legacy
20525 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20526 See also sc_get_gpc and src_inc_gpc.
20527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020528src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020529 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020530 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020531 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020532 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020533
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020534src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20535 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
20536 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
20537 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
20538 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
20539
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020020540src_get_gpt(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
20541 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
20542 the array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
20543 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>.
20544 <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20545 If the address is not found or the GPT is not stored, zero is returned.
20546 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
20547
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020020548src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
20549 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
20550 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
20551 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
20552 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
20553
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020554src_gpc_rate(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
20555 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
20556 index <idx> of the array associated to the incoming connection's
20557 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
20558 stick-table <table>. It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was
20559 incremented over the configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20560 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter must be stored in the stick-table for a
20561 value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
20562 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
20563 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
20564 See also sc_gpc_rate, src_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
20565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020566src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020567 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020568 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020569 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
20570 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020571 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
20572 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
20573 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020574
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020575src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
20576 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
20577 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20578 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
20579 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
20580 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
20581 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
20582 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
20583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020584src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020585 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020586 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020587 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020588 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020589 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020591src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
20592 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
20593 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20594 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
20595 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020596 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020597
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010020598src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20599 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
20600 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050020601 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010020602 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
20603 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
20604
20605src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
20606 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
20607 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20608 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
20609 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
20610 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
20611 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
20612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020613src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020614 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020615 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
20616 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020617 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020619src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
20620 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
20621 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
20622 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020623 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020624 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020625
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020626src_inc_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
20627 Increments the General Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array
20628 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20629 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its new
20630 value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20631 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 1 is returned.
20632 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20633 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20634 See also sc_inc_gpc.
20635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020636src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20637 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20638 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20639 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020640 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020641 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
20642 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020643
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020644 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020645 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010020646 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020647 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020648
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020649src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20650 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20651 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20652 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
20653 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
20654 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
20655 connection when a first ACL was verified.
20656
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020020657src_is_local : boolean
20658 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
20659 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
20660 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
20661 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020662 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020020663 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
20664 once per connection.
20665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020666src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020667 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
20668 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
20669 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
20670 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
20671 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020673src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020674 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
20675 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20676 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
20677 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
20678 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020680src_port : integer
20681 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020682 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected
20683 from. Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. Usage of this function is
20684 very limited as modern protocols do not care much about source ports
20685 nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010020686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020687src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020688 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020689 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20690 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
20691 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020692 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020694src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
20695 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
20696 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20697 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
20698 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020699 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020701src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20702 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
20703 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
20704 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
20705 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
20706 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
20707 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
20708 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
20709 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020710
20711 Example :
20712 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
20713 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
20714 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
20715 listen ssh
20716 bind :22
20717 mode tcp
20718 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020719 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020720 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020721 server local 127.0.0.1:22
20722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020723srv_id : integer
20724 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
20725 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020020726 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020020727
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080020728srv_name : string
20729 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
20730 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020020731 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080020732
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200207337.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020734----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020020735
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020736The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020737closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
20738when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
20739usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020740future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020020741
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00002074251d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
20743 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
20744 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
20745 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
20746 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
20747 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
20748
20749 Example :
20750 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
20751 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
20752 # the request.
20753 frontend http-in
20754 bind *:8081
20755 default_backend servers
20756 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
20757 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
20758
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020759ssl_bc : boolean
20760 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
20761 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Mariam John6ff043d2023-05-22 13:11:13 -050020762 to a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020763 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020764
20765ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
20766 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020767 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
20768 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020769
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020770ssl_bc_alpn : string
20771 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
20772 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020020773 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020774 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
20775 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
20776 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
20777 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
20778 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020779 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
20780 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020781
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020782ssl_bc_cipher : string
20783 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020784 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
20785 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020786
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020787ssl_bc_client_random : binary
20788 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
20789 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20790 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020791 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020792
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020793ssl_bc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020794 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020795 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
20796 backend side. It can raise handshake errors as well as other read or write
20797 errors occurring during the connection's lifetime. In order to get a text
20798 description of this error code, you can either use the "ssl_bc_err_str"
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020799 sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which takes an error code
20800 in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer to your SSL
20801 library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error codes.
20802
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020803ssl_bc_err_str : string
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020804 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020805 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
20806 that was raised on the connection from the backend's perspective. See also
20807 "ssl_fc_err".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020808
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010020809ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
20810 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20811 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020812 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
20813 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010020814
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020815ssl_bc_npn : string
20816 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
20817 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020020818 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020819 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
20820 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
20821 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
20822 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020823 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
20824 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020825
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020826ssl_bc_protocol : string
20827 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020828 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
20829 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020830
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020831ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020832 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020833 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020834 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
20835 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020836
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020837ssl_bc_server_random : binary
20838 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
20839 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20840 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020841 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020842
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020843ssl_bc_session_id : binary
20844 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
20845 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020846 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
20847 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020848
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040020849ssl_bc_session_key : binary
20850 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
20851 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
20852 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020853 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040020854
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020855ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
20856 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020857 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
20858 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020860ssl_c_ca_err : integer
20861 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20862 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
20863 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
20864 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
20865 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020020866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020867ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
20868 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20869 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
20870 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
20871 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020872
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010020873ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020874 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
20875 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20876 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050020877 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020878 does not support resumed sessions.
20879
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010020880ssl_c_der : binary
20881 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
20882 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20883 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020885ssl_c_err : integer
20886 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20887 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
20888 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
20889 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
20890 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020891
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020892ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020893 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20894 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
20895 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20896 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20897 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20898 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20899 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20900 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020901 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20902 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20903 LDAP v3.
20904 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20905 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020907ssl_c_key_alg : string
20908 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
20909 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20910 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020912ssl_c_notafter : string
20913 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
20914 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20915 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020020916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020917ssl_c_notbefore : string
20918 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
20919 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20920 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010020921
Abhijeet Rastogidf97f472023-05-13 20:04:45 -070020922ssl_c_r_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
20923 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and is
20924 successfully validated with the configured ca-file, returns the full
20925 distinguished name of the root CA of the certificate presented by the client
20926 when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the first given entry found from
20927 the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative occurrence number is specified
20928 as the optional second argument, it returns the value of the nth given entry
20929 value from the beginning/end of the DN. For instance, "ssl_c_r_dn(OU,2)" the
20930 second organization unit, and "ssl_c_r_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name. The
20931 <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for consumption by
20932 different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for LDAP v3. If you'd like
20933 to modify the format only you can specify an empty string and zero for the
20934 first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_r_dn(,0,rfc2253)
20935
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020936ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020937 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20938 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
20939 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20940 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20941 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20942 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20943 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20944 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020945 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20946 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20947 LDAP v3.
20948 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20949 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010020950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020951ssl_c_serial : binary
20952 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
20953 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20954 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020956ssl_c_sha1 : binary
20957 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
20958 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
20959 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020020960 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
20961 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
20962
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020963 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020020964 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020966ssl_c_sig_alg : string
20967 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
20968 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20969 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020971ssl_c_used : boolean
20972 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
20973 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020020974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020975ssl_c_verify : integer
20976 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
20977 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
20978 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
20979 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020020980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020981ssl_c_version : integer
20982 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
20983 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020020984
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010020985ssl_f_der : binary
20986 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
20987 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20988 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20989
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020990ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020991 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20992 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
20993 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20994 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020995 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020996 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20997 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20998 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020999 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
21000 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
21001 LDAP v3.
21002 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
21003 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020021004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021005ssl_f_key_alg : string
21006 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
21007 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
21008 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020021009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021010ssl_f_notafter : string
21011 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
21012 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21013 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020021014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021015ssl_f_notbefore : string
21016 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
21017 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21018 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020021019
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050021020ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021021 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21022 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
21023 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
21024 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
21025 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
21026 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
21027 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
21028 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050021029 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
21030 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
21031 LDAP v3.
21032 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
21033 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020021034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021035ssl_f_serial : binary
21036 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
21037 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21038 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020021039
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020021040ssl_f_sha1 : binary
21041 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
21042 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
21043 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
21044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021045ssl_f_sig_alg : string
21046 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
21047 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
21048 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020021049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021050ssl_f_version : integer
21051 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
21052 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
21053
21054ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020021055 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
21056 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
21057 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
21058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021059 Example :
21060 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
21061 listen http-https
21062 bind :80
21063 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
21064 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
21065
21066ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
21067 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
21068 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
21069
21070ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021071 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021072 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021073 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021074 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
21075 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
21076 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
21077 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
21078 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
21079 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
21080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021081ssl_fc_cipher : string
21082 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
21083 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020021084
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021085ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
21086 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
21087 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021088 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021089 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
21090 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
21091 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021092
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021093 Example:
21094 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
21095 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21096 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21097 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21098 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
21099 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
21100 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
21101 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
21102 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
21103
21104ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021105 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021106 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021107 capture buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
21108 Setting <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021109 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
21110 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021111
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021112ssl_fc_cipherlist_str([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021113 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021114 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021115 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021116 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
21117 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
21118 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
21119 Note that this sample-fetch is only available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the
21120 function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash like
21121 "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021122
21123ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021124 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can return only if the value
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021125 "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash take
21126 into account all the data of the cipher list.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021127
21128ssl_fc_ecformats_bin : binary
21129 Return the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curve point
21130 formats. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021131 buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021132
21133 Example:
21134 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
21135 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21136 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21137 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21138 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
21139 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
21140 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
21141 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
21142 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
21143
21144ssl_fc_eclist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
21145 Returns the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curves. The
21146 maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021147 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021148 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
21149 0 : return the full list of supported elliptic curves (default)
21150 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
21151
21152 Example:
21153 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
21154 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21155 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21156 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21157 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
21158 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
21159 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
21160 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
21161 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
21162
21163ssl_fc_extlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
21164 Returns the binary form of the client hello extension list. The maximum
21165 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021166 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021167 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
21168 0 : return the full list of extensions (default)
21169 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
21170
21171 Example:
21172 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
21173 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21174 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21175 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21176 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
21177 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
21178 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
21179 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
21180 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021181
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040021182ssl_fc_client_random : binary
21183 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
21184 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
21185 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
21186
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020021187ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
21188 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
21189 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
21190 transport layer.
21191 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21192 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21193 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21194 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21195
21196ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
21197 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
21198 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
21199 transport layer.
21200 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21201 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21202 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21203 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21204
21205ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
21206 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
21207 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
21208 transport layer.
21209 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21210 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21211 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21212 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21213
21214ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
21215 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
21216 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
21217 transport layer.
21218 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21219 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21220 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21221 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21222
21223ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
21224 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
21225 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
21226 transport layer.
21227 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21228 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21229 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21230 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21231
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020021232ssl_fc_err : integer
21233 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21234 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
21235 frontend side, or 0 if no error was encountered. It can be used to identify
21236 handshake related errors other than verify ones (such as cipher mismatch), as
21237 well as other read or write errors occurring during the connection's
21238 lifetime. Any error happening during the client's certificate verification
21239 process will not be raised through this fetch but via the existing
21240 "ssl_c_err", "ssl_c_ca_err" and "ssl_c_ca_err_depth" fetches. In order to get
21241 a text description of this error code, you can either use the
21242 "ssl_fc_err_str" sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which
21243 takes an error code in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer
21244 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
21245 codes.
21246
21247ssl_fc_err_str : string
21248 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21249 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
21250 that was raised on the frontend side. Any error happening during the client's
21251 certificate verification process will not be raised through this fetch. See
21252 also "ssl_fc_err".
21253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021254ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020021255 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
21256 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010021257 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
21258 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
21259 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
21260 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020021261
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020021262ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
21263 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
21264 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
21265 wait until the handshake happened.
21266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021267ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
21268 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020021269 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
21270 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021271 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020021272 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020021273
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020021274ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020021275 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010021276 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
21277 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020021278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021279ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021280 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021281 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021282 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
21283 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
21284 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
21285 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
21286 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
21287 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020021288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021289ssl_fc_protocol : string
21290 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
21291 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020021292
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021293ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id : integer
21294 The version of the TLS protocol by which the client wishes to communicate
21295 during the session as indicated in client hello message. This value can
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021296 return only if the value "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than
21297 0.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021298
21299 Example:
21300 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
21301 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21302 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21303 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21304 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
21305 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
21306 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
21307 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
21308 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
21309
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020021310ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040021311 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020021312 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Faulet15ae22c2021-11-09 14:23:36 +010021313 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040021314
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020021315ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
21316 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
21317 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
21318 transport layer.
21319 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21320 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21321 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21322 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21323
21324ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
21325 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
21326 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
21327 transport layer.
21328 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21329 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21330 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21331 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21332
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040021333ssl_fc_server_random : binary
21334 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
21335 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
21336 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
21337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021338ssl_fc_session_id : binary
21339 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
21340 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
21341 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
21342 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020021343
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040021344ssl_fc_session_key : binary
21345 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
21346 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
21347 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
21348 BoringSSL.
21349
21350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021351ssl_fc_sni : string
21352 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
21353 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021354 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021355 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
21356 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
21357
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020021358 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021359 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021360 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021361 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020021362 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020021363
Willy Tarreaud26fb572022-11-25 10:12:12 +010021364 CAUTION! Except under very specific conditions, it is normally not correct to
21365 use this field as a substitute for the HTTP "Host" header field. For example,
21366 when forwarding an HTTPS connection to a server, the SNI field must be set
21367 from the HTTP Host header field using "req.hdr(host)" and not from the front
21368 SNI value. The reason is that SNI is solely used to select the certificate
21369 the server side will present, and that clients are then allowed to send
21370 requests with different Host values as long as they match the names in the
21371 certificate. As such, "ssl_fc_sni" should normally not be used as an argument
21372 to the "sni" server keyword, unless the backend works in TCP mode.
21373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021374 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021375 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
21376 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020021377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021378ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
21379 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
21380 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020021381
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020021382ssl_s_der : binary
21383 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
21384 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21385 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
21386
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020021387ssl_s_chain_der : binary
21388 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
21389 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21390 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050021391 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020021392 does not support resumed sessions.
21393
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020021394ssl_s_key_alg : string
21395 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
21396 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
21397 SSL/TLS transport layer.
21398
21399ssl_s_notafter : string
21400 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
21401 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21402 transport layer.
21403
21404ssl_s_notbefore : string
21405 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
21406 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21407 transport layer.
21408
21409ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
21410 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21411 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
21412 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
21413 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
21414 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
21415 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020021416 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
21417 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020021418 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
21419 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
21420 LDAP v3.
21421 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
21422 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
21423
21424ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
21425 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21426 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
21427 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
21428 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
21429 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
21430 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020021431 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
21432 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020021433 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
21434 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
21435 LDAP v3.
21436 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
21437 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
21438
21439ssl_s_serial : binary
21440 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
21441 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21442 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
21443
21444ssl_s_sha1 : binary
21445 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
21446 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
21447 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
21448
21449ssl_s_sig_alg : string
21450 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
21451 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
21452 layer.
21453
21454ssl_s_version : integer
21455 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
21456 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020021457
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200214587.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021459------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020021460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021461Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
21462sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
21463only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
21464For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
21465be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
21466can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
21467sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
21468for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
21469content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020021470
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010021471Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
21472 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021473 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010021474 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
21475 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
21476 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
21477 sample expression). So be careful.
21478
Willy Tarreau3ec14612022-03-10 10:39:58 +010021479distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
21480 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
21481 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
21482 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
21483 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
21484 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
21485 list of supported tokens.
21486
21487distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
21488 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
21489 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
21490 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
21491 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
21492 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
21493 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
21494 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
21495 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
21496 supported tokens.
21497
21498 Example :
21499 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
21500 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
21501 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
21502 # send large files to the big farm
21503 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
21504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021505payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021506 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021507 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
21508 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021510payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
21511 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021512 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021513 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021515req.len : integer
21516req_len : integer (deprecated)
21517 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
21518 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
21519 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
21520 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
21521 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021522 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021523 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
21524 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021526req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
21527 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020021528 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
21529 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
21530 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
21531 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021532
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021533 ACL derivatives :
21534 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021536req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
21537 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
21538 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
21539 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
21540 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021541
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021542 ACL derivatives :
21543 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021545 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021547req.proto_http : boolean
21548req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
21549 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
21550 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
21551 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
21552 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
21553 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
21554 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
21555 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021557 Example:
21558 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
21559 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
21560 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020021561 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021563req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
21564rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21565 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
21566 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
21567 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
21568 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
21569 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
21570 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
21571 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021573 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
21574 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
21575 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
21576 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
21577 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
21578 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021580 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021581 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021583 Example :
21584 listen tse-farm
21585 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
21586 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
21587 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
21588 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
21589 # apply RDP cookie persistence
21590 persist rdp-cookie
21591 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
21592 # This is only useful makes sense if
21593 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
21594 stick-table type string size 204800
21595 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
21596 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
21597 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021599 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021600 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021602req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
21603rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
21604 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
21605 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
21606 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
21607 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021609 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021610 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021611
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110021612req.ssl_alpn : string
21613 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
21614 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
21615 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
21616 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
21617 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
21618 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020021619 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110021620
21621 Examples :
21622 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
21623 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021624 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020021625 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110021626 default_backend bk_default
21627
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020021628req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
21629 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
21630 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020021631 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
21632 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
21633 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
21634 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
21635 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020021636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021637req.ssl_hello_type : integer
21638req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
21639 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
21640 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
21641 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
21642 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
21643 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
21644 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
21645 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021647req.ssl_sni : string
21648req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
21649 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
21650 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
21651 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
21652 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
21653 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020021654 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
21655 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
21656 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
21657 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
21658 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
21659 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
21660 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
21661 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
21662 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021664 ACL derivatives :
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020021665 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021667 Examples :
21668 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
21669 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021670 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020021671 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021672 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021673
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053021674req.ssl_st_ext : integer
21675 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
21676 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
21677 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
21678 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
21679 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
21680 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
21681 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
21682 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
21683 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
21684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021685req.ssl_ver : integer
21686req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
21687 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
21688 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
21689 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
21690 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
21691 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
21692 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
21693 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021694 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021695 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021697 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021698 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021699
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021700res.len : integer
21701 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
21702 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
21703 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
21704 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
21705 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021706 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021707 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021708 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021710res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
21711 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020021712 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021713 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020021714 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021715 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021717res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
21718 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
21719 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
21720 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021721 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
21722 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021724 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021725
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020021726res.ssl_hello_type : integer
21727rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
21728 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
21729 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
21730 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
21731 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
21732 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
21733 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
21734 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
21735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021736wait_end : boolean
21737 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
21738 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021739 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021740 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
21741 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021742 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021743 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
21744 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021746 Examples :
21747 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
21748 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
21749 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021751 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
21752 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
21753 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
21754 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
21755 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
21756 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
21757 tcp-request content reject
21758
21759
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200217607.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021761--------------------------------------
21762
21763It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
21764This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
21765data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
21766its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
21767HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
21768content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
21769to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
21770more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
21771response are indexed.
21772
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010021773Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
21774 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
21775 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
21776 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
21777 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
21778 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
21779 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
21780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021781base : string
21782 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
21783 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
21784 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
21785 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
21786 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
21787 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
21788 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
21789 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
21790
21791 ACL derivatives :
21792 base : exact string match
21793 base_beg : prefix match
21794 base_dir : subdir match
21795 base_dom : domain match
21796 base_end : suffix match
21797 base_len : length match
21798 base_reg : regex match
21799 base_sub : substring match
21800
21801base32 : integer
21802 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
21803 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
21804 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020021805 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
21806 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
21807 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021808
21809base32+src : binary
21810 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
21811 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
21812 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
21813 per-URL counters.
21814
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010021815baseq : string
21816 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
21817 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
21818 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
21819 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
21820
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010021821capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
21822 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
21823 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
21824 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
21825
21826capture.req.method : string
21827 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
21828 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
21829 because it's allocated.
21830
21831capture.req.uri : string
21832 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
21833 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
21834 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
21835 allocated.
21836
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020021837capture.req.ver : string
21838 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
21839 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
21840 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
21841
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010021842capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
21843 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
21844 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
21845 The first entry is an index of 0.
21846 See also: "capture response header"
21847
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020021848capture.res.ver : string
21849 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
21850 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
21851 persistent flag.
21852
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021853req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020021854 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
21855 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
21856 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021857
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040021858req.body_param([<name>[,i]]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020021859 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
21860 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
21861 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
21862 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040021863 case-sensitive, unless "i" is added as a second argument. If no name is
21864 given, any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The
21865 result is a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as
21866 presented in the request body (no URL decoding is performed). Note that the
21867 ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will
21868 iteratively report all parameters values if no name is given.
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020021869
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021870req.body_len : integer
21871 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
21872 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020021873 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
21874 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021875
21876req.body_size : integer
21877 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020021878 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
21879 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021881req.cook([<name>]) : string
21882cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21883 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
21884 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
21885 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
21886 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
21887 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
21888 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
21889 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
21890 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
21891
21892 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021893 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
21894 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
21895 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
21896 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
21897 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
21898 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
21899 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
21900 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021902req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21903cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
21904 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
21905 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021907req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
21908cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
21909 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
21910 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
21911 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
21912 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020021913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021914cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21915 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
21916 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
21917 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
21918 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020021919 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021920 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
21921 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
21922 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
21923 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021925hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
21926 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
21927 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
21928 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
21929 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021930 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021932req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021933 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
21934 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
21935 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
21936 with headers such as User-Agent.
21937
21938 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
21939 found.
21940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021941 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
21942 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
21943 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021944 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021946req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21947 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
21948 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021949 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
21950 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021952req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021953 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
21954 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
21955 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
21956 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
21957 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
21958 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
21959 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
21960
21961 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
21962 found.
21963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021964 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
21965 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
21966 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021967 with -1 being the last one.
21968
21969 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
21970 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021972 ACL derivatives :
21973 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
21974 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
21975 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
21976 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
21977 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
21978 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
21979 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
21980 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
21981
21982req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21983hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
21984 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
21985 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021986 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
21987 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
21988 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
21989
21990 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
21991 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
21992 which contain more than one of certain headers.
21993
21994 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021995
21996req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
21997hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
21998 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
21999 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
22000 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010022001 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
22002 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
22003 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
22004 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
22005 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022006
22007 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
22008
22009 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022010
22011req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
22012hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
22013 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
22014 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
22015 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022016
22017 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
22018
22019 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022020
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010022021req.hdrs : string
22022 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
22023 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
22024 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
22025 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
22026
22027req.hdrs_bin : binary
22028 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
22029 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
22030 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
22031 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
22032 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
22033 names and values (length of 0 for both).
22034
22035 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010022036
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010022037 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
22038 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010022039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022040http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
22041 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
22042 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
22043 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
22044 basic auth is supported.
22045
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonf5dd3372021-10-01 15:36:53 +020022046http_auth_bearer([<header>]) : string
22047 Returns the client-provided token found in the authorization data when the
22048 Bearer scheme is used (to send JSON Web Tokens for instance). No check is
22049 performed on the data sent by the client.
22050 If a specific <header> is supplied, it will parse this header instead of the
22051 Authorization one.
22052
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010022053http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
22054 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
22055 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
22056 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
22057 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022058 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
22059 basic auth is supported.
22060
22061 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010022062 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
22063 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
22064 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
22065 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022066
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020022067http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010022068 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
22069 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
22070 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020022071
22072http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010022073 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
22074 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
22075 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020022076
22077http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010022078 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
22079 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
22080 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020022081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022082http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020022083 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
22084 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022085 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
22086 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020022087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022088method : integer + string
22089 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
22090 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
22091 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
22092 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
22093 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
22094 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
22095 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022097 ACL derivatives :
22098 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022100 Example :
22101 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
22102 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
22103 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022105path : string
22106 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
22107 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
22108 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
22109 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
22110 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022111 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau965fb742023-08-08 19:35:25 +020022112 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods. Please
22113 note that any fragment reference in the URI ('#' after the path) is strictly
22114 forbidden by the HTTP standard and will be rejected. However, if the frontend
22115 receiving the request has "option accept-invalid-http-request", then this
22116 fragment part will be accepted and will also appear in the path.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022118 ACL derivatives :
22119 path : exact string match
22120 path_beg : prefix match
22121 path_dir : subdir match
22122 path_dom : domain match
22123 path_end : suffix match
22124 path_len : length match
22125 path_reg : regex match
22126 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022127
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020022128pathq : string
22129 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
22130 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
22131 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
22132 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
22133 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
Willy Tarreau965fb742023-08-08 19:35:25 +020022134 result in both cases. Please note that any fragment reference in the URI ('#'
22135 after the path) is strictly forbidden by the HTTP standard and will be
22136 rejected. However, if the frontend receiving the request has "option
22137 accept-invalid-http-request", then this fragment part will be accepted and
22138 will also appear in the path.
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020022139
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010022140query : string
22141 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
22142 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
22143 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
22144 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010022145 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010022146 which stops before the question mark.
22147
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010022148req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
22149 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
22150 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
22151 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
22152 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
22153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022154req.ver : string
22155req_ver : string (deprecated)
22156 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
William Lallemandbcb3d602023-09-04 16:49:59 +020022157 be useful for ACL. For logs use the "%HV" log variable. Some predefined ACL
22158 already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
22159
22160 Common values are "1.0", "1.1", "2.0" or "3.0".
22161
22162 In the case of http/2 and http/3, the value is not extracted from the HTTP
22163 version in the request line but is determined by the negociated protocol
22164 version.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022166 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010022167 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020022168
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022169res.body : binary
22170 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
22171 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022172 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
22173
22174 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022175
22176res.body_len : integer
22177 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
22178 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022179 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
22180
22181 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022182
22183res.body_size : integer
22184 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
22185 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
22186 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
22187 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022188 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
22189
22190 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022191
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010022192res.cache_hit : boolean
22193 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
22194 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
22195
22196res.cache_name : string
22197 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
22198 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
22199 empty string.
22200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022201res.comp : boolean
22202 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
22203 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
22204 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022206res.comp_algo : string
22207 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
22208 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
22209 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022211res.cook([<name>]) : string
22212scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
22213 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
22214 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022215 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
22216
22217 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020022218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022219 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010022220 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020022221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022222res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
22223scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
22224 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
22225 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022226 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
22227
22228 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022230res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
22231scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
22232 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
22233 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022234 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
22235
22236 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022238res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022239 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
22240 on the headers within an HTTP response.
22241
22242 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
22243 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
22244
22245 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
22246
22247 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022249res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022250 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
22251 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
22252
22253 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
22254 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
22255
22256 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022258res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
22259shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022260 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
22261 on the headers within an HTTP response.
22262
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050022263 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022264 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
22265
22266 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022268 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010022269 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
22270 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
22271 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
22272 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
22273 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
22274 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
22275 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
22276 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022277
22278res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
22279shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022280 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
22281 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
22282
22283 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050022284 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022285
22286 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022288res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
22289shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022290 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
22291 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
22292
22293 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
22294
22295 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022296
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010022297res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
22298 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
22299 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
22300 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022301 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
22302
22303 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010022304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022305res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
22306shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022307 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
22308 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
22309
22310 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
22311
22312 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022313
22314res.hdrs : string
22315 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
22316 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
22317 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022318 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
22319
22320 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022321
22322res.hdrs_bin : binary
22323 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
22324 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
22325 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
22326 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
22327 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
22328 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
22329 (length of 0 for both).
22330
22331 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
22332
22333 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
22334 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010022335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022336res.ver : string
22337resp_ver : string (deprecated)
22338 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022339 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
22340
22341 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020022342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022343 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010022344 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010022345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022346set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
22347 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
22348 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020022349 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022350 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022352 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
22353 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022355status : integer
22356 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
22357 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022358 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
22359
22360 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022361
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020022362unique-id : string
22363 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
22364 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
22365 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
22366 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
22367 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
22368 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
22369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022370url : string
22371 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
22372 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
22373 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
22374 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
22375 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
22376 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
Willy Tarreau965fb742023-08-08 19:35:25 +020022377 also "path" and "base". Please note that any fragment reference in the URI
22378 ('#' after the path) is strictly forbidden by the HTTP standard and will be
22379 rejected. However, if the frontend receiving the request has "option
22380 accept-invalid-http-request", then this fragment part will be accepted and
22381 will also appear in the url.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022383 ACL derivatives :
22384 url : exact string match
22385 url_beg : prefix match
22386 url_dir : subdir match
22387 url_dom : domain match
22388 url_end : suffix match
22389 url_len : length match
22390 url_reg : regex match
22391 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022393url_ip : ip
22394 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
22395 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
22396 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
22397 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020022398 entry in a table for a given source address. It may be used in combination
22399 with 'http-request set-dst' to emulate the older 'option http_proxy'.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022401url_port : integer
22402 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020022403 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed..
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022404
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040022405urlp([<name>[,<delim>[,i]]]) : string
22406url_param([<name>[,<delim>[,i]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022407 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
22408 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040022409 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive, unless"i" is added as a
22410 third argument. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
22411 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
22412 parameter <name> as presented in the request (no URL decoding is performed).
22413 This can be used for session stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an
22414 application cookie passed as a URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks.
22415 Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and
22416 will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022418 ACL derivatives :
22419 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
22420 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
22421 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
22422 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
22423 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
22424 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
22425 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
22426 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022427
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022429 Example :
22430 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
22431 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
22432 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
22433 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022434
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040022435urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>[,i]]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022436 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
22437 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
22438 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020022439
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020022440url32 : integer
22441 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
22442 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
22443 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
22444 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
22445 is an unsigned integer.
22446
22447url32+src : binary
22448 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
22449 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
22450 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
22451
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020022452
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200224537.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022454---------------------------------------
22455
22456This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
22457used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
22458purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
22459There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
22460or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
22461any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
22462for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
22463
22464internal.htx.data : integer
22465 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
22466 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22467
22468internal.htx.free : integer
22469 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
22470 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22471
22472internal.htx.free_data : integer
22473 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
22474 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22475
22476internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010022477 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
22478 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
22479 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022480
22481internal.htx.nbblks : integer
22482 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
22483 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22484
22485internal.htx.size : integer
22486 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
22487 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22488
22489internal.htx.used : integer
22490 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
22491 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22492 direction.
22493
22494internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
22495 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
22496 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
22497 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
22498 of the special value :
22499 * head : The oldest inserted block
22500 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022501 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022502
22503internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
22504 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
22505 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
22506 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
22507 integer or one of the special value :
22508 * head : The oldest inserted block
22509 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022510 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022511
22512internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
22513 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
22514 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
22515 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22516 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22517
22518 * head : The oldest inserted block
22519 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022520 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022521
22522internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
22523 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
22524 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
22525 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22526 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22527
22528 * head : The oldest inserted block
22529 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022530 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022531
22532internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
22533 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
22534 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
22535 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22536 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22537
22538 * head : The oldest inserted block
22539 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022540 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022541
22542internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
22543 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
22544 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
22545 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22546 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22547
22548 * head : The oldest inserted block
22549 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022550 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022551
22552internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
22553 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
22554 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
22555 it returns false.
22556
22557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200225587.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022559---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010022560
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022561Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
22562every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020022563order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010022564
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022565ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020022566---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
22567FALSE always_false never match
22568HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
22569HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
22570HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010022571HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020022572HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
22573HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
22574HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
22575HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
Björn Jacke20d0f502021-10-15 16:32:15 +020022576LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 ::1 match connection from local host
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020022577METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
22578METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
22579METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
22580METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
22581METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
22582METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
22583METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
22584METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
22585RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
22586REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
22587TRUE always_true always match
22588WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
22589---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010022590
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010022591
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200225928. Logging
22593----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010022594
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022595One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
22596provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
22597very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
22598provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
22599state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010022600to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022601headers.
22602
22603In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
22604about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
22605send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
22606
22607 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
22608 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
22609 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
22610 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
22611 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022612 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060022613 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022614
22615The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
22616allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
22617as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
22618while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
22619real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
22620delay.
22621
22622
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226238.1. Log levels
22624---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022625
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090022626TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022627source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090022628HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
22629in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
22630track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
22631syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
22632about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022633
22634
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226358.2. Log formats
22636----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022637
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022638HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090022639and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
22640slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
22641options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022642
22643 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
22644 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
22645 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
22646 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
22647 extents.
22648
22649 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
22650 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
22651 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
22652 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
22653 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
22654
22655 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
22656 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
22657 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
22658 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
22659 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
22660
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020022661 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
22662 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
22663 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
22664 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
22665
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022666 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
22667
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022668Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
22669specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
22670field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
22671servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
22672always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
22673identifier.
22674
22675Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
22676 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
22677 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
22678 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
22679 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
22680
22681
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226828.2.1. Default log format
22683-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022684
22685This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
22686as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
22687format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
22688
22689 Example :
22690 listen www
22691 mode http
22692 log global
22693 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
22694
22695 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
22696 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
22697 (www/HTTP)
22698
22699 Field Format Extract from the example above
22700 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
22701 2 'Connect from' Connect from
22702 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
22703 4 'to' to
22704 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
22705 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
22706
22707Detailed fields description :
22708 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
22709 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
22710 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
22711 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
22712 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
22713 and processed the connection.
22714 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
22715
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022716In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
22717"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
22718connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
22719
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022720It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
22721will eventually disappear.
22722
22723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200227248.2.2. TCP log format
22725---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022726
22727The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
22728is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
22729information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
22730counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
22731emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
22732environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
22733the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
22734sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020022735specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022736not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
22737
22738The TCP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
22739exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022740if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT variable can be used instead.
22741Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022742
22743 # strict equivalent of "option tcplog"
22744 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
22745 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022746 # or using the HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT variable
22747 log-format "${HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022748
22749A few fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those
22750are marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022751
22752 Example :
22753 frontend fnt
22754 mode tcp
22755 option tcplog
22756 log global
22757 default_backend bck
22758
22759 backend bck
22760 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
22761
22762 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
22763 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
22764 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
22765
22766 Field Format Extract from the example above
22767 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
22768 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
22769 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
22770 4 frontend_name fnt
22771 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
22772 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
22773 7 bytes_read* 212
22774 8 termination_state --
22775 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
22776 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
22777
22778Detailed fields description :
22779 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022780 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022781 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
22782 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022783 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022784 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022785 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022786
22787 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022788 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
22789 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
22790 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022791
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022792 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022793 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
22794 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022795 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
22796 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
22797 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
22798 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022799
22800 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
22801 and processed the connection.
22802
22803 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
22804 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
22805 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
22806 applications.
22807
22808 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
22809 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
22810 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
22811 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
22812 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
22813
22814 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
22815 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
22816 See "Timers" below for more details.
22817
22818 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
22819 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
22820 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
22821 "Timers" below for more details.
22822
22823 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022824 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022825 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
22826 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
22827 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
22828 details.
22829
22830 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
22831 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
22832 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
22833 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
22834 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
22835
22836 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
22837 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
22838 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
22839 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
22840 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
22841 for more details.
22842
22843 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022844 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022845 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
22846 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
22847 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022848 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022849
22850 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
22851 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
22852 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
22853 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
22854 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
22855 caused by a denial of service attack.
22856
22857 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
22858 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
22859 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
22860 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
22861 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
22862 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
22863 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
22864 denial of service attack.
22865
22866 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
22867 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
22868 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
22869 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
22870 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
22871 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
22872 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
22873 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
22874 be processed than on other servers.
22875
22876 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
22877 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
22878 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
22879 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022880 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022881 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
22882 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
22883 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
22884 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
22885 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
22886 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
22887 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
22888 should not be attributed to the logged server.
22889
22890 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
22891 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
22892 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
22893 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
22894 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
22895 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022896 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022897 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
22898
22899 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
22900 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
22901 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
22902 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
22903 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
22904 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022905 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022906 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
22907 occurs.
22908
22909
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200229108.2.3. HTTP log format
22911----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022912
22913The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
22914is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
22915the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
22916are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
22917emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
22918generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
22919"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
22920which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020022921frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
22922is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022923
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022924The HTTP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
22925exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022926if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT variable can be used
22927instead. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022928
22929 # strict equivalent of "option httplog"
22930 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
22931 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
22932
22933And the CLF log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on
22934this exact string:
22935
22936 # strict equivalent of "option httplog clf"
22937 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
22938 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
22939 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022940 # or using the HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT variable
22941 log-format "${HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022942
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022943Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
22944slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
22945with a star ('*') after the field name below.
22946
22947 Example :
22948 frontend http-in
22949 mode http
22950 option httplog
22951 log global
22952 default_backend bck
22953
22954 backend static
22955 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
22956
22957 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
22958 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
22959 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022960 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022961
22962 Field Format Extract from the example above
22963 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
22964 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022965 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022966 4 frontend_name http-in
22967 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022968 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022969 7 status_code 200
22970 8 bytes_read* 2750
22971 9 captured_request_cookie -
22972 10 captured_response_cookie -
22973 11 termination_state ----
22974 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
22975 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
22976 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
22977 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
22978 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022979
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022980Detailed fields description :
22981 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022982 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022983 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
22984 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022985 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022986 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022987 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022988
22989 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022990 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
22991 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
22992 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022993
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022994 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022995 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022996
22997 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
22998 and processed the connection.
22999
23000 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
23001 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
23002 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
23003
23004 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
23005 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
23006 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
23007 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
23008 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
23009 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
23010
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023011 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
23012 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
23013 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050023014 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023015 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
23016 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023017 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023018 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023019
23020 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
23021 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023022 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023023
23024 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
23025 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023026 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
23027 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023028
23029 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
23030 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
23031 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
23032 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
23033 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023034 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
23035 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023036
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023037 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023038 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
23039 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
23040 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
23041 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
23042 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
23043 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023044 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023045
23046 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023047 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
23048 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023049
23050 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
23051 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050023052 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023053 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
23054 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
23055 overflowing.
23056
23057 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
23058 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
23059 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
23060 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
23061 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
23062 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
23063 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
23064 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
23065
23066 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
23067 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
23068 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
23069 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
23070 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
23071 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
23072 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
23073 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
23074
23075 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
23076 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
23077 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
23078 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
23079 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
23080 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
23081 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
23082
23083 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040023084 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023085 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
23086 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
23087 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023088 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023089 system.
23090
23091 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
23092 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
23093 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
23094 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
23095 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
23096 caused by a denial of service attack.
23097
23098 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
23099 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
23100 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
23101 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
23102 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
23103 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
23104 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
23105 denial of service attack.
23106
23107 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
23108 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
23109 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
23110 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
23111 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
23112 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
23113 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
23114 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
23115 processed than on other servers.
23116
23117 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
23118 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
23119 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
23120 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023121 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023122 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
23123 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
23124 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
23125 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
23126 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
23127 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
23128 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
23129 should not be attributed to the logged server.
23130
23131 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
23132 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
23133 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
23134 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
23135 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
23136 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023137 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023138 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
23139
23140 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
23141 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
23142 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
23143 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
23144 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
23145 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023146 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023147 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
23148 occurs.
23149
23150 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
23151 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
23152 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
23153 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
23154 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
23155 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
23156 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
23157 cookies" below for more details.
23158
23159 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
23160 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
23161 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
23162 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
23163 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
23164 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
23165 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
23166 and cookies" below for more details.
23167
23168 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
23169 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
23170 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
23171 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
23172 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
23173 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
23174 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
23175 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
23176
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023177
231788.2.4. HTTPS log format
23179----------------------
23180
23181The HTTPS format is the best suited for HTTP over SSL connections. It is an
23182extension of the HTTP format (see section 8.2.3) to which SSL related
23183information are added. It is enabled when "option httpslog" is specified in the
23184frontend. Just like the TCP and HTTP formats, the log is usually emitted at the
23185end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified. A session which
23186matches the "monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log
23187sessions for which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option
23188dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if
23189"option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
23190
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023191The HTTPS log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
23192exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010023193if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT variable can be used
23194instead. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023195
23196 # strict equivalent of "option httpslog"
23197 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
23198 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r \
23199 %[fc_err]/%[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/\
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010023200 %[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010023201 # or using the HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT variable
23202 log-format "${HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023203
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023204This format is basically the HTTP one (see section 8.2.3) with new fields
23205appended to it. The new fields (lines 17 and 18) will be detailed here. For the
23206HTTP ones, refer to the HTTP section.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023207
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023208 Example :
23209 frontend https-in
23210 mode http
23211 option httpslog
23212 log global
23213 bind *:443 ssl crt mycerts/srv.pem ...
23214 default_backend bck
23215
23216 backend static
23217 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 ssl crt mycerts/clt.pem ...
23218
23219 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
23220 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] https-in \
23221 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010023222 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1" 0/0/0/0/0 \
23223 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023224
23225 Field Format Extract from the example above
23226 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
23227 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
23228 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
23229 4 frontend_name https-in
23230 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
23231 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
23232 7 status_code 200
23233 8 bytes_read* 2750
23234 9 captured_request_cookie -
23235 10 captured_response_cookie -
23236 11 termination_state ----
23237 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
23238 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
23239 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
23240 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
23241 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010023242 17 fc_err '/' ssl_fc_err '/' ssl_c_err
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020023243 '/' ssl_c_ca_err '/' ssl_fc_is_resumed 0/0/0/0/0
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010023244 18 ssl_fc_sni '/' ssl_version
23245 '/' ssl_ciphers 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023246
23247Detailed fields description :
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010023248 - "fc_err" is the status of the connection on the frontend's side. It
23249 corresponds to the "fc_err" sample fetch. See the "fc_err" and "fc_err_str"
23250 sample fetch functions for more information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023251
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020023252 - "ssl_fc_err" is the last error of the first SSL error stack that was
23253 raised on the connection from the frontend's perspective. It might be used
23254 to detect SSL handshake errors for instance. It will be 0 if everything
Ilya Shipitsinbd6b4be2021-10-15 16:18:21 +050023255 went well. See the "ssl_fc_err" sample fetch's description for more
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020023256 information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023257
23258 - "ssl_c_err" is the status of the client's certificate verification process.
23259 The handshake might be successful while having a non-null verification
23260 error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_err" sample fetch and
23261 the "crt-ignore-err" option.
23262
23263 - "ssl_c_ca_err" is the status of the client's certificate chain verification
23264 process. The handshake might be successful while having a non-null
23265 verification error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_ca_err"
23266 sample fetch and the "ca-ignore-err" option.
23267
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020023268 - "ssl_fc_is_resumed" is true if the incoming TLS session was resumed with
23269 the stateful cache or a stateless ticket. Don't forgot that a TLS session
23270 can be shared by multiple requests.
23271
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010023272 - "ssl_fc_sni" is the SNI (Server Name Indication) presented by the client
23273 to select the certificate to be used. It usually matches the host name for
23274 the first request of a connection. An absence of this field may indicate
23275 that the SNI was not sent by the client, and will lead haproxy to use the
23276 default certificate, or to reject the connection in case of strict-sni.
23277
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023278 - "ssl_version" is the SSL version of the frontend.
23279
23280 - "ssl_ciphers" is the SSL cipher used for the connection.
23281
23282
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +0100232838.2.5. Error log format
23284-----------------------
23285
23286When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
23287protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format,
23288unless a dedicated error log format is defined through an "error-log-format"
23289line. By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
23290"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
23291will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
23292logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
23293
23294The default format looks like this :
23295
23296 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
23297 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
23298 Connection error during SSL handshake
23299
23300 Field Format Extract from the example above
23301 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
23302 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
23303 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
23304 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
23305 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
23306
23307These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
23308failures.
23309
23310By using the "error-log-format" directive, the legacy log format described
23311above will not be used anymore, and all error log lines will follow the
23312defined format.
23313
23314An example of reasonably complete error-log-format follows, it will report the
23315source address and port, the connection accept() date, the frontend name, the
23316number of active connections on the process and on thit frontend, haproxy's
23317internal error identifier on the front connection, the hexadecimal OpenSSL
23318error number (that can be copy-pasted to "openssl errstr" for full decoding),
23319the client certificate extraction status (0 indicates no error), the client
23320certificate validation status using the CA (0 indicates no error), a boolean
23321indicating if the connection is new or was resumed, the optional server name
23322indication (SNI) provided by the client, the SSL version name and the SSL
23323ciphers used on the connection, if any. Note that backend connection errors
23324are never reported here since in order for a backend connection to fail, it
23325would have passed through a successful stream, hence will be available as
23326regular traffic log (see option httplog or option httpslog).
23327
23328 # detailed frontend connection error log
Lukas Tribus2b949732021-12-09 01:27:14 +010023329 error-log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %ac/%fc %[fc_err]/\
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010023330 %[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/%[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] \
23331 %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
23332
23333
233348.2.6. Custom log format
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020023335------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023336
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023337When the default log formats are not sufficient, it is possible to define new
23338ones in very fine details. As creating a log-format from scratch is not always
23339a trivial task, it is strongly recommended to first have a look at the existing
23340formats ("option tcplog", "option httplog", "option httpslog"), pick the one
23341looking the closest to the expectation, copy its "log-format" equivalent string
23342and adjust it.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023343
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023344HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023345Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
23346separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
23347prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
23348
23349Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
23350variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010023351("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023352
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010023353If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020023354as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010023355less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
23356the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
23357
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020023358Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
23359"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
23360delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
23361preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023362
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010023363Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
23364'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
23365https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
23366such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
23367
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023368Flags are :
23369 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040023370 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010023371 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
23372 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023373
23374 Example:
23375
23376 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
23377 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
23378
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010023379 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
23380
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023381Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
23382
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023383 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020023384 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023385 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
23386 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
23387 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023388 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
23389 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
23390 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020023391 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000023392 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000023393 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000023394 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000023395 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000023396 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
23397 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010023398 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020023399 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020023400 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3010e002021-12-03 10:48:36 +010023401 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023402 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020023403 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080023404 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023405 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
23406 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
23407 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
23408 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
23409 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020023410 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023411 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000023412 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023413 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023414 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023415 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
23416 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023417 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
23418 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
23419 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023420 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023421 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
23422 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023423 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023424 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
23425 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
23426 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020023427 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020023428 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020023429 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
23430 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
23431 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
23432 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020023433 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020023434 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020023435 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023436 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010023437 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023438 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023439 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
23440 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
23441 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023442 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020023443 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
23444 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023445 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023446 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
23447 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020023448 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023449 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020023450 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023451 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023452
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020023453 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023454
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010023455
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200234568.3. Advanced logging options
23457-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023458
23459Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
23460just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
23461options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
23462for more information about their usage.
23463
23464
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200234658.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
23466------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023467
23468It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023469HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023470commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
23471monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
23472ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
23473
23474 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
23475 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
23476 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
23477 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
23478
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020023479 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
23480 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023481
23482 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
23483 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
23484 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
23485
23486
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200234878.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
23488----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023489
23490The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
23491what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
23492or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023493"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023494just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
23495log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
23496after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
23497is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
23498with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
23499with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
23500
23501
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200235028.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
23503------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020023504
23505Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
23506for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
23507"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
23508retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
23509raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
23510a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
23511file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
23512you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
23513"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
23514
23515
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200235168.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
23517--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020023518
23519Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
23520multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
23521them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
23522"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
23523logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
23524error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
23525and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
23526too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
23527useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
23528alternative.
23529
23530
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200235318.4. Timing events
23532------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023533
23534Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
23535reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
23536the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
23537frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023538mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
23539addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
23540
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010023541Timings events in HTTP mode:
23542
23543 first request 2nd request
23544 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
23545 t tr t tr ...
23546 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
23547 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
23548 :<---- Tq ---->: :
23549 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000023550 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010023551 :<--------- Ta --------->:
23552
23553Timings events in TCP mode:
23554
23555 TCP session
23556 |<----------------->|
23557 t t
23558 ---|----|----|----|----|---
23559 | Th Tw Tc Td |
23560 |<------ Tt ------->|
23561
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023562 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023563 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023564 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
23565 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
23566 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023567 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023568 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
23569 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
23570 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
23571 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023572
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023573 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
23574 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
23575 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023576 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
23577 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
23578 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
23579 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
23580 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
23581 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023582
23583 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
23584 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
23585 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
23586 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
23587 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
23588 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
23589 request typed by hand during a test.
23590
23591 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
23592 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023593 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023594 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
23595 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
23596 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
23597 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023598
23599 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
23600 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
23601 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
23602 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
23603 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
23604
23605 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
23606 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
23607 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
23608 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
23609 connection never established.
23610
23611 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
23612 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
23613 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
23614 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
23615 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
23616 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
23617 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
23618 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
23619 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
23620 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
23621 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
23622
William Lallemand14894192023-07-25 09:06:51 +020023623 - Td: this is the total transfer time of the response payload till the last
23624 byte sent to the client. In HTTP it starts after the last response header
23625 (after Tr).
23626
23627 The data sent are not guaranteed to be received by the client, they can be
23628 stuck in either the kernel or the network.
23629
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023630 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
23631 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
23632 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
23633 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
23634 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
23635 by subtracting other timers when valid :
23636
23637 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
23638
23639 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
23640 "Ta" can never be negative.
23641
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023642 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
23643 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023644 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
23645 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030023646 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023647
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023648 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023649
23650 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023651 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
23652 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023653
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000023654 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
23655 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
23656 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
23657 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
23658 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
23659 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
23660 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
23661 prefixed with a '+' sign.
23662
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023663These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
23664protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
23665that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023666due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
23667"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
23668that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023669
23670Most common cases :
23671
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023672 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
23673 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
23674 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
23675 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
23676 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023677 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023678 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
23679 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
23680 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
23681 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
23682 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020023683 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023684
23685 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
23686 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
23687 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
23688 of ms on remote networks.
23689
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020023690 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
23691 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
23692 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023693
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023694 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
23695 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023696 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023697 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
23698 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
23699 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
23700 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
23701 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
23702 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023703
23704Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
23705
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023706 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023707 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023708 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023709
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023710 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023711 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
23712 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
23713
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023714 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023715 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
23716 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
23717 flags.
23718
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023719 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
23720 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023721 Check the session termination flags, then check the
23722 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
23723 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
23724 the client connection was maintained open.
23725
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023726 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030023727 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023728 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023729 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
23730
23731
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200237328.5. Session state at disconnection
23733-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023734
23735TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
23736"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
237372-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
23738each of which has a special meaning :
23739
23740 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
23741 session to terminate :
23742
23743 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
23744
23745 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
23746 server explicitly refused it.
23747
23748 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
23749 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
23750 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
23751 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023752 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020023753
Christopher Faulet9183dfd2023-12-19 08:51:26 +010023754 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023755
23756 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
23757 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
23758 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
23759 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
23760 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
23761
23762 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
23763 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
23764 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
23765 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
23766 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
23767
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023768 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090023769 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
23770
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023771 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070023772 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
23773 backup connections when going up.
23774
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023775 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020023776
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023777 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
23778 send or receive data.
23779
23780 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
23781 send or receive data.
23782
23783 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
23784 with nothing left in the buffers.
23785
23786 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
23787
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010023788 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023789 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
23790
23791 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
23792 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
23793 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
23794 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
23795 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
23796
23797 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
23798 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
23799
23800 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
23801 server (HTTP only).
23802
23803 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
23804
23805 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
23806 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
23807 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
23808
23809 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
23810 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
23811 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
23812
23813 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
23814
23815 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
23816 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
23817
23818 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
23819 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
23820 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
23821
23822 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
23823 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020023824 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
23825 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023826
23827 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
23828 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
23829 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
23830 another server.
23831
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023832 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023833 server.
23834
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023835 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
23836 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
23837 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
23838 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
23839
23840 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
23841 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
23842 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
23843 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
23844
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020023845 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
23846 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
23847 "use-server" rule).
23848
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023849 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
23850
23851 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
23852 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
23853
23854 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
23855
23856 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
23857 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
23858 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
23859
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023860 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
23861 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030023862 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023863 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
23864 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
23865
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023866 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
23867
23868 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
23869 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
23870
23871 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
23872
23873 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
23874
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023875The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
23876was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023877helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
23878starvation, attacks, etc...
23879
23880The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
23881alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
23882easier finding and understanding.
23883
23884 Flags Reason
23885
23886 -- Normal termination.
23887
23888 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023889 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
23890 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023891 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
23892
23893 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
23894 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023895 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
23896 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023897 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
23898 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023899
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023900 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
23901 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020023902 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023903
23904 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
23905 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
23906 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
23907
23908 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
23909 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
23910 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
23911 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
23912 the server takes too long to respond.
23913
23914 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
23915 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
23916 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
23917 long a time to respond.
23918
23919 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
23920 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
23921 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023922 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020023923 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
23924 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023925
23926 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
23927 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
23928 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
23929 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
23930 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020023931 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020023932 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
23933 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
23934 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
23935 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
23936 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
23937 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
23938 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
23939 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023940 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020023941 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
23942 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
23943 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023944
23945 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
23946 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020023947 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
23948 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
23949 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
23950 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023951
Christopher Faulet9183dfd2023-12-19 08:51:26 +010023952 LC The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. The
23953 request was not sent to the server. It only happens with a redirect
23954 because of a "redir" parameter on the server line.
23955
23956 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. The
23957 request was not sent to the server. Generally it means a redirect was
23958 returned, an HTTP return statement was processed or the request was
23959 handled by an applet (stats, cache, Prometheus exported, lua applet...).
23960
23961 LH The response was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
23962 it means a redirect was returned or an HTTP return statement was
23963 processed.
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020023964
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023965 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023966 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
23967 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023968 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023969 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
23970 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
23971
23972 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
23973 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
23974 503 or 504 here.
23975
23976 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023977 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023978 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
23979 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
23980 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
23981
23982 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
23983 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023984 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023985 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023986 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023987
23988 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
23989 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
23990 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
23991 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
23992 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
23993 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023994 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023995
23996 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
23997 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
23998 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
23999 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
24000 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
24001 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
24002 solution is to fix the application.
24003
24004 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
24005 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
24006 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
24007 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
24008 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
24009 external attacks.
24010
24011 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070024012 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020024013 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024014 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
24015 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
24016
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010024017 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
24018 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
24019 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024020 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020024021 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010024022
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024023 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
24024 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
24025 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
24026 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010024027 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
24028 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
24029 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
24030 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020024031 logs. Finally, it may be due to an HTTP header rewrite failure on the
24032 response. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is sent (see
24033 "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-response strict-mode" for more
24034 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024035
24036 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
24037 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
24038 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020024039 returned an HTTP 403 error. It may also be due to an HTTP header
24040 rewrite failure on the request. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is
24041 sent (see "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-request strict-mode" for more
24042 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024043
24044 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
24045 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
24046 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
24047 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
24048
24049 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
24050 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
24051 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
24052 only be solved by proper system tuning.
24053
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020024054The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024055persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020024056important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
24057re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
24058
24059 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
24060
24061 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
24062 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
24063 set on a GET request.
24064
24065 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
24066 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040024067 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020024068 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
24069
24070 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
24071 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
24072 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
24073
24074 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
24075 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
24076 already got a cookie.
24077
24078 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
24079 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
24080 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
24081 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
24082 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
24083
24084 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
24085 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
24086 new cookie was inserted in the response.
24087
24088 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
24089 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
24090 new cookie was inserted in the response.
24091
24092 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
24093 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
24094
24095 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
24096 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
24097 then advertised in the response.
24098
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024099
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200241008.6. Non-printable characters
24101-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024102
24103In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
24104consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
24105converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
24106prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
24107being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
24108escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
24109is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
24110'}' when logging headers.
24111
24112Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
24113issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
24114containing spaces is "User-Agent".
24115
24116Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
24117the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
24118performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
24119
24120
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200241218.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
24122---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024123
24124Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
24125achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024126section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024127cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
24128the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
24129the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024130locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024131not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
24132user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
24133a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
24134wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
24135
24136 Examples :
24137 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
24138 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
24139
24140 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
24141 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
24142
24143
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200241448.8. Capturing HTTP headers
24145---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024146
24147Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
24148proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
24149the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
24150server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
24151
24152Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
24153response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024154section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024155
24156It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010024157time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
24158appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024159are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
24160and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
24161follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
24162request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
24163in the logs.
24164
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020024165As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
24166frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
24167an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
24168
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024169 Example :
24170 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
24171 listen proxy-out
24172 mode http
24173 option httplog
24174 option logasap
24175 log global
24176 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
24177
24178 # log the name of the virtual server
24179 capture request header Host len 20
24180
24181 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
24182 capture request header Content-Length len 10
24183
24184 # log the beginning of the referrer
24185 capture request header Referer len 20
24186
24187 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
24188 capture response header Server len 20
24189
24190 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
24191 capture response header Content-Length len 10
24192
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024193 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024194 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
24195
24196 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
24197 capture response header Via len 20
24198
24199 # log the URL location during a redirection
24200 capture response header Location len 20
24201
24202 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
24203 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
24204 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
24205 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
24206 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
24207
24208 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
24209 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
24210 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
24211 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010024212 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024213
24214 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
24215 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
24216 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
24217 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
24218 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010024219 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024220
24221
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200242228.9. Examples of logs
24223---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024224
24225These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
24226them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
24227reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
24228
24229 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
24230 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
24231 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
24232
24233 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
24234 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
24235
24236 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
24237 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
24238 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
24239
24240 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
24241 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
24242
24243 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
24244 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
24245 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
24246
24247 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010024248 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024249 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
24250 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
24251
24252 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
24253 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
24254 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
24255
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020024256 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
24257 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
24258 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
24259 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024260 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020024261 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024262
24263 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010024264 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024265
24266 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
24267 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
24268 Nothing was sent to any server.
24269
24270 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
24271 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
24272
24273 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
24274 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024275 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024276 send a 408 return code to the client.
24277
24278 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
24279 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
24280
24281 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
24282 5 seconds ("c----").
24283
24284 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
24285 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010024286 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024287
24288 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024289 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024290 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
24291 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
24292 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
24293 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
24294 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010024295
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020024296
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200242979. Supported filters
24298--------------------
24299
24300Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
24301accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
24302unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
24303
24304See also : "filter"
24305
243069.1. Trace
24307----------
24308
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010024309filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024310
24311 Arguments:
24312 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
24313 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
24314
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010024315 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024316
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024317 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024318 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
24319 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
24320 amount of the parsed data.
24321
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024322 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010024323
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024324This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
24325callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
24326information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
24327filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
24328
24329Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
24330tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
24331a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
24332
24333
243349.2. HTTP compression
24335---------------------
24336
24337filter compression
24338
24339The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
24340keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024341when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
24342fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
24343done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
24344explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
24345filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
24346listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
24347order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024348
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024349See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
24350 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024351
24352
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200243539.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
24354--------------------------------------------
24355
24356filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
24357
24358 Arguments :
24359
24360 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
24361 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
24362 parsed.
24363
24364 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
24365 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
24366 part must be placed in its own scope.
24367
24368The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
24369external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024370streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020024371exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
24372also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
24373
24374SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
24375the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
24376
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010024377For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020024378"doc/SPOE.txt".
24379
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100243809.4. Cache
24381----------
24382
24383filter cache <name>
24384
24385 Arguments :
24386
24387 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
24388
24389The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
24390"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050024391cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024392other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
24393case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
24394is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
24395filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010024396listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
24397order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010024398
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024399See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
24400 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
24401
24402
244039.5. Fcgi-app
24404-------------
24405
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040024406filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024407
24408 Arguments :
24409
24410 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
24411
24412The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
24413request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
24414reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
24415used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
24416implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
24417used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
24418fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
24419used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
24420order.
24421
24422See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
24423 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
24424
24425
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100244269.6. OpenTracing
24427----------------
24428
24429The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
24430HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
24431of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
24432Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
24433
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024434This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010024435
24436The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
24437HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
24438participates in the work of HAProxy.
24439
24440filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
24441
24442 Arguments :
24443
24444 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
24445 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
24446 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
24447 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
24448 OpenTracing filters.
24449
24450 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
24451 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
24452 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
24453 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
24454 filter must have its own scope defined.
24455
24456More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020024457of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010024458
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +0200244599.7. Bandwidth limitation
24460--------------------------
24461
24462filter bwlim-in <name> default-limit <size> default-period <time> [min-size <sz>]
24463filter bwlim-out <name> default-limit <size> default-period <time> [min-size <sz>]
24464filter bwlim-in <name> limit <size> key <pattern> [table <table>] [min-size <sz>]
24465filter bwlim-out <name> limit <size> key <pattern> [table <table>] [min-size <sz>]
24466
24467 Arguments :
24468
24469 <name> is the filter name that will be used by 'set-bandwidth-limit'
24470 actions to reference a specific bandwidth limitation filter.
24471
24472 <size> is max number of bytes that can be forwarded over the period.
24473 The value must be specified for per-stream and shared bandwidth
24474 limitation filters. It follows the HAProxy size format and is
24475 expressed in bytes.
24476
24477 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
24478 describes what elements will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
24479 and used to select which table entry to update the counters. It
24480 must be specified for shared bandwidth limitation filters only.
24481
24482 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
24483 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. It can
24484 be specified for shared bandwidth limitation filters only.
24485
24486 <time> is the default time period used to evaluate the bandwidth
Ilya Shipitsin3b64a282022-07-29 22:26:53 +050024487 limitation rate. It can be specified for per-stream bandwidth
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020024488 limitation filters only. It follows the HAProxy time format and
24489 is expressed in milliseconds.
24490
24491 <min-size> is the optional minimum number of bytes forwarded at a time by
24492 a stream excluding the last packet that may be smaller. This
24493 value can be specified for per-stream and shared bandwidth
24494 limitation filters. It follows the HAProxy size format and is
24495 expressed in bytes.
24496
24497Bandwidth limitation filters should be used to restrict the data forwarding
24498speed at the stream level. By extension, such filters limit the network
24499bandwidth consumed by a resource. Several bandwidth limitation filters can be
24500used. For instance, it is possible to define a limit per source address to be
24501sure a client will never consume all the network bandwidth, thereby penalizing
24502other clients, and another one per stream to be able to fairly handle several
24503connections for a given client.
24504
24505The definition order of these filters is important. If several bandwidth
24506filters are enabled on a stream, the filtering will be applied in their
24507definition order. It is also important to understand the definition order of
24508the other filters have an influence. For instance, depending on the HTTP
24509compression filter is defined before or after a bandwidth limitation filter,
24510the limit will be applied on the compressed payload or not. The same is true
24511for the cache filter.
24512
24513There are two kinds of bandwidth limitation filters. The first one enforces a
24514default limit and is applied per stream. The second one uses a stickiness table
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +050024515to enforce a limit equally divided between all streams sharing the same entry in
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020024516the table.
24517
24518In addition, for a given filter, depending on the filter keyword used, the
24519limitation can be applied on incoming data, received from the client and
24520forwarded to a server, or on outgoing data, received from a server and sent to
24521the client. To apply a limit on incoming data, "bwlim-in" keyword must be
24522used. To apply it on outgoing data, "bwlim-out" keyword must be used. In both
24523cases, the bandwidth limitation is applied on forwarded data, at the stream
24524level.
24525
24526The bandwidth limitation is applied at the stream level and not at the
24527connection level. For multiplexed protocols (H2, H3 and FastCGI), the streams
24528of the same connection may have different limits.
24529
24530For a per-stream bandwidth limitation filter, default period and limit must be
24531defined. As their names suggest, they are the default values used to setup the
24532bandwidth limitation rate for a stream. However, for this kind of filter and
24533only this one, it is possible to redefine these values using sample expressions
24534when the filter is enabled with a TCP/HTTP "set-bandwidth-limit" action.
24535
24536For a shared bandwidth limitation filter, depending on whether it is applied on
24537incoming or outgoing data, the stickiness table used must store the
24538corresponding bytes rate information. "bytes_in_rate(<period>)" counter must be
24539stored to limit incoming data and "bytes_out_rate(<period>)" counter must be
24540used to limit outgoing data.
24541
24542Finally, it is possible to set the minimum number of bytes that a bandwidth
24543limitation filter can forward at a time for a given stream. It should be used
24544to not forward too small amount of data, to reduce the CPU usage. It must
24545carefully be defined. Too small, a value can increase the CPU usage. Too high,
24546it can increase the latency. It is also highly linked to the defined bandwidth
24547limit. If it is too close to the bandwidth limit, some pauses may be
24548experienced to not exceed the limit because too many bytes will be consumed at
24549a time. It is highly dependent on the filter configuration. A good idea is to
24550start with something around 2 TCP MSS, typically 2896 bytes, and tune it after
24551some experimentations.
24552
24553 Example:
24554 frontend http
24555 bind *:80
24556 mode http
24557
24558 # If this filter is enabled, the stream will share the download limit
24559 # of 10m/s with all other streams with the same source address.
24560 filter bwlim-out limit-by-src key src table limit-by-src limit 10m
24561
Ilya Shipitsin3b64a282022-07-29 22:26:53 +050024562 # If this filter is enabled, the stream will be limited to download at 1m/s,
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020024563 # independently of all other streams.
24564 filter bwlim-out limit-by-strm default-limit 1m default-period 1s
24565
24566 # Limit all streams to 1m/s (the default limit) and those accessing the
24567 # internal API to 100k/s. Limit each source address to 10m/s. The shared
24568 # limit is applied first. Both are limiting the download rate.
24569 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-strm
24570 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-strm limit 100k if { path_beg /internal }
24571 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-src
24572 ...
24573
24574 backend limit-by-src
24575 # The stickiness table used by <limit-by-src> filter
24576 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 3600s store bytes_out_rate(1s)
24577
24578See also : "tcp-request content set-bandwidth-limit",
24579 "tcp-response content set-bandwidth-limit",
24580 "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" and
24581 "http-response set-bandwidth-limit".
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010024582
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002458310. FastCGI applications
24584-------------------------
24585
24586HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
24587feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
24588the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
24589FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
24590servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
24591FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
24592backend.
24593
24594HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
24595application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
24596connection.
24597
2459810.1. Setup
24599-----------
24600
2460110.1.1. Fcgi-app section
24602--------------------------
24603
24604fcgi-app <name>
24605 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
24606 document root must be defined.
24607
24608acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
24609 Declare or complete an access list.
24610
24611 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
24612 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
24613 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
24614 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
24615 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
24616
24617docroot <path>
24618 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
24619 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
24620 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
24621
24622index <script-name>
24623 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
24624 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
24625 is an optional setting.
24626
24627 Example :
24628 index index.php
24629
24630log-stderr global
24631log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010024632 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024633 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
24634
24635 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
24636 default STDERR messages are ignored.
24637
24638pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
24639 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
24640 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
24641 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
24642
24643 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
24644 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
24645 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
24646 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
24647
24648 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
24649 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
24650
24651path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010024652 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010024653 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
24654 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
24655 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
24656 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
24657 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
24658 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
24659 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010024660
24661 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050024662 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010024663 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
24664 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
24665 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
24666 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024667
24668 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010024669 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
24670 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024671
24672option get-values
24673no option get-values
24674 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
24675
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040024676 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024677 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
24678
24679 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
24680 application will accept.
24681
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020024682 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
24683 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024684
24685 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050024686 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024687 option is disabled.
24688
24689 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
24690 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
24691 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
24692 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
24693 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
24694 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
24695
24696option keep-conn
24697no option keep-conn
24698 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
24699 sending a response.
24700
24701 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
24702 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
24703
24704option max-reqs <reqs>
24705 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
24706 accept.
24707
24708 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
24709 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
24710 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
24711 to 1.
24712
24713option mpxs-conns
24714no option mpxs-conns
24715 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
24716
24717 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
24718 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
24719
24720set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
24721 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
24722 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
24723 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
24724 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
24725
24726 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
24727 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
24728 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
24729
24730 Example :
24731 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
24732 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
24733
24734 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
24735
24736
2473710.1.2. Proxy section
24738---------------------
24739
24740use-fcgi-app <name>
24741 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
24742
24743 Arguments :
24744 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
24745
24746 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
24747 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
24748 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
24749 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
24750 application may be defined at a time per backend.
24751
24752 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
24753 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
24754 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
24755 application are evaluated.
24756
24757
2475810.1.3. Example
24759---------------
24760
24761 frontend front-http
24762 mode http
24763 bind *:80
24764 bind *:
24765
24766 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
24767 default_backend back-static
24768
24769 backend back-static
24770 mode http
24771 server www A.B.C.D:80
24772
24773 backend back-dynamic
24774 mode http
24775 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
24776 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
24777
24778 fcgi-app php-fpm
24779 log-stderr global
24780 option keep-conn
24781
24782 docroot /var/www/my-app
24783 index index.php
24784 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
24785
24786
2478710.2. Default parameters
24788------------------------
24789
24790A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
24791the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050024792script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024793applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
24794
24795 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24796 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
24797 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
24798 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
24799 | | |
24800 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24801 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
24802 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
24803 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
24804 | | application. |
24805 | | |
24806 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24807 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
24808 | | the request. It may not be set. |
24809 | | |
24810 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24811 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
24812 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
24813 | | the application's configuration. |
24814 | | |
24815 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24816 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
24817 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
24818 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
24819 | | |
24820 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24821 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
24822 | | following the part that identifies the script |
24823 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
24824 | | be defined. |
24825 | | |
24826 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24827 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
24828 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
24829 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
24830 | | is not set too. |
24831 | | |
24832 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24833 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
24834 | | set. |
24835 | | |
24836 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24837 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
24838 | | the request. |
24839 | | |
24840 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24841 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
24842 | | client as part of user authentication. |
24843 | | |
24844 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24845 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
24846 | | script to process the request. |
24847 | | |
24848 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24849 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
24850 | | |
24851 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24852 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
24853 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
24854 | | |
24855 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24856 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
24857 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
24858 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
24859 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
24860 | | |
24861 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24862 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
24863 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
24864 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
24865 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
24866 | | side. |
24867 | | |
24868 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24869 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
24870 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
24871 | | connected to. |
24872 | | |
24873 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24874 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
24875 | | |
24876 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Faulet5cd0e522021-06-11 13:34:42 +020024877 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
24878 | | current HAProxy version. |
24879 | | |
24880 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024881 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
24882 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
24883 | | |
24884 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24885
24886
2488710.3. Limitations
24888------------------
24889
24890The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
24891way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
24892during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
24893establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
24894application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
24895or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
24896message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
24897these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
24898and HTTP servers under the same backend.
24899
24900Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
24901request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
24902requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
24903
24904About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
24905into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
24906fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
24907"http-request" ones.
24908
24909Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
24910FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
24911processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
24912must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
24913here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010024914
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024915
2491611. Address formats
24917-------------------
24918
24919Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
24920address.
24921
24922This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
24923The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
24924of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
24925equivalent is '::'.
24926
24927Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
24928is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
24929
24930This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
24931family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
24932
24933Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
24934configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
24935use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
24936'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
24937
24938Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
24939socket type and the transport method.
24940
24941
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002494211.1. Address family prefixes
24943-----------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024944
24945'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
24946
24947'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
24948 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
24949 listening.
24950
24951'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
24952 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
24953 on the statement using this address, a port or
24954 a port range may or must be specified.
24955
24956'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24957 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
24958 using this address, a port or a port range
24959 may or must be specified.
24960
24961'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24962 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
24963 using this address, a port or a port range
24964 may or must be specified.
24965
24966'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
24967 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
24968 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
24969 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
24970 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
24971 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
24972
24973'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
24974 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
24975 start by slash '/'.
24976
24977
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002497811.2. Socket type prefixes
24979--------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024980
24981Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
24982type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
24983this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
24984This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
24985but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
24986
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010024987Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should instead use
24988use aliases of the next section "11.3 Protocol prefixes". However these can
24989sometimes be convenient, for example in combination with inherited sockets
24990known by their file descriptor number, in which case the address family is "fd"
24991and the socket type must be declared.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024992
24993If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
24994they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
24995report this to the maintainers.
24996
24997'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
24998 to "stream"
24999
25000'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
25001 to "datagram".
25002
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010025003'quic+<family>@<address>' forces socket type to "datagram" and transport
25004 method to "stream".
25005
25006
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025007
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002500811.3. Protocol prefixes
25009-----------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025010
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010025011'quic4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25012 an IPv4 address but socket type is forced to
25013 "datagram" and the transport method is forced
25014 to "stream". Depending on the statement using
25015 this address, a UDP port or port range can or
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010025016 must be specified. It is equivalent to
25017 "quic+ipv4@".
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010025018
25019'quic6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25020 an IPv6 address but socket type is forced to
25021 "datagram" and the transport method is forced
25022 to "stream". Depending on the statement using
25023 this address, a UDP port or port range can or
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010025024 must be specified. It is equivalent to
25025 "quic+ipv6@".
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010025026
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025027'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
25028 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
25029 socket type and transport method is forced to
25030 "stream". Depending on the statement using
25031 this address, a port or a port range can or
25032 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
25033 of 'stream+ip@'.
25034
25035'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25036 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
25037 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
25038 statement using this address, a port or port
25039 range can or must be specified.
25040 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
25041
25042'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25043 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
25044 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
25045 statement using this address, a port or port
25046 range can or must be specified.
25047 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
25048
25049'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
25050 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
25051 socket type and transport method is forced to
25052 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
25053 this address, a port or a port range can or
25054 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
25055 of 'dgram+ip@'.
25056
25057'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25058 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
25059 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
25060 the statement using this address, a port or
25061 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau24101f92023-01-16 12:11:38 +010025062 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025063
25064'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25065 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
25066 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
25067 the statement using this address, a port or
25068 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau24101f92023-01-16 12:11:38 +010025069 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025070
25071'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
25072 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
25073 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
25074
25075'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
25076 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
25077 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
25078
25079In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
25080QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
25081
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010025082/*
25083 * Local variables:
25084 * fill-column: 79
25085 * End:
25086 */